Revision: miles@gnu.org--gnu-2004/emacs--cvs-trunk--0--patch-523
[bpt/emacs.git] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright (c) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004
12 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13
14 @quotation
15 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
16 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
17 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
18 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
19 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
20 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
21 License'' in the Emacs manual.
22
23 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
24 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
25 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
26
27 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
28 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
29 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
30 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
31 @end quotation
32 @end copying
33
34 @iftex
35 @iflatex
36 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
37 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
38 \usepackage{pagestyle}
39 \usepackage{epsfig}
40 \usepackage{pixidx}
41 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
42
43 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \else
45 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
46 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
47 \pdfcompresslevel=9
48 \fi
49
50 \makeindex
51 \begin{document}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.10.6}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.10.6.
363
364 @end ifinfo
365
366 @iftex
367
368 @iflatex
369 \tableofcontents
370 \gnuscleardoublepage
371 @end iflatex
372
373 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
374 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
375
376 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
377 being accused of plagiarism:
378
379 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
380 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
381 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
382 can even read news with it!
383
384 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
385 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
386 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
387 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
388 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
389 the program.
390
391 @end iftex
392
393 @menu
394 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
395 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
396 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
397 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
398 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
399 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
400 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
401 * Various:: General purpose settings.
402 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
403 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
404 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
405 * Key Index:: Key Index.
406
407 Other related manuals
408
409 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
410 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
411 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
412 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
413
414 @detailmenu
415 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
416
417 Starting Gnus
418
419 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
420 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
421 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
422 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
423 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
424 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
425 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
426 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
427 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
428 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
429 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
430
431 New Groups
432
433 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
434 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
435 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
436
437 Group Buffer
438
439 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
440 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
441 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
442 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
443 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
444 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
445 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
446 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
447 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
448 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
449 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
450 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
451 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
452 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
453 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
454 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
455 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
456
457 Group Buffer Format
458
459 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
460 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
461 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
462
463 Group Topics
464
465 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
466 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
467 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
468 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
469 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
470
471 Misc Group Stuff
472
473 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
474 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
475 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
476 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
477 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
478
479 Summary Buffer
480
481 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
482 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
483 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
484 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
485 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
486 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
487 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
488 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
489 * Threading:: How threads are made.
490 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
491 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
492 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
493 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
494 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
495 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
496 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
497 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
498 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
499 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
500 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
501 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
502 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
503 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
504 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
505 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
506 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
507 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
508 or reselecting the current group.
509 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
510 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
511 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
512 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
513
514 Summary Buffer Format
515
516 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
517 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
518 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
519 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
520
521 Choosing Articles
522
523 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
524 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
525
526 Reply, Followup and Post
527
528 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
529 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
530 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
531 * Canceling and Superseding::
532
533 Marking Articles
534
535 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
536 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
537 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
538
539 Marking Articles
540
541 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
542 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
543 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
544
545 Threading
546
547 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
548 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
549
550 Customizing Threading
551
552 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
553 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
554 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
555 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
556
557 Decoding Articles
558
559 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
560 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
561 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
562 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
563 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
564 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
565
566 Decoding Variables
567
568 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
569 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
570 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
571
572 Article Treatment
573
574 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
575 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
576 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
577 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
578 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
579 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
580 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
581 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
582 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
583 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
584 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
585
586 Alternative Approaches
587
588 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
589 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
590
591 Various Summary Stuff
592
593 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
594 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
595 * Summary Generation Commands::
596 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
597
598 Article Buffer
599
600 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
601 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
602 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
603 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
604 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
605
606 Composing Messages
607
608 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
609 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
610 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
611 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
612 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
613 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
614 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
615 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
616 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
617
618 Select Methods
619
620 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
621 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
622 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
623 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
624 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
625 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
626 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
627 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
628
629 Server Buffer
630
631 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
632 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
633 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
634 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
635 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
636 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
637 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
638
639 Getting News
640
641 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
642 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
643
644 @acronym{NNTP}
645
646 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
647 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
648 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
649
650 Getting Mail
651
652 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
653 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
654 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
655 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
656 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
657 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
658 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
659 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
660 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
661 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
662 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
663 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
664 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
665
666 Mail Sources
667
668 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
669 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
670 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
671
672 Choosing a Mail Back End
673
674 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
675 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
676 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
677 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
678 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
679 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
680 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
681
682 Browsing the Web
683
684 * Archiving Mail::
685 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
686 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
687 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
688 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
689 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
690 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
691
692 @acronym{IMAP}
693
694 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
695 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
696 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
697 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
698 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
699 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
700
701 Other Sources
702
703 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
704 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
705 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
706 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
707 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
708
709 Document Groups
710
711 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
712
713 SOUP
714
715 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
716 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
717 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
718
719 Combined Groups
720
721 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
722 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
723
724 Gnus Unplugged
725
726 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
727 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
728 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
729 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
730 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
731 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
732 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
733 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
734 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
735 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
736 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
737 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
738 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
739
740 Agent Categories
741
742 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
743 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
744 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
745
746 Agent Commands
747
748 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
749 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
750 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
751
752 Scoring
753
754 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
755 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
756 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
757 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
758 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
759 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
760 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
761 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
762 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
763 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
764 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
765 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
766 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
767 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
768 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
769 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
770 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
771
772 GroupLens
773
774 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
775 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
776 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
777 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
778
779 Advanced Scoring
780
781 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
782 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
783 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
784
785 Various
786
787 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
788 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
789 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
790 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
791 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
792 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
793 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
794 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
795 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
796 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
797 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
798 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
799 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
800 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
801 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
802 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
803 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
804 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
805 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
806 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
807
808 Formatting Variables
809
810 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
811 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
812 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
813 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
814 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
815 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
816 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
817 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
818
819 Image Enhancements
820
821 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
822 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
823 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
824 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
825 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
826
827 Thwarting Email Spam
828
829 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
830 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
831 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
832 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
833 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
834 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
835
836 Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
837
838 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
839 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
840 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
841 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
842 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
843 * BBDB Whitelists::
844 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
845 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
846 * Blackholes::
847 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
848 * Bogofilter::
849 * ifile spam filtering::
850 * spam-stat spam filtering::
851 * SpamOracle::
852 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
853
854 Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
855
856 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
857 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
858 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
859
860 Appendices
861
862 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
863 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
864 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
865 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
866 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
867 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
868 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
869 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
870 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
871
872 History
873
874 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
875 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
876 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
877 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
878 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
879 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
880 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
881 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
882 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
883
884 New Features
885
886 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
887 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
888 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
889 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
890 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
891 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10.
892
893 Customization
894
895 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
896 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
897 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
898 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
899
900 Gnus Reference Guide
901
902 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
903 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
904 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
905 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
906 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
907 * Group Info:: The group info format.
908 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
909 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
910 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
911
912 Back End Interface
913
914 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
915 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
916 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
917 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
918 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
919 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
920
921 Various File Formats
922
923 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
924 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
925
926 Emacs for Heathens
927
928 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
929 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
930
931 @end detailmenu
932 @end menu
933
934 @node Starting Up
935 @chapter Starting Gnus
936 @cindex starting up
937
938 @kindex M-x gnus
939 @findex gnus
940 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
941 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
942 your Emacs.
943
944 @findex gnus-other-frame
945 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
946 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
947 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
948
949 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
950 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
951 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
952
953 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
954 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
955
956 @menu
957 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
958 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
959 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
960 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
961 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
962 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
963 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
964 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
965 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
966 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
967 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
968 @end menu
969
970
971 @node Finding the News
972 @section Finding the News
973 @cindex finding news
974
975 @vindex gnus-select-method
976 @c @head
977 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
978 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
979 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
980 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
981 foreign groups.
982
983 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
984 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
985
986 @lisp
987 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
988 @end lisp
989
990 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
991
992 @lisp
993 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
994 @end lisp
995
996 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
997 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
998 server is running Leafnode; in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
999
1000 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1001 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1002 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1003 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1004 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1005 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1006 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1007 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1008 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1009
1010 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1011 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1012 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1013 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1014
1015 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1016 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1017 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1018 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1019 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1020 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1021 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1022 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1023 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1024 server.)
1025
1026 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1027 @kindex B (Group)
1028 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1029 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1030 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1031 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1032 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1033 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1034
1035 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1036 @c @head
1037 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1038 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1039 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1040 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1041 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1042 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1043 groups are.
1044
1045 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1046 you would typically set this variable to
1047
1048 @lisp
1049 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1050 @end lisp
1051
1052
1053 @node The First Time
1054 @section The First Time
1055 @cindex first time usage
1056
1057 If no startup files exist, Gnus will try to determine what groups should
1058 be subscribed by default.
1059
1060 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1061 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1062 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1063 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1064 something useful.
1065
1066 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1067 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1068 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1069
1070 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1071 help you with most common problems.
1072
1073 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1074 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1075 special.
1076
1077
1078 @node The Server is Down
1079 @section The Server is Down
1080 @cindex server errors
1081
1082 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1083 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1084 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1085
1086 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1087 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1088 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1089 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1090 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1091 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1092 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1093
1094 @findex gnus-no-server
1095 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1096 @c @head
1097 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1098 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1099 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1100 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1101 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1102 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1103 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1104
1105
1106 @node Slave Gnusae
1107 @section Slave Gnusae
1108 @cindex slave
1109
1110 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1111 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1112 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1113 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1114
1115 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1116 @file{.newsrc} file.
1117
1118 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1119 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1120 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1121 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1122 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1123 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1124 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1125
1126 @findex gnus-slave
1127 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1128 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1129 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1130 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1131 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1132 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1133 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1134 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1135
1136 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1137 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1138
1139 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1140 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1141 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1142 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1143 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1144
1145 @node Fetching a Group
1146 @section Fetching a Group
1147 @cindex fetching a group
1148
1149 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1150 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1151 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
1152 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1153 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1154 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1155
1156
1157 @node New Groups
1158 @section New Groups
1159 @cindex new groups
1160 @cindex subscription
1161
1162 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1163 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1164 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1165 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1166 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1167 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1168 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1169 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1170 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1171
1172 @menu
1173 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1174 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1175 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1176 @end menu
1177
1178
1179 @node Checking New Groups
1180 @subsection Checking New Groups
1181
1182 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1183 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1184 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1185 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1186 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1187 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1188 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1189 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1190 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1191 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1192
1193 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1194 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1195 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1196 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1197 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1198 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1199 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1200 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1201 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1202 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1203 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1204
1205 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1206 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1207 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1208 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1209 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1210 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1211
1212
1213 @node Subscription Methods
1214 @subsection Subscription Methods
1215
1216 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1217 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1218 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1219
1220 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1221 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1222
1223 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1224
1225 @table @code
1226
1227 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1228 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1229 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1230 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1231 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1232
1233 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1234 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1235 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1236 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1237
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1240 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1241
1242 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1243 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1244 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1245 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1246 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1247 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1248 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1249 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1250 up. Or something like that.
1251
1252 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1253 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1254 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1255 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1256 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1257
1258 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1259 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1260 Kill all new groups.
1261
1262 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1263 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1264 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1265 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1266 topic parameter that looks like
1267
1268 @example
1269 "nnslashdot"
1270 @end example
1271
1272 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1273 that topic.
1274
1275 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1276 top-level topic.
1277
1278 @end table
1279
1280 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1281 A closely related variable is
1282 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1283 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1284 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1285 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1286 hierarchy or not.
1287
1288 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1289 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1290 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1291 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1292
1293
1294 @node Filtering New Groups
1295 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1296
1297 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1298 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1299 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1300
1301 @example
1302 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1303 @end example
1304
1305 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1306 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1307 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1308 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1309 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1310 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1311 subscribing these groups.
1312 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1313 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1314
1315 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1316 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1317 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1318 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1319 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1320 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1321 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1322 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1323
1324 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1325 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1326 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1327 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1328 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1329 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1330 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1331 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1332 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1333 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1334 @code{nil}.
1335
1336 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1337 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1338
1339
1340 @node Changing Servers
1341 @section Changing Servers
1342 @cindex changing servers
1343
1344 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1345 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1346 very flaky and you want to use another.
1347
1348 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1349 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1350
1351 @emph{Wrong!}
1352
1353 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1354 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1355 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1356 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1357 worthless.
1358
1359 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1360 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1361 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1362 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1363
1364 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1365 @findex gnus-change-server
1366 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1367 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1368 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1370 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1373 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1374 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1375 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1376 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1377
1378 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1379 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1380 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1381 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1382 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1383 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1384
1385 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1386 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1387 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1388 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1389
1390 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1391 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1392 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1393 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1394 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1395 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1396 cache for all groups).
1397
1398
1399 @node Startup Files
1400 @section Startup Files
1401 @cindex startup files
1402 @cindex .newsrc
1403 @cindex .newsrc.el
1404 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1405
1406 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1407 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1408
1409 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1410 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1411 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1412 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1413 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1414 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1415 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1416
1417 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1418 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1419 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1420 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1421 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1422 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1423
1424 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1425 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1426 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1427 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1428 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1429 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1430 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1431 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1432 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1433 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1434
1435 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1436 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1437 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1438 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1439 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1440 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1441 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1442 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1443 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1444 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1445 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1446 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1447
1448 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1449 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1450 @vindex version-control
1451 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1452 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1453 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1454 If you want version control for this file, set
1455 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1456 @code{version-control} variable.
1457
1458 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1459 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1460 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1461 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1462 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1463 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1464 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1465 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1466 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1467 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1468
1469 @lisp
1470 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1471 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1472
1473 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1474 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1475 @end lisp
1476
1477 @vindex gnus-init-file
1478 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1479 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1480 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1481 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1482 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1483 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1484 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1485 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1486 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1487 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1488
1489
1490
1491 @node Auto Save
1492 @section Auto Save
1493 @cindex dribble file
1494 @cindex auto-save
1495
1496 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1497 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1498 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1499 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1500 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1501 this file.
1502
1503 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1504 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1505 saved.
1506
1507 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1508 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1509 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1510
1511 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1512 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1513 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1514 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1515 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1516 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1517
1518 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1519 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1520 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1521
1522
1523 @node The Active File
1524 @section The Active File
1525 @cindex active file
1526 @cindex ignored groups
1527
1528 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1529 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1530 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1531
1532 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1533 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1534 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1535 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1536 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1537 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1538 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1539
1540 @c This variable is
1541 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1542 @c if you set it to anything else.
1543
1544 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1545 @c @head
1546 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1547 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1548 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1549
1550 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1551 you actually subscribe to.
1552
1553 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1554 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1555 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1556 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1557
1558 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1559 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1560 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1561 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1562 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1563 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1564
1565 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1566 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1567 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1568 variable.
1569
1570 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1571 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1572 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1573 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1574 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1575 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1576
1577 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1578 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1579
1580 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1581 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1582
1583 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1584 secondary select methods.
1585
1586
1587 @node Startup Variables
1588 @section Startup Variables
1589
1590 @table @code
1591
1592 @item gnus-load-hook
1593 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1594 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1595 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1596 times you start Gnus.
1597
1598 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1600 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1601
1602 @item gnus-startup-hook
1603 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1604 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1605
1606 @item gnus-started-hook
1607 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1608 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1609 successfully.
1610
1611 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1612 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1613 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1614 generating the group buffer.
1615
1616 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1617 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1618 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1619 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1620 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1621 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1622 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1623 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1624
1625 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1626 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1627 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1628 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1629 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1630 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1631
1632 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1633 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1634 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1635
1636 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1637 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1638 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1639
1640 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1641 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1642 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1643 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1644
1645 @end table
1646
1647
1648 @node Group Buffer
1649 @chapter Group Buffer
1650 @cindex group buffer
1651
1652 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1653 @c
1654 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1655 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1656 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1657 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1658 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1659 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1660 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1661 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1662 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1663 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1664 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1665 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1666 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1667 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1668 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1669 @c human rights at 9...
1670
1671
1672 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1673 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1674 long as Gnus is active.
1675
1676 @iftex
1677 @iflatex
1678 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1679 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1680 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1681 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1682 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1683 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1684 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1685 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1686 }
1687 @end iflatex
1688 @end iftex
1689
1690 @menu
1691 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1692 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1693 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1694 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1695 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1696 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1697 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1698 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1699 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1700 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1701 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1702 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1703 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1704 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1705 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1706 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1707 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1708 @end menu
1709
1710
1711 @node Group Buffer Format
1712 @section Group Buffer Format
1713
1714 @menu
1715 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1716 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1717 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1718 @end menu
1719
1720
1721 @node Group Line Specification
1722 @subsection Group Line Specification
1723 @cindex group buffer format
1724
1725 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1726 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1727
1728 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1729
1730 @example
1731 25: news.announce.newusers
1732 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1733 @end example
1734
1735 Quite simple, huh?
1736
1737 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1738 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1739 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1740 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1741
1742 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1743 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1744 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1745 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1746 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1747 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1748
1749 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1750
1751 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1752 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1753 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1754 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1755 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1756
1757 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1758 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1759 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1760
1761 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1762
1763 @table @samp
1764
1765 @item M
1766 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1767
1768 @item S
1769 Whether the group is subscribed.
1770
1771 @item L
1772 Level of subscribedness.
1773
1774 @item N
1775 Number of unread articles.
1776
1777 @item I
1778 Number of dormant articles.
1779
1780 @item T
1781 Number of ticked articles.
1782
1783 @item R
1784 Number of read articles.
1785
1786 @item U
1787 Number of unseen articles.
1788
1789 @item t
1790 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1791 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1792
1793 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1794 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1795 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1796 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1797 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1798 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1799 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1800 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1801
1802 @item y
1803 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1804
1805 @item i
1806 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1807
1808 @item g
1809 Full group name.
1810
1811 @item G
1812 Group name.
1813
1814 @item C
1815 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1816 comment element in the group parameters.
1817
1818 @item D
1819 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1820 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1821 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1822 command.
1823
1824 @item o
1825 @samp{m} if moderated.
1826
1827 @item O
1828 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1829
1830 @item s
1831 Select method.
1832
1833 @item B
1834 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1835
1836 @item n
1837 Select from where.
1838
1839 @item z
1840 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1841 used.
1842
1843 @item P
1844 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1845
1846 @item c
1847 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1848 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1849 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1850 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1851 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1852
1853 @item m
1854 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1855 @cindex %
1856 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1857 the group lately.
1858
1859 @item p
1860 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1861
1862 @item d
1863 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1864 Timestamp}).
1865
1866 @item u
1867 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1868 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1869 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1870 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1871 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1872 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1873 specifier.
1874 @end table
1875
1876 @cindex *
1877 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1878 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1879 group, or a bogus native group.
1880
1881
1882 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1883 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1884 @cindex group mode line
1885
1886 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1887 The mode line can be changed by setting
1888 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1889 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1890
1891 @table @samp
1892 @item S
1893 The native news server.
1894 @item M
1895 The native select method.
1896 @end table
1897
1898
1899 @node Group Highlighting
1900 @subsection Group Highlighting
1901 @cindex highlighting
1902 @cindex group highlighting
1903
1904 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1905 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1906 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1907 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1908 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1909
1910 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1911 background is dark:
1912
1913 @lisp
1914 (cond (window-system
1915 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1916 (defface my-group-face-1
1917 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1918 (defface my-group-face-2
1919 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1920 "Second group face")
1921 (defface my-group-face-3
1922 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-4
1924 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-5
1926 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1927
1928 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1929 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1930 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1931 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1932 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1933 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1934 @end lisp
1935
1936 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1937
1938 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1939 include:
1940
1941 @table @code
1942 @item group
1943 The group name.
1944 @item unread
1945 The number of unread articles in the group.
1946 @item method
1947 The select method.
1948 @item mailp
1949 Whether the group is a mail group.
1950 @item level
1951 The level of the group.
1952 @item score
1953 The score of the group.
1954 @item ticked
1955 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1956 @item total
1957 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1958 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1959 @item topic
1960 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1961 topic being inserted.
1962 @end table
1963
1964 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1965 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1966 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1967
1968 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1969 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1970 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1971 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1972 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1973
1974
1975 @node Group Maneuvering
1976 @section Group Maneuvering
1977 @cindex group movement
1978
1979 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1980 expected, hopefully.
1981
1982 @table @kbd
1983
1984 @item n
1985 @kindex n (Group)
1986 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1987 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1988 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1989
1990 @item p
1991 @itemx DEL
1992 @kindex DEL (Group)
1993 @kindex p (Group)
1994 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1995 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1996 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1997
1998 @item N
1999 @kindex N (Group)
2000 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2001 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2002
2003 @item P
2004 @kindex P (Group)
2005 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2006 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2007
2008 @item M-n
2009 @kindex M-n (Group)
2010 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2011 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2012 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2013
2014 @item M-p
2015 @kindex M-p (Group)
2016 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2017 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2018 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2019 @end table
2020
2021 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2022
2023 @table @kbd
2024
2025 @item j
2026 @kindex j (Group)
2027 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2028 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2029 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2030 like living groups.
2031
2032 @item ,
2033 @kindex , (Group)
2034 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2035 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2036 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2037
2038 @item .
2039 @kindex . (Group)
2040 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2041 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2042 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2043 @end table
2044
2045 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2046 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2047 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2048 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2049 is @code{t}.
2050
2051
2052 @node Selecting a Group
2053 @section Selecting a Group
2054 @cindex group selection
2055
2056 @table @kbd
2057
2058 @item SPACE
2059 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2060 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2061 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2062 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2063 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2064 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2065 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2066 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2067 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2068 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2069
2070 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2071 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2072 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2073
2074 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2075 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2076 ones.
2077
2078 @item RET
2079 @kindex RET (Group)
2080 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2081 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2082 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2083 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2084 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2085 entry.
2086
2087 @item M-RET
2088 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2089 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2090 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2091 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2092 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2093 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2094 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2095 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2096 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2097 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2098
2099 @item M-SPACE
2100 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2101 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2102 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2103 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2104 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2105
2106 @item C-M-RET
2107 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2108 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2109 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2110 doing any processing of its contents
2111 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2112 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2113 manner will have no permanent effects.
2114
2115 @end table
2116
2117 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2118 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2119 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2120 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2121 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2122 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2123 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2124 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2125 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2126 most recently will be fetched.
2127
2128 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2129 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2130 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2131 newsgroups.
2132
2133 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2134 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2135 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2136 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2137 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2138 Which article this is is controlled by the
2139 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2140 variable is:
2141
2142 @table @code
2143
2144 @item unread
2145 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2146
2147 @item first
2148 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2149
2150 @item unseen
2151 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2152
2153 @item unseen-or-unread
2154 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2155 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2156 unread article.
2157
2158 @item best
2159 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2160
2161 @end table
2162
2163 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2164 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2165
2166 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2167 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2168 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2169 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2170 selected.
2171
2172
2173 @node Subscription Commands
2174 @section Subscription Commands
2175 @cindex subscription
2176
2177 @table @kbd
2178
2179 @item S t
2180 @itemx u
2181 @kindex S t (Group)
2182 @kindex u (Group)
2183 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2184 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2185 Toggle subscription to the current group
2186 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2187
2188 @item S s
2189 @itemx U
2190 @kindex S s (Group)
2191 @kindex U (Group)
2192 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2193 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2194 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2195 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2196
2197 @item S k
2198 @itemx C-k
2199 @kindex S k (Group)
2200 @kindex C-k (Group)
2201 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2202 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2203 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2204
2205 @item S y
2206 @itemx C-y
2207 @kindex S y (Group)
2208 @kindex C-y (Group)
2209 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2210 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2211
2212 @item C-x C-t
2213 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2214 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2215 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2216 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2217 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2218
2219 @item S w
2220 @itemx C-w
2221 @kindex S w (Group)
2222 @kindex C-w (Group)
2223 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2224 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2225
2226 @item S z
2227 @kindex S z (Group)
2228 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2229 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2230
2231 @item S C-k
2232 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2233 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2234 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2235 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2236 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2237 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2238 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2239 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2240 @file{.newsrc} file.
2241
2242 @end table
2243
2244 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2245
2246
2247 @node Group Data
2248 @section Group Data
2249
2250 @table @kbd
2251
2252 @item c
2253 @kindex c (Group)
2254 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2255 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2256 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2257 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2258 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2259 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2260 the group buffer.
2261
2262 @item C
2263 @kindex C (Group)
2264 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2265 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2266 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2267
2268 @item M-c
2269 @kindex M-c (Group)
2270 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2271 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2272 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2273
2274 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2275 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2276 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2277 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2278 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2279 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2280 caution.
2281
2282 @end table
2283
2284
2285 @node Group Levels
2286 @section Group Levels
2287 @cindex group level
2288 @cindex level
2289
2290 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2291 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2292 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2293 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2294 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2295
2296 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2297
2298 @table @kbd
2299
2300 @item S l
2301 @kindex S l (Group)
2302 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2303 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2304 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2305 prompted for a level.
2306 @end table
2307
2308 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2309 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2310 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2311 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2312 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2313 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2314 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2315 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2316 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2317 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2318 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2319 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2320 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2321 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2322 reasons of efficiency.
2323
2324 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2325 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2326
2327 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2328 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2329 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2330 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2331 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2332 groups are hidden, in a way.
2333
2334 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2335 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2336 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2337 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2338 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2339 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2340
2341 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2342 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2343 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2344 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2345 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2346 list of killed groups.)
2347
2348 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2349 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2350 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2351
2352 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2353 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2354 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2355 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2356 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2357 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2358 relevant valid ranges.
2359
2360 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2361 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2362 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2363 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2364 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2365 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2366 rest.
2367
2368 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2369 one with the best level.
2370
2371 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2372 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2373 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2374 by default.
2375
2376 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2377 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2378 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2379 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2380 listed.
2381
2382 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2383 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2384 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2385 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2386
2387 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2388 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2389 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2390 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2391 to 5. The default is 6.
2392
2393
2394 @node Group Score
2395 @section Group Score
2396 @cindex group score
2397 @cindex group rank
2398 @cindex rank
2399
2400 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2401 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2402 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2403 reason?
2404
2405 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2406 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2407 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2408 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2409 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2410 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2411 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2412 least significant part.))
2413
2414 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2415 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2416 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2417 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2418 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2419 action after each summary exit, you can add
2420 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2421 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2422 slow things down somewhat.
2423
2424
2425 @node Marking Groups
2426 @section Marking Groups
2427 @cindex marking groups
2428
2429 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2430 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2431 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2432 bidding on those groups.
2433
2434 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2435 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2436 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2437
2438 @table @kbd
2439
2440 @item #
2441 @kindex # (Group)
2442 @itemx M m
2443 @kindex M m (Group)
2444 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2445 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2446
2447 @item M-#
2448 @kindex M-# (Group)
2449 @itemx M u
2450 @kindex M u (Group)
2451 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2452 Remove the mark from the current group
2453 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2454
2455 @item M U
2456 @kindex M U (Group)
2457 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2458 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2459
2460 @item M w
2461 @kindex M w (Group)
2462 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2463 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2464
2465 @item M b
2466 @kindex M b (Group)
2467 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2468 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2469
2470 @item M r
2471 @kindex M r (Group)
2472 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2473 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2474 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2475 @end table
2476
2477 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2478
2479 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2480 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2481 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2482 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2483 the command to be executed.
2484
2485
2486 @node Foreign Groups
2487 @section Foreign Groups
2488 @cindex foreign groups
2489
2490 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2491 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2492 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2493 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2494 consulted.
2495
2496 @table @kbd
2497
2498 @item G m
2499 @kindex G m (Group)
2500 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2501 @cindex making groups
2502 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2503 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2504 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2505
2506 @item G M
2507 @kindex G M (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2509 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2510 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2511
2512 @item G r
2513 @kindex G r (Group)
2514 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2515 @cindex renaming groups
2516 Rename the current group to something else
2517 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2518 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2519 on some back ends.
2520
2521 @item G c
2522 @kindex G c (Group)
2523 @cindex customizing
2524 @findex gnus-group-customize
2525 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2526
2527 @item G e
2528 @kindex G e (Group)
2529 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2530 @cindex renaming groups
2531 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2532 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2533
2534 @item G p
2535 @kindex G p (Group)
2536 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2537 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2538 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2539
2540 @item G E
2541 @kindex G E (Group)
2542 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2543 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2544 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2545
2546 @item G d
2547 @kindex G d (Group)
2548 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2549 @cindex nndir
2550 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2551 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2552
2553 @item G h
2554 @kindex G h (Group)
2555 @cindex help group
2556 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2557 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2558
2559 @item G a
2560 @kindex G a (Group)
2561 @cindex (ding) archive
2562 @cindex archive group
2563 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2564 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2565 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2566 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2567 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2568 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2569 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2570
2571 @item G k
2572 @kindex G k (Group)
2573 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2574 @cindex nnkiboze
2575 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2576 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2577 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2578 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2579
2580 @item G D
2581 @kindex G D (Group)
2582 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2583 @cindex nneething
2584 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2585 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2586 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2587
2588 @item G f
2589 @kindex G f (Group)
2590 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2591 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2592 @cindex nndoc
2593 Make a group based on some file or other
2594 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2595 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2596 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2597 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2598 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2599 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2600 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2601 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2602 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2603
2604 @item G u
2605 @kindex G u (Group)
2606 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2607 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2608 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2609 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2610
2611 @item G w
2612 @kindex G w (Group)
2613 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2614 @cindex Google
2615 @cindex nnweb
2616 @cindex gmane
2617 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2618 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2619 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2620 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2621 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2622 @xref{Web Searches}.
2623
2624 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2625 to a particular group by using a match string like
2626 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2627
2628 @item G R
2629 @kindex G R (Group)
2630 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2631 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2632 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2633 @xref{RSS}.
2634
2635 @item G DEL
2636 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2637 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2638 This function will delete the current group
2639 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2640 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2641 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2642 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2643 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2644
2645 @item G V
2646 @kindex G V (Group)
2647 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2648 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2649 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2650
2651 @item G v
2652 @kindex G v (Group)
2653 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2654 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2655 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2656 @end table
2657
2658 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2659 methods.
2660
2661 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2662 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2663 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2664 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2665 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2666 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2667 newsgroups.
2668
2669
2670 @node Group Parameters
2671 @section Group Parameters
2672 @cindex group parameters
2673
2674 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2675 Here's an example group parameter list:
2676
2677 @example
2678 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2679 (auto-expire . t))
2680 @end example
2681
2682 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2683 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2684 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2685 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2686
2687 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2688 is an alist of regexps and values.
2689
2690 The following group parameters can be used:
2691
2692 @table @code
2693 @item to-address
2694 @cindex to-address
2695 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2696
2697 @example
2698 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2699 @end example
2700
2701 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2702 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2703 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2704 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2705 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2706
2707 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2708 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2709 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2710 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2711 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2712 list address instead.
2713
2714 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2715
2716 @item to-list
2717 @cindex to-list
2718 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2719
2720 @example
2721 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2722 @end example
2723
2724 It is totally ignored
2725 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2726 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2727
2728 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2729 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2730 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2731 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2732 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2733
2734 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2735 @cindex mail list groups
2736 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2737 entering summary buffer.
2738
2739 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2740
2741 @anchor{subscribed}
2742 @item subscribed
2743 @cindex subscribed
2744 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2745 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2746 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2747 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2748 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2749 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2750 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2751 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2752
2753 @lisp
2754 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2755 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2756 @end lisp
2757
2758 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2759 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2760
2761 @item visible
2762 @cindex visible
2763 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2764 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2765 of whether it has any unread articles.
2766
2767 @item broken-reply-to
2768 @cindex broken-reply-to
2769 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2770 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2771 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2772 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2773 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2774 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2775
2776 @item to-group
2777 @cindex to-group
2778 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2779 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2780
2781 @item newsgroup
2782 @cindex newsgroup
2783 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2784 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2785 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2786 news group.
2787
2788 @item gcc-self
2789 @cindex gcc-self
2790 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2791 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2792 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2793 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2794 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2795 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2796 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2797
2798 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2799 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2800 doesn't accept articles.
2801
2802 @item auto-expire
2803 @cindex auto-expire
2804 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2805 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2806 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2807
2808 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2809
2810 @item total-expire
2811 @cindex total-expire
2812 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2813 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2814 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2815 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2816 expiry.
2817
2818 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2819
2820 @item expiry-wait
2821 @cindex expiry-wait
2822 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2823 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2824 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2825 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2826 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2827 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2828 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2829
2830 @item expiry-target
2831 @cindex expiry-target
2832 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2833 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2834
2835 @item score-file
2836 @cindex score file group parameter
2837 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2838 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2839 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2840
2841 @item adapt-file
2842 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2843 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2844 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2845 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2846
2847 @item admin-address
2848 @cindex admin-address
2849 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2850 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2851 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2852 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2853
2854 @item display
2855 @cindex display
2856 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2857 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2858
2859 @table @code
2860 @item all
2861 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2862
2863 @item an integer
2864 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2865 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2866
2867 @item default
2868 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2869 ticked articles.
2870
2871 @item an array
2872 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2873
2874 Here are some examples:
2875
2876 @table @code
2877 @item [unread]
2878 Display only unread articles.
2879
2880 @item [not expire]
2881 Display everything except expirable articles.
2882
2883 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2884 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2885 responded to.
2886 @end table
2887
2888 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2889 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2890 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2891 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2892 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2893
2894 @end table
2895
2896 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2897 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2898 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2899
2900 @item comment
2901 @cindex comment
2902 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2903 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2904 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2905
2906 @item charset
2907 @cindex charset
2908 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2909 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2910 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2911
2912 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2913
2914 @item ignored-charsets
2915 @cindex ignored-charset
2916 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2917 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2918 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2919
2920 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2921
2922 @item posting-style
2923 @cindex posting-style
2924 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2925 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2926 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2927 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2928 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2929
2930 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2931 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2932 like this in the group parameters:
2933
2934 @example
2935 (posting-style
2936 (name "Funky Name")
2937 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2938 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2939 @end example
2940
2941 @item post-method
2942 @cindex post-method
2943 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2944 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2945
2946 @item banner
2947 @cindex banner
2948 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2949 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2950 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2951 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2952 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2953
2954 @item sieve
2955 @cindex sieve
2956 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2957 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2958 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2959 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2960
2961 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2962 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2963 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2964 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2965
2966 @example
2967 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2968 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2969 @}
2970 @end example
2971
2972 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2973 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2974
2975 @item (agent parameters)
2976 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2977 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2978 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2979 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2980 minimize the configuration effort.
2981
2982 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2983 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2984 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2985 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2986 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2987 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2988 @code{eval}ed there.
2989
2990 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2991 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2992 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2993 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2994 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
2995 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
2996 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
2997 @file{~/.gnus} file:
2998
2999 @lisp
3000 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3001 @end lisp
3002
3003 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3004 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3005 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3006
3007 @example
3008 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3009 @end example
3010
3011 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3012 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3013 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3014 into the group parameters for the group.
3015
3016 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you'd like.
3017 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
3018 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
3019 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
3020 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
3021
3022 @end table
3023
3024 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3025 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3026 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3027 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3028 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3029
3030 @vindex gnus-parameters
3031 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3032 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
3033 example:
3034
3035 @lisp
3036 (setq gnus-parameters
3037 '(("mail\\..*"
3038 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3039 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3040 (gnus-summary-line-format
3041 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3042 (gcc-self . t)
3043 (display . all))
3044
3045 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3046 (to-group . "\\1"))
3047
3048 ("mail\\.me"
3049 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3050
3051 ("list\\..*"
3052 (total-expire . t)
3053 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3054 @end lisp
3055
3056 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3057 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3058
3059
3060 @node Listing Groups
3061 @section Listing Groups
3062 @cindex group listing
3063
3064 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3065
3066 @table @kbd
3067
3068 @item l
3069 @itemx A s
3070 @kindex A s (Group)
3071 @kindex l (Group)
3072 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3073 List all groups that have unread articles
3074 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3075 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3076 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3077 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3078 groups).
3079
3080 @item L
3081 @itemx A u
3082 @kindex A u (Group)
3083 @kindex L (Group)
3084 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3085 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3086 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3087 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3088 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3089 unsubscribed groups).
3090
3091 @item A l
3092 @kindex A l (Group)
3093 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3094 List all unread groups on a specific level
3095 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3096 with no unread articles.
3097
3098 @item A k
3099 @kindex A k (Group)
3100 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3101 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3102 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3103 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3104 from the server.
3105
3106 @item A z
3107 @kindex A z (Group)
3108 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3109 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3110
3111 @item A m
3112 @kindex A m (Group)
3113 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3114 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3115 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3116
3117 @item A M
3118 @kindex A M (Group)
3119 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3120 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3121
3122 @item A A
3123 @kindex A A (Group)
3124 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3125 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3126 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3127 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3128 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3129 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3130 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3131 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3132
3133 @item A a
3134 @kindex A a (Group)
3135 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3136 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3137 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3138
3139 @item A d
3140 @kindex A d (Group)
3141 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3142 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3143 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3144
3145 @item A c
3146 @kindex A c (Group)
3147 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3148 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3149
3150 @item A ?
3151 @kindex A ? (Group)
3152 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3153 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3154
3155 @item A /
3156 @kindex A / (Group)
3157 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3158 List groups limited within the current selection
3159 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3160
3161 @item A f
3162 @kindex A f (Group)
3163 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3164 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3165
3166 @item A p
3167 @kindex A p (Group)
3168 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3169 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3170
3171 @end table
3172
3173 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3174 @cindex visible group parameter
3175 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3176 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3177 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3178 get the same effect.
3179
3180 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3181 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3182 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3183 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3184 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3185
3186
3187 @node Sorting Groups
3188 @section Sorting Groups
3189 @cindex sorting groups
3190
3191 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3192 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3193 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3194 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3195 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3196 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3197 include:
3198
3199 @table @code
3200
3201 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3202 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3203 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3204
3205 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3206 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3207 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3208
3209 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3210 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3211 Sort by group level.
3212
3213 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3214 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3215 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3216
3217 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3218 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3219 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3220 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3221
3222 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3224 Sort by number of unread articles.
3225
3226 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3227 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3228 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3229
3230 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3231 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3232 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3233
3234
3235 @end table
3236
3237 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3238 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3239 the last one.
3240
3241
3242 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3243 some sorting criteria:
3244
3245 @table @kbd
3246 @item G S a
3247 @kindex G S a (Group)
3248 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3249 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3250 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3251
3252 @item G S u
3253 @kindex G S u (Group)
3254 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3255 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3256 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3257
3258 @item G S l
3259 @kindex G S l (Group)
3260 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3261 Sort the group buffer by group level
3262 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3263
3264 @item G S v
3265 @kindex G S v (Group)
3266 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3267 Sort the group buffer by group score
3268 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3269
3270 @item G S r
3271 @kindex G S r (Group)
3272 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3273 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3274 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3275
3276 @item G S m
3277 @kindex G S m (Group)
3278 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3279 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3280 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3281
3282 @item G S n
3283 @kindex G S n (Group)
3284 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3285 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3286 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3287
3288 @end table
3289
3290 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3291 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3292
3293 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3294 commands will sort in reverse order.
3295
3296 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3297
3298 @table @kbd
3299 @item G P a
3300 @kindex G P a (Group)
3301 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3302 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3303 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3304
3305 @item G P u
3306 @kindex G P u (Group)
3307 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3308 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3309 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3310
3311 @item G P l
3312 @kindex G P l (Group)
3313 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3314 Sort the groups by group level
3315 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3316
3317 @item G P v
3318 @kindex G P v (Group)
3319 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3320 Sort the groups by group score
3321 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3322
3323 @item G P r
3324 @kindex G P r (Group)
3325 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3326 Sort the groups by group rank
3327 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3328
3329 @item G P m
3330 @kindex G P m (Group)
3331 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3332 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3333 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3334
3335 @item G P n
3336 @kindex G P n (Group)
3337 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3338 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3339 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3340
3341 @item G P s
3342 @kindex G P s (Group)
3343 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3344 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3345
3346 @end table
3347
3348 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3349 move groups around.
3350
3351
3352 @node Group Maintenance
3353 @section Group Maintenance
3354 @cindex bogus groups
3355
3356 @table @kbd
3357 @item b
3358 @kindex b (Group)
3359 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3360 Find bogus groups and delete them
3361 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3362
3363 @item F
3364 @kindex F (Group)
3365 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3366 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3367 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3368 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3369 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3370 zombies.
3371
3372 @item C-c C-x
3373 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3374 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3375 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3376 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3377 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3378 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3379
3380 @item C-c C-M-x
3381 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3382 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3383 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3384 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3385
3386 @end table
3387
3388
3389 @node Browse Foreign Server
3390 @section Browse Foreign Server
3391 @cindex foreign servers
3392 @cindex browsing servers
3393
3394 @table @kbd
3395 @item B
3396 @kindex B (Group)
3397 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3398 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3399 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3400 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3401 @end table
3402
3403 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3404 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3405 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3406 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3407
3408 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3409
3410 @table @kbd
3411 @item n
3412 @kindex n (Browse)
3413 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3414 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3415
3416 @item p
3417 @kindex p (Browse)
3418 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3419 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3420
3421 @item SPACE
3422 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3423 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3424 Enter the current group and display the first article
3425 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3426
3427 @item RET
3428 @kindex RET (Browse)
3429 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3430 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3431
3432 @item u
3433 @kindex u (Browse)
3434 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3435 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3436 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3437
3438 @item l
3439 @itemx q
3440 @kindex q (Browse)
3441 @kindex l (Browse)
3442 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3443 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3444
3445 @item d
3446 @kindex d (Browse)
3447 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3448 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3449
3450 @item ?
3451 @kindex ? (Browse)
3452 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3453 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3454 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3455 @end table
3456
3457
3458 @node Exiting Gnus
3459 @section Exiting Gnus
3460 @cindex exiting Gnus
3461
3462 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3463
3464 @table @kbd
3465 @item z
3466 @kindex z (Group)
3467 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3468 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3469 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3470 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3471
3472 @item q
3473 @kindex q (Group)
3474 @findex gnus-group-exit
3475 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3476 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3477
3478 @item Q
3479 @kindex Q (Group)
3480 @findex gnus-group-quit
3481 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3482 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3483 @end table
3484
3485 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3486 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3487 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3488 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3489 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3490 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3491 exiting Gnus.
3492
3493 Note:
3494
3495 @quotation
3496 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3497 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3498 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3499 plastic chair.
3500 @end quotation
3501
3502
3503 @node Group Topics
3504 @section Group Topics
3505 @cindex topics
3506
3507 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3508 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3509 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3510 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3511 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3512 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3513
3514 @iftex
3515 @iflatex
3516 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3517 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3518 }
3519 @end iflatex
3520 @end iftex
3521
3522 Here's an example:
3523
3524 @example
3525 Gnus
3526 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3527 3: comp.emacs
3528 2: alt.religion.emacs
3529 Naughty Emacs
3530 452: alt.sex.emacs
3531 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3532 Misc
3533 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3534 13: comp.sources.unix
3535 @end example
3536
3537 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3538 @kindex t (Group)
3539 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3540 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3541 is a toggling command.)
3542
3543 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3544 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3545 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3546 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3547 Hot and bothered?
3548
3549 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3550 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3551 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3552
3553 @lisp
3554 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3555 @end lisp
3556
3557 @menu
3558 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3559 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3560 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3561 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3562 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3563 @end menu
3564
3565
3566 @node Topic Commands
3567 @subsection Topic Commands
3568 @cindex topic commands
3569
3570 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3571 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3572 definitions slightly.
3573
3574 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3575 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3576 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3577 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3578 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3579 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3580
3581 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3582 the way you like.
3583
3584 @table @kbd
3585
3586 @item T n
3587 @kindex T n (Topic)
3588 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3589 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3590 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3591
3592 @item T TAB
3593 @itemx TAB
3594 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3595 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3596 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3597 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3598 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3599 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3600
3601 @item M-TAB
3602 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3603 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3604 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3605 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3606
3607 @end table
3608
3609 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3610 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3611 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3612 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3613
3614 @table @kbd
3615
3616 @item C-k
3617 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3618 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3619 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3620 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3621
3622 @item C-y
3623 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3624 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3625 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3626 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3627 before all groups.
3628
3629 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3630 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3631 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3632 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3633 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3634
3635 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3636 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3637
3638 @end table
3639
3640 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3641 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3642 key.
3643
3644 @table @kbd
3645
3646 @item RET
3647 @kindex RET (Topic)
3648 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3649 @itemx SPACE
3650 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3651 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3652 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3653 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3654 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3655 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3656
3657 @end table
3658
3659 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3660
3661 @table @kbd
3662
3663 @item T m
3664 @kindex T m (Topic)
3665 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3666 Move the current group to some other topic
3667 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3668 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3669
3670 @item T j
3671 @kindex T j (Topic)
3672 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3673 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3674
3675 @item T c
3676 @kindex T c (Topic)
3677 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3678 Copy the current group to some other topic
3679 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3680 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3681
3682 @item T h
3683 @kindex T h (Topic)
3684 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3685 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3686 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3687
3688 @item T s
3689 @kindex T s (Topic)
3690 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3691 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3692 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3693
3694 @item T D
3695 @kindex T D (Topic)
3696 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3697 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3698 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3699 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3700 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3701 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3702 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3703 topic.
3704
3705 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3706 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3707
3708 @item T M
3709 @kindex T M (Topic)
3710 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3711 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3712 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3713
3714 @item T C
3715 @kindex T C (Topic)
3716 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3717 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3718 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3719
3720 @item T H
3721 @kindex T H (Topic)
3722 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3723 Toggle hiding empty topics
3724 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3725
3726 @item T #
3727 @kindex T # (Topic)
3728 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3729 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3730 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3731 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3732
3733 @item T M-#
3734 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3735 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3736 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3737 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3738 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3739
3740 @item C-c C-x
3741 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3742 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3743 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3744 expiry process (if any)
3745 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3746
3747 @item T r
3748 @kindex T r (Topic)
3749 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3750 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3751
3752 @item T DEL
3753 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3754 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3755 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3756
3757 @item A T
3758 @kindex A T (Topic)
3759 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3760 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3761 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3762
3763 @item T M-n
3764 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3765 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3766 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3767
3768 @item T M-p
3769 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3770 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3771 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3772
3773 @item G p
3774 @kindex G p (Topic)
3775 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3776 @cindex group parameters
3777 @cindex topic parameters
3778 @cindex parameters
3779 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3780 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3781
3782 @end table
3783
3784
3785 @node Topic Variables
3786 @subsection Topic Variables
3787 @cindex topic variables
3788
3789 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3790 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3791
3792 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3793 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3794 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3795 Valid elements are:
3796
3797 @table @samp
3798 @item i
3799 Indentation.
3800 @item n
3801 Topic name.
3802 @item v
3803 Visibility.
3804 @item l
3805 Level.
3806 @item g
3807 Number of groups in the topic.
3808 @item a
3809 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3810 @item A
3811 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3812 @end table
3813
3814 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3815 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3816 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3817 The default is 2.
3818
3819 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3820 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3821
3822 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3823 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3824 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3825
3826
3827 @node Topic Sorting
3828 @subsection Topic Sorting
3829 @cindex topic sorting
3830
3831 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3832 commands:
3833
3834
3835 @table @kbd
3836 @item T S a
3837 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3838 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3839 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3840 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3841
3842 @item T S u
3843 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3844 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3845 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3846 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3847
3848 @item T S l
3849 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3850 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3851 Sort the current topic by group level
3852 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3853
3854 @item T S v
3855 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3856 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3857 Sort the current topic by group score
3858 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3859
3860 @item T S r
3861 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3862 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3863 Sort the current topic by group rank
3864 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3865
3866 @item T S m
3867 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3868 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3869 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3870 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3871
3872 @item T S e
3873 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3874 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3875 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3876 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3877
3878 @item T S s
3879 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3880 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3881 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3882 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3884
3885 @end table
3886
3887 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3888 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3889 sorting.
3890
3891
3892 @node Topic Topology
3893 @subsection Topic Topology
3894 @cindex topic topology
3895 @cindex topology
3896
3897 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3898
3899 @example
3900 @group
3901 Gnus
3902 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3903 3: comp.emacs
3904 2: alt.religion.emacs
3905 Naughty Emacs
3906 452: alt.sex.emacs
3907 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3908 Misc
3909 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3910 13: comp.sources.unix
3911 @end group
3912 @end example
3913
3914 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3915 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3916 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3917 follows:
3918
3919 @lisp
3920 (("Gnus" visible)
3921 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3922 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3923 (("Misc" visible)))
3924 @end lisp
3925
3926 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3927 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3928 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3929 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3930 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3931 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3932
3933 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3934 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3935 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3936
3937
3938 @node Topic Parameters
3939 @subsection Topic Parameters
3940 @cindex topic parameters
3941
3942 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3943 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3944 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3945 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3946 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3947
3948 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3949 parameters:
3950
3951 @table @code
3952 @item subscribe
3953 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3954 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3955 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3956 topic.
3957
3958 @item subscribe-level
3959 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3960 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3961 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3962
3963 @end table
3964
3965 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3966 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3967 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3968 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3969
3970 @example
3971 @group
3972 Gnus
3973 Emacs
3974 3: comp.emacs
3975 2: alt.religion.emacs
3976 452: alt.sex.emacs
3977 Relief
3978 452: alt.sex.emacs
3979 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3980 Misc
3981 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3982 13: comp.sources.unix
3983 452: alt.sex.emacs
3984 @end group
3985 @end example
3986
3987 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3988 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3989 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3990 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3991 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3992 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3993
3994 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3995 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3996 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
3997 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
3998 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
3999
4000 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4001 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4002 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4003 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4004 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4005 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4006 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4007 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4008
4009
4010 @node Misc Group Stuff
4011 @section Misc Group Stuff
4012
4013 @menu
4014 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4015 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4016 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4017 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4018 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4019 @end menu
4020
4021 @table @kbd
4022
4023 @item ^
4024 @kindex ^ (Group)
4025 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4026 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4027 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4028
4029 @item a
4030 @kindex a (Group)
4031 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4032 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4033 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4034 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4035 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4036 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4037 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4038
4039 @item m
4040 @kindex m (Group)
4041 @findex gnus-group-mail
4042 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4043 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4044 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4045 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4046
4047 @item i
4048 @kindex i (Group)
4049 @findex gnus-group-news
4050 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4051 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4052 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4053
4054 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4055 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4056 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4057 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4058 for this to work though.
4059
4060 @end table
4061
4062 Variables for the group buffer:
4063
4064 @table @code
4065
4066 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4067 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4068 is called after the group buffer has been
4069 created.
4070
4071 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4072 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4073 is called after the group buffer is
4074 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4075 unnatural way.
4076
4077 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4078 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4079 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4080 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4081
4082 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4083 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4084 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4085 whether they are empty or not.
4086
4087 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4088 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4089 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4090 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4091
4092 For example:
4093 @lisp
4094 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4095 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4096 @end lisp
4097
4098 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4099 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4100 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4101 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4102 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4103 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4104 default is @code{nil}.
4105
4106 For example:
4107 @lisp
4108 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4109 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4110 @end lisp
4111
4112 @end table
4113
4114 @node Scanning New Messages
4115 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4116 @cindex new messages
4117 @cindex scanning new news
4118
4119 @table @kbd
4120
4121 @item g
4122 @kindex g (Group)
4123 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4124 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4125 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4126 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4127 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4128 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4129 back end(s).
4130
4131 @item M-g
4132 @kindex M-g (Group)
4133 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4134 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4135 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4136 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4137 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4138 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4139 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4140
4141 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4142 @cindex activating groups
4143 @item C-c M-g
4144 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4145 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4146
4147 @item R
4148 @kindex R (Group)
4149 @cindex restarting
4150 @findex gnus-group-restart
4151 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4152 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4153 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4154
4155 @end table
4156
4157 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4158 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4159
4160 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4161 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4162 news.
4163
4164
4165 @node Group Information
4166 @subsection Group Information
4167 @cindex group information
4168 @cindex information on groups
4169
4170 @table @kbd
4171
4172
4173 @item H f
4174 @kindex H f (Group)
4175 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4176 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4177 @cindex FAQ
4178 @cindex ange-ftp
4179 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4180 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4181 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4182 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4183 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4184 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4185 used for fetching the file.
4186
4187 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4188 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4189
4190 @item H c
4191 @kindex H c (Group)
4192 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4193 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4194 @cindex charter
4195 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4196 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4197 prefix argument.
4198
4199 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4200 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4201 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4202
4203 @item H C
4204 @kindex H C (Group)
4205 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4206 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4207 @cindex control message
4208 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4209 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4210 group if given a prefix argument.
4211
4212 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4213 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4214 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4215 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4216
4217 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4218 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4219 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4220
4221 @item H d
4222 @itemx C-c C-d
4223 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4224 @kindex H d (Group)
4225 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4226 @cindex describing groups
4227 @cindex group description
4228 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4229 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4230 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4231
4232 @item M-d
4233 @kindex M-d (Group)
4234 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4235 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4236 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4237
4238 @item H v
4239 @itemx V
4240 @kindex V (Group)
4241 @kindex H v (Group)
4242 @cindex version
4243 @findex gnus-version
4244 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4245
4246 @item ?
4247 @kindex ? (Group)
4248 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4249 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4250
4251 @item C-c C-i
4252 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4253 @cindex info
4254 @cindex manual
4255 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4256 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4257 @end table
4258
4259
4260 @node Group Timestamp
4261 @subsection Group Timestamp
4262 @cindex timestamps
4263 @cindex group timestamps
4264
4265 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4266 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4267 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4268
4269 @lisp
4270 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4271 @end lisp
4272
4273 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4274
4275 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4276 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4277
4278 @lisp
4279 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4280 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4281 @end lisp
4282
4283 This will result in lines looking like:
4284
4285 @example
4286 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4287 0: custom 19961002T012713
4288 @end example
4289
4290 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4291 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4292 something like:
4293
4294 @lisp
4295 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4296 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4297 @end lisp
4298
4299 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4300 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4301 trick:
4302
4303 @lisp
4304 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4305 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4306 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4307 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4308 (if time
4309 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4310 "")))
4311 @end lisp
4312
4313
4314 @node File Commands
4315 @subsection File Commands
4316 @cindex file commands
4317
4318 @table @kbd
4319
4320 @item r
4321 @kindex r (Group)
4322 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4323 @vindex gnus-init-file
4324 @cindex reading init file
4325 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4326 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4327
4328 @item s
4329 @kindex s (Group)
4330 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4331 @cindex saving .newsrc
4332 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4333 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4334 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4335
4336 @c @item Z
4337 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4338 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4339 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4340
4341 @end table
4342
4343
4344 @node Sieve Commands
4345 @subsection Sieve Commands
4346 @cindex group sieve commands
4347
4348 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4349 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4350 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4351 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4352 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4353
4354 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4355 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4356 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4357 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4358 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4359 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4360 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4361 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4362 regenerate the Sieve script.
4363
4364 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4365 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4366 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4367 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4368 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4369 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4370 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4371 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4372 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4373 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4374
4375 @example
4376 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4377 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4378 stop;
4379 @}
4380 @end example
4381
4382 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4383
4384 @table @kbd
4385
4386 @item D g
4387 @kindex D g (Group)
4388 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4389 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4390 @cindex generating sieve script
4391 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4392 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4393
4394 @item D u
4395 @kindex D u (Group)
4396 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4397 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4398 @cindex updating sieve script
4399 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4400 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4401 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4402
4403 @end table
4404
4405
4406 @node Summary Buffer
4407 @chapter Summary Buffer
4408 @cindex summary buffer
4409
4410 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4411 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4412
4413 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4414 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4415
4416 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4417
4418 @menu
4419 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4420 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4421 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4422 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4423 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4424 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4425 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4426 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4427 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4428 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4429 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4430 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4431 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4432 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4433 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4434 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4435 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4436 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4437 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4438 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4439 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4440 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4441 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4442 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4443 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4444 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4445 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4446 or reselecting the current group.
4447 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4448 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4449 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4450 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4451 @end menu
4452
4453
4454 @node Summary Buffer Format
4455 @section Summary Buffer Format
4456 @cindex summary buffer format
4457
4458 @iftex
4459 @iflatex
4460 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4461 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4462 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4463 }
4464 @end iflatex
4465 @end iftex
4466
4467 @menu
4468 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4469 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4470 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4471 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4472 @end menu
4473
4474 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4475 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4476 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4477 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4478 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4479 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4480 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4481 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4482 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4483 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4484 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4485
4486 @lisp
4487 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4488 'mail-extract-address-components)
4489 @end lisp
4490
4491 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4492 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4493 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4494 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4495
4496
4497 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4498 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4499
4500 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4501 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4502 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4503 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4504 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4505
4506 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4507 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4508 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4509 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4510 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4511 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4512
4513 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4514
4515 The following format specification characters and extended format
4516 specification(s) are understood:
4517
4518 @table @samp
4519 @item N
4520 Article number.
4521 @item S
4522 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4523 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4524 @item s
4525 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4526 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4527 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4528 @item F
4529 Full @code{From} header.
4530 @item n
4531 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4532 @item f
4533 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4534 From Newsgroups}).
4535 @item a
4536 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4537 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4538 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4539 may be more thorough.
4540 @item A
4541 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4542 the @code{a} spec.
4543 @item L
4544 Number of lines in the article.
4545 @item c
4546 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4547 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4548 @item k
4549 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4550 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4551 @item I
4552 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4553 @item B
4554 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4555 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4556
4557 @example
4558 >
4559 +->
4560 | +->
4561 | | \->
4562 | | \->
4563 | \->
4564 +->
4565 \->
4566 @end example
4567
4568 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4569 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4570 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4571 line-drawing glyphs.
4572 @table @code
4573 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4574 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4575 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4576 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4577
4578 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4579 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4580 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4581 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4582
4583 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4584 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4585 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4586 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4587
4588 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4589 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4590 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4591
4592 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4593 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4594 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4595
4596 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4597 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4598 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4599
4600 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4601 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4602 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4603
4604 @end table
4605
4606 @item T
4607 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4608 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4609 @item [
4610 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4611 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4612 @item ]
4613 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4614 for adopted articles.
4615 @item >
4616 One space for each thread level.
4617 @item <
4618 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4619 @item U
4620 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4621
4622 @item R
4623 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4624 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4625 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4626
4627 @item i
4628 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4629 @item z
4630 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4631 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4632 default level. If the difference between
4633 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4634 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4635 @item V
4636 Total thread score.
4637 @item x
4638 @code{Xref}.
4639 @item D
4640 @code{Date}.
4641 @item d
4642 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4643 @item o
4644 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4645 @item M
4646 @code{Message-ID}.
4647 @item r
4648 @code{References}.
4649 @item t
4650 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4651 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4652 @item e
4653 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4654 article has any children.
4655 @item P
4656 The line number.
4657 @item O
4658 Download mark.
4659 @item &user-date;
4660 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4661 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4662 @item u
4663 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4664 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4665 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4666 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4667 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4668 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4669 @end table
4670
4671 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4672 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4673 There can only be one such area.
4674
4675 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4676 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4677 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4678 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4679 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4680 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4681
4682 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4683 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4684
4685 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4686
4687
4688 @node To From Newsgroups
4689 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4690 @cindex To
4691 @cindex Newsgroups
4692
4693 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4694 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4695 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4696 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4697 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4698
4699 @enumerate
4700 @item
4701 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4702 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4703 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4704 instance:
4705
4706 @lisp
4707 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4708 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4709 @end lisp
4710
4711 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4712 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4713
4714 @item
4715 @findex gnus-extra-header
4716 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4717 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4718 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4719
4720 @example
4721 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4722 @end example
4723
4724 @item
4725 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4726 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4727 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4728 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4729 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4730 headers are used instead.
4731
4732 @end enumerate
4733
4734 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4735 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4736 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4737 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4738 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4739 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4740 regeneration.
4741
4742 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4743 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4744 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4745 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4746
4747 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4748 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4749
4750 @lisp
4751 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4752 '(To Newsgroups))
4753 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4754 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4755 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4756 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4757 "Your Name Here")
4758 @end lisp
4759
4760 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4761 to fit your needs.)
4762
4763 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4764 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4765 support:
4766
4767 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4768 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4769 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4770
4771 @example
4772 Newsgroups:full
4773 @end example
4774
4775 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4776 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4777
4778
4779 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4780 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4781
4782 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4783 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4784 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4785 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4786
4787 Here are the elements you can play with:
4788
4789 @table @samp
4790 @item G
4791 Group name.
4792 @item p
4793 Unprefixed group name.
4794 @item A
4795 Current article number.
4796 @item z
4797 Current article score.
4798 @item V
4799 Gnus version.
4800 @item U
4801 Number of unread articles in this group.
4802 @item e
4803 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4804 summary buffer.
4805 @item Z
4806 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4807 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4808 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4809 and no unselected ones.
4810 @item g
4811 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4812 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4813 @item S
4814 Subject of the current article.
4815 @item u
4816 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4817 @item s
4818 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4819 @item d
4820 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4821 @item t
4822 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4823 @item r
4824 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4825 @item E
4826 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4827 @end table
4828
4829
4830 @node Summary Highlighting
4831 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4832
4833 @table @code
4834
4835 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4836 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4837 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4838 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4839 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4840
4841 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4842 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4843 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4844 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4845
4846 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4847 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4848 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4849 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4850
4851 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4852 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4853 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4854 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4855 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4856 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4857 to something like
4858 @lisp
4859 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4860 ((> score default) . bold))
4861 @end lisp
4862 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4863 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4864 @end table
4865
4866
4867 @node Summary Maneuvering
4868 @section Summary Maneuvering
4869 @cindex summary movement
4870
4871 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4872 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4873
4874 None of these commands select articles.
4875
4876 @table @kbd
4877 @item G M-n
4878 @itemx M-n
4879 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4880 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4881 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4882 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4883 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4884
4885 @item G M-p
4886 @itemx M-p
4887 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4888 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4889 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4890 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4891 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4892
4893 @item G g
4894 @kindex G g (Summary)
4895 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4896 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4897 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4898 @end table
4899
4900 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4901 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4902 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4903 to the group buffer.
4904
4905 Variables related to summary movement:
4906
4907 @table @code
4908
4909 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4910 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4911 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4912 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4913 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4914 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4915 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4916 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4917 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4918 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4919 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4920 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4921 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4922 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4923
4924 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4925 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4926 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4927 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4928 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4929 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4930 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4931
4932 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4933
4934 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4935 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4936 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4937 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4938 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4939
4940 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4941 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4942 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4943 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4944 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4945 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4946 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4947 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4948 threads.
4949
4950 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4951 the given number of lines from the top.
4952
4953 @end table
4954
4955
4956 @node Choosing Articles
4957 @section Choosing Articles
4958 @cindex selecting articles
4959
4960 @menu
4961 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4962 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4963 @end menu
4964
4965
4966 @node Choosing Commands
4967 @subsection Choosing Commands
4968
4969 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4970 and they all select and display an article.
4971
4972 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4973 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4974
4975 @table @kbd
4976 @item SPACE
4977 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4978 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4979 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4980 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4981
4982 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
4983 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
4984 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
4985
4986 @item G n
4987 @itemx n
4988 @kindex n (Summary)
4989 @kindex G n (Summary)
4990 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4991 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4992 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4993
4994 @item G p
4995 @itemx p
4996 @kindex p (Summary)
4997 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
4998 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
4999 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5000
5001 @item G N
5002 @itemx N
5003 @kindex N (Summary)
5004 @kindex G N (Summary)
5005 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5006 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5007
5008 @item G P
5009 @itemx P
5010 @kindex P (Summary)
5011 @kindex G P (Summary)
5012 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5013 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5014
5015 @item G C-n
5016 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5017 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5018 Go to the next article with the same subject
5019 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5020
5021 @item G C-p
5022 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5023 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5024 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5025 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5026
5027 @item G f
5028 @itemx .
5029 @kindex G f (Summary)
5030 @kindex . (Summary)
5031 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5032 Go to the first unread article
5033 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5034
5035 @item G b
5036 @itemx ,
5037 @kindex G b (Summary)
5038 @kindex , (Summary)
5039 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5040 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5041 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5042 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5043
5044 @item G l
5045 @itemx l
5046 @kindex l (Summary)
5047 @kindex G l (Summary)
5048 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5049 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5050
5051 @item G o
5052 @kindex G o (Summary)
5053 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5054 @cindex history
5055 @cindex article history
5056 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5057 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5058 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5059 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5060 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5061 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5062
5063 @item G j
5064 @itemx j
5065 @kindex j (Summary)
5066 @kindex G j (Summary)
5067 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5068 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5069 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5070
5071 @end table
5072
5073
5074 @node Choosing Variables
5075 @subsection Choosing Variables
5076
5077 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5078
5079 @table @code
5080 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5081 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5082 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5083 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5084 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5085 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5086
5087 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5088 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5089 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
5090 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article. If you would
5091 like each article to be saved in the Agent as you read it, putting
5092 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this hook will do so.
5093
5094 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5095 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5096 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5097 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5098 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5099 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5100 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5101 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5102 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
5103 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5104 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5105 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5106 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5107 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5108
5109 @end table
5110
5111
5112 @node Paging the Article
5113 @section Scrolling the Article
5114 @cindex article scrolling
5115
5116 @table @kbd
5117
5118 @item SPACE
5119 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5120 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5121 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5122 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5123 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5124
5125 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5126 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5127 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5128 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5129 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5130 what is considered uninteresting with
5131 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5132 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5133
5134 @item DEL
5135 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5136 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5137 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5138
5139 @item RET
5140 @kindex RET (Summary)
5141 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5142 Scroll the current article one line forward
5143 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5144
5145 @item M-RET
5146 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5147 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5148 Scroll the current article one line backward
5149 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5150
5151 @item A g
5152 @itemx g
5153 @kindex A g (Summary)
5154 @kindex g (Summary)
5155 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5156 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5157 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5158 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5159 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5160 the way it came from the server.
5161
5162 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5163 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5164 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5165
5166 @lisp
5167 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5168 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5169 (2 . big5)))
5170 @end lisp
5171
5172 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5173
5174 @item A <
5175 @itemx <
5176 @kindex < (Summary)
5177 @kindex A < (Summary)
5178 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5179 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5180 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5181
5182 @item A >
5183 @itemx >
5184 @kindex > (Summary)
5185 @kindex A > (Summary)
5186 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5187 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5188
5189 @item A s
5190 @itemx s
5191 @kindex A s (Summary)
5192 @kindex s (Summary)
5193 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5194 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5195 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5196
5197 @item h
5198 @kindex h (Summary)
5199 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5200 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5201
5202 @end table
5203
5204
5205 @node Reply Followup and Post
5206 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5207
5208 @menu
5209 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5210 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5211 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5212 * Canceling and Superseding::
5213 @end menu
5214
5215
5216 @node Summary Mail Commands
5217 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5218 @cindex mail
5219 @cindex composing mail
5220
5221 Commands for composing a mail message:
5222
5223 @table @kbd
5224
5225 @item S r
5226 @itemx r
5227 @kindex S r (Summary)
5228 @kindex r (Summary)
5229 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5230 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5231 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5232 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5233 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5234
5235 @item S R
5236 @itemx R
5237 @kindex R (Summary)
5238 @kindex S R (Summary)
5239 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5240 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5241 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5242 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5243 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5244
5245 @item S w
5246 @kindex S w (Summary)
5247 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5248 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5249 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5250 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5251 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5252 present, that's used instead.
5253
5254 @item S W
5255 @kindex S W (Summary)
5256 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5257 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5258 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5259 the process/prefix convention.
5260
5261 @item S v
5262 @kindex S v (Summary)
5263 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5264 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5265 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5266 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5267 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5268 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5269
5270 @item S V
5271 @kindex S V (Summary)
5272 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5273 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5274 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5275 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5276
5277 @item S B r
5278 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5279 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5280 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5281 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5282 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5283 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5284 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5285 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5286
5287 @item S B R
5288 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5289 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5290 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5291 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5292 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5293
5294 @item S o m
5295 @itemx C-c C-f
5296 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5297 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5298 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5299 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5300 Forward the current article to some other person
5301 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5302 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5303 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5304 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5305 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5306 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5307 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5308 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5309 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5310 section.
5311
5312 @item S m
5313 @itemx m
5314 @kindex m (Summary)
5315 @kindex S m (Summary)
5316 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5317 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5318 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5319 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5320 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5321
5322 @item S i
5323 @itemx i
5324 @kindex i (Summary)
5325 @kindex S i (Summary)
5326 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5327 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5328 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5329 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5330
5331 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5332 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5333 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5334 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5335 for this to work though.
5336
5337 @item S D b
5338 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5339 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5340 @cindex bouncing mail
5341 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5342 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5343 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5344 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5345 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5346 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5347 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5348 very well fail, though.
5349
5350 @item S D r
5351 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5352 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5353 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5354 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5355 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5356 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5357 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5358 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5359 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5360 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5361
5362 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5363 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5364 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5365 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5366 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5367
5368 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5369 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5370
5371 @item S O m
5372 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5373 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5374 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5375 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5376 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5377
5378 @item S M-c
5379 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5380 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5381 @cindex crossposting
5382 @cindex excessive crossposting
5383 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5384 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5385
5386 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5387 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5388 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5389 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5390 command understands the process/prefix convention
5391 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5392
5393 @end table
5394
5395 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5396 Manual}, for more information.
5397
5398
5399 @node Summary Post Commands
5400 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5401 @cindex post
5402 @cindex composing news
5403
5404 Commands for posting a news article:
5405
5406 @table @kbd
5407 @item S p
5408 @itemx a
5409 @kindex a (Summary)
5410 @kindex S p (Summary)
5411 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5412 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5413 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5414 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5415 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5416
5417 @item S f
5418 @itemx f
5419 @kindex f (Summary)
5420 @kindex S f (Summary)
5421 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5422 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5423 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5424
5425 @item S F
5426 @itemx F
5427 @kindex S F (Summary)
5428 @kindex F (Summary)
5429 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5430 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5431 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5432 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5433 process/prefix convention.
5434
5435 @item S n
5436 @kindex S n (Summary)
5437 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5438 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5439 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5440
5441 @item S N
5442 @kindex S N (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5444 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5445 message through mail and include the original message
5446 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5447 the process/prefix convention.
5448
5449 @item S o p
5450 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5451 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5452 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5453 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5454 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5455 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5456 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5457 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5458 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5459 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5460 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5461 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5462 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5463
5464 @item S O p
5465 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5466 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5467 @cindex digests
5468 @cindex making digests
5469 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5470 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
5471 process/prefix convention.
5472
5473 @item S u
5474 @kindex S u (Summary)
5475 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5476 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5477 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5478 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5479 @end table
5480
5481 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5482 Manual}, for more information.
5483
5484
5485 @node Summary Message Commands
5486 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5487
5488 @table @kbd
5489 @item S y
5490 @kindex S y (Summary)
5491 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5492 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5493 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5494 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5495 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5496
5497 @end table
5498
5499
5500 @node Canceling and Superseding
5501 @subsection Canceling Articles
5502 @cindex canceling articles
5503 @cindex superseding articles
5504
5505 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5506 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5507
5508 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5509
5510 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5511 @kindex C (Summary)
5512 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5513 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5514 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5515 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5516 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5517 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5518
5519 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5520 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5521 question.
5522
5523 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5524 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5525 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5526
5527 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5528 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5529 message, Message Manual}).
5530
5531 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5532 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5533 your original article.
5534
5535 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5536 @kindex S (Summary)
5537 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5538 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5539 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5540 usual way.
5541
5542 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5543 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5544 have posted almost the same article twice.
5545
5546 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5547 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5548 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5549 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5550 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5551 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5552 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5553 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5554 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5555 canceled/superseded.
5556
5557 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5558
5559 @node Delayed Articles
5560 @section Delayed Articles
5561 @cindex delayed sending
5562 @cindex send delayed
5563
5564 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5565 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5566 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5567 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5568
5569 @lisp
5570 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5571 @end lisp
5572
5573 @findex gnus-delay-article
5574 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5575 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5576 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5577 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5578
5579 @itemize @bullet
5580 @item
5581 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5582 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5583 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5584 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5585
5586 @item
5587 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5588 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5589 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5590
5591 @item
5592 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5593 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5594 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5595 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5596 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5597 that means a time tomorrow.
5598 @end itemize
5599
5600 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5601 couple of variables:
5602
5603 @table @code
5604 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5605 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5606 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5607 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5608
5609 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5610 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5611 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5612 formats described above.
5613
5614 @item gnus-delay-group
5615 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5616 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5617 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5618 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5619
5620 @item gnus-delay-header
5621 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5622 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5623 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5624 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5625 @end table
5626
5627 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5628 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5629 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5630 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5631 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5632
5633 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5634 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5635 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5636 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5637 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5638 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5639 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5640
5641 @table @code
5642 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5643 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5644 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5645 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5646 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5647 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5648 argument is ignored.
5649
5650 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5651 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5652 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5653 @end table
5654
5655
5656 @node Marking Articles
5657 @section Marking Articles
5658 @cindex article marking
5659 @cindex article ticking
5660 @cindex marks
5661
5662 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5663
5664 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5665 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5666 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5667
5668 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5669
5670 @menu
5671 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5672 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5673 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5674 @end menu
5675
5676 @ifinfo
5677 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
5678 @end ifinfo
5679
5680 @menu
5681 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5682 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5683 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5684 @end menu
5685
5686
5687 @node Unread Articles
5688 @subsection Unread Articles
5689
5690 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5691 other.
5692
5693 @table @samp
5694 @item !
5695 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5696 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5697
5698 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5699 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5700 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5701 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5702 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5703 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5704 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5705
5706 @item ?
5707 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5708 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5709
5710 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5711 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5712 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5713 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5714 messages.
5715
5716 @item SPACE
5717 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5718 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5719
5720 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5721 @end table
5722
5723
5724 @node Read Articles
5725 @subsection Read Articles
5726 @cindex expirable mark
5727
5728 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5729
5730 @table @samp
5731
5732 @item r
5733 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5734 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5735 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5736
5737 @item R
5738 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5739 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5740
5741 @item O
5742 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5743 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5744 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5745
5746 @item K
5747 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5748 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5749
5750 @item X
5751 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5752 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5753
5754 @item Y
5755 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5756 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5757
5758 @item C
5759 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5760 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5761
5762 @item G
5763 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5764 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5765
5766 @item F
5767 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5768 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5769
5770 @item Q
5771 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5772 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5773 Threading}.
5774
5775 @item M
5776 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5777 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5778 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5779
5780 @end table
5781
5782 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5783 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5784
5785 One more special mark, though:
5786
5787 @table @samp
5788 @item E
5789 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5790 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5791
5792 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5793 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5794 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5795 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5796 any time.
5797 @end table
5798
5799
5800 @node Other Marks
5801 @subsection Other Marks
5802 @cindex process mark
5803 @cindex bookmarks
5804
5805 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5806 read or not.
5807
5808 @itemize @bullet
5809
5810 @item
5811 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5812 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5813 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5814 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5815 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5816
5817 @item
5818 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5819 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5820 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5821 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5822
5823 @item
5824 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5825 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5826 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5827
5828 @item
5829 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5830 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5831 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5832
5833 @item
5834 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5835 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5836 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5837 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5838
5839 @item
5840 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5841 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5842 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5843 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5844 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5845 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5846
5847 @item
5848 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5849 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5850 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5851 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5852
5853 @item
5854 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5855 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5856 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5857 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5858 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5859 use.)
5860
5861 @item
5862 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5863 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5864 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5865 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5866 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5867 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5868
5869 @item
5870 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5871 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5872 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5873 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5874 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5875 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5876 use.)
5877
5878 @item
5879 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5880 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5881 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5882 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5883 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5884
5885 @item
5886 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5887 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5888 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5889 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5890 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5891 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5892
5893 @end itemize
5894
5895 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5896 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5897 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5898
5899 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5900 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5901 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5902
5903
5904 @node Setting Marks
5905 @subsection Setting Marks
5906 @cindex setting marks
5907
5908 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5909
5910 @table @kbd
5911 @item M c
5912 @itemx M-u
5913 @kindex M c (Summary)
5914 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5915 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5916 @cindex mark as unread
5917 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5918 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5919 article as unread.
5920
5921 @item M t
5922 @itemx !
5923 @kindex ! (Summary)
5924 @kindex M t (Summary)
5925 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5926 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5927 @xref{Article Caching}.
5928
5929 @item M ?
5930 @itemx ?
5931 @kindex ? (Summary)
5932 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5933 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5934 Mark the current article as dormant
5935 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5936
5937 @item M d
5938 @itemx d
5939 @kindex M d (Summary)
5940 @kindex d (Summary)
5941 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5942 Mark the current article as read
5943 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5944
5945 @item D
5946 @kindex D (Summary)
5947 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5948 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5949 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5950
5951 @item M k
5952 @itemx k
5953 @kindex k (Summary)
5954 @kindex M k (Summary)
5955 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5956 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5957 and then select the next unread article
5958 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5959
5960 @item M K
5961 @itemx C-k
5962 @kindex M K (Summary)
5963 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5964 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5965 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5966 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5967
5968 @item M C
5969 @kindex M C (Summary)
5970 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5971 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5972 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5973
5974 @item M C-c
5975 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5976 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5977 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5978 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5979
5980 @item M H
5981 @kindex M H (Summary)
5982 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5983 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
5984 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5985
5986 @item M h
5987 @kindex M h (Summary)
5988 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
5989 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
5990 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
5991
5992 @item C-w
5993 @kindex C-w (Summary)
5994 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
5995 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
5996 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
5997
5998 @item M V k
5999 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6000 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6001 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6002 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6003
6004 @item M e
6005 @itemx E
6006 @kindex M e (Summary)
6007 @kindex E (Summary)
6008 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6009 Mark the current article as expirable
6010 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6011
6012 @item M b
6013 @kindex M b (Summary)
6014 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6015 Set a bookmark in the current article
6016 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6017
6018 @item M B
6019 @kindex M B (Summary)
6020 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6021 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6022 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6023
6024 @item M V c
6025 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6026 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6027 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6028 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6029
6030 @item M V u
6031 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6032 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6033 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6034 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6035
6036 @item M V m
6037 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6038 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6039 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6040 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6041 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6042 @end table
6043
6044 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6045 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6046 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6047 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6048 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6049 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6050 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6051 The default is @code{t}.
6052
6053
6054 @node Generic Marking Commands
6055 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6056
6057 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6058 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6059 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6060 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6061 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6062 well.
6063
6064 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6065 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6066 command should do.
6067
6068 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6069 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6070 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6071 to list in this manual.
6072
6073 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6074 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6075 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6076 article, you could say something like:
6077
6078 @lisp
6079 @group
6080 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6081 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6082 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6083 @end group
6084 @end lisp
6085
6086 @noindent
6087 or
6088
6089 @lisp
6090 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6091 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6092 @end lisp
6093
6094
6095 @node Setting Process Marks
6096 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6097 @cindex setting process marks
6098
6099 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6100 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6101 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6102 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6103 commands into the cache. For more information,
6104 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6105
6106 @table @kbd
6107
6108 @item M P p
6109 @itemx #
6110 @kindex # (Summary)
6111 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6112 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6113 Mark the current article with the process mark
6114 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6115 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6116
6117 @item M P u
6118 @itemx M-#
6119 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6120 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6121 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6122 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6123
6124 @item M P U
6125 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6126 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6127 Remove the process mark from all articles
6128 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6129
6130 @item M P i
6131 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6132 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6133 Invert the list of process marked articles
6134 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6135
6136 @item M P R
6137 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6138 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6139 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6140 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6141
6142 @item M P G
6143 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6144 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6145 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6146 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6147
6148 @item M P r
6149 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6150 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6151 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6152
6153 @item M P g
6154 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6155 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6156 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6157
6158 @item M P t
6159 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6160 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6161 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6162 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6163
6164 @item M P T
6165 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6166 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6167 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6168 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6169
6170 @item M P v
6171 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6172 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6173 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6174 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6175
6176 @item M P s
6177 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6178 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6179 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6180
6181 @item M P S
6182 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6183 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6184 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6185 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6186
6187 @item M P a
6188 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6189 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6190 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6191
6192 @item M P b
6193 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6194 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6195 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6196 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6197
6198 @item M P k
6199 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6200 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6201 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6202 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6203
6204 @item M P y
6205 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6206 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6207 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6208 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6209
6210 @item M P w
6211 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6212 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6213 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6214 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6215
6216 @end table
6217
6218 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6219 set process marks based on article body contents.
6220
6221
6222 @node Limiting
6223 @section Limiting
6224 @cindex limiting
6225
6226 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6227 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6228 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6229 buffer.
6230
6231 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6232 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6233 additional articles.
6234
6235 @table @kbd
6236
6237 @item / /
6238 @itemx / s
6239 @kindex / / (Summary)
6240 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6241 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6242 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6243 matching articles.
6244
6245 @item / a
6246 @kindex / a (Summary)
6247 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6248 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6249 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6250 matching articles.
6251
6252 @item / x
6253 @kindex / x (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6255 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6256 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6257 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6258 matching articles.
6259
6260 @item / u
6261 @itemx x
6262 @kindex / u (Summary)
6263 @kindex x (Summary)
6264 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6265 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6266 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6267 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6268 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6269
6270 @item / m
6271 @kindex / m (Summary)
6272 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6273 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6274 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6275
6276 @item / t
6277 @kindex / t (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6279 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6281 articles younger than that number of days.
6282
6283 @item / n
6284 @kindex / n (Summary)
6285 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6286 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6287 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6288 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6289
6290 @item / w
6291 @kindex / w (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6293 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6294 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6295 the stack.
6296
6297 @item / .
6298 @kindex / . (Summary)
6299 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6300 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6301 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6302
6303 @item / v
6304 @kindex / v (Summary)
6305 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6306 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6307 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6308
6309 @item / p
6310 @kindex / p (Summary)
6311 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6312 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6313 group parameter predicate
6314 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6315 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6316
6317 @item / E
6318 @itemx M S
6319 @kindex M S (Summary)
6320 @kindex / E (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6322 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6324
6325 @item / D
6326 @kindex / D (Summary)
6327 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6328 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6329 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6330
6331 @item / *
6332 @kindex / * (Summary)
6333 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6334 Include all cached articles in the limit
6335 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6336
6337 @item / d
6338 @kindex / d (Summary)
6339 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6340 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6341 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6342
6343 @item / M
6344 @kindex / M (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6346 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6347
6348 @item / T
6349 @kindex / T (Summary)
6350 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6351 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6352
6353 @item / c
6354 @kindex / c (Summary)
6355 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6356 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6357 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6358
6359 @item / C
6360 @kindex / C (Summary)
6361 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6362 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6363 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6364 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6365
6366 @item / N
6367 @kindex / N (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6369 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6370 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6371
6372 @item / o
6373 @kindex / o (Summary)
6374 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6375 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6376 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6377
6378 @end table
6379
6380
6381 @node Threading
6382 @section Threading
6383 @cindex threading
6384 @cindex article threading
6385
6386 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6387 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6388 hierarchical fashion.
6389
6390 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6391 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6392 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6393 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6394 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6395 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6396 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6397
6398 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6399
6400 @table @dfn
6401 @item root
6402 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6403
6404 @item thread
6405 A tree-like article structure.
6406
6407 @item sub-thread
6408 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6409
6410 @item loose threads
6411 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6412 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6413 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6414 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6415 called loose threads.
6416
6417 @item thread gathering
6418 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6419
6420 @item sparse threads
6421 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6422 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6423
6424 @end table
6425
6426
6427 @menu
6428 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6429 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6430 @end menu
6431
6432
6433 @node Customizing Threading
6434 @subsection Customizing Threading
6435 @cindex customizing threading
6436
6437 @menu
6438 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6439 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6440 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6441 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6442 @end menu
6443
6444
6445 @node Loose Threads
6446 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6447 @cindex <
6448 @cindex >
6449 @cindex loose threads
6450
6451 @table @code
6452 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6453 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6454 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6455 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6456 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6457 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6458
6459 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6460 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6461 There are four possible values:
6462
6463 @iftex
6464 @iflatex
6465 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6466 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6467 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6468 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6469 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6470 }
6471 @end iflatex
6472 @end iftex
6473
6474 @cindex adopting articles
6475
6476 @table @code
6477
6478 @item adopt
6479 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6480 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6481 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6482 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6483
6484 @item dummy
6485 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6486 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6487 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6488 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6489 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6490 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6491 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6492 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6493 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6494 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6495
6496 @item empty
6497 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6498 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6499 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6500 Buffer Format}).)
6501
6502 @item none
6503 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6504 display them after one another.
6505
6506 @item nil
6507 Don't gather loose threads.
6508 @end table
6509
6510 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6511 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6512 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6513 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6514 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6515 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6516 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6517 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6518 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6519 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6520 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6521
6522 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6523 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6524 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6525 Matching}).
6526
6527 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6528 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6529 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6530 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6531 simplification is used.
6532
6533 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6534 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6535 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6536 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6537
6538 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6539 @lisp
6540 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6541 (concat
6542 "\\`\\[?\\("
6543 (mapconcat
6544 'identity
6545 '("looking"
6546 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6547 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6548 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6549 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6550 ;; ...
6551 )
6552 "\\|")
6553 "\\)\\s *\\("
6554 (mapconcat 'identity
6555 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6556 "\\|")
6557 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6558 @end lisp
6559
6560 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6561 subjects.
6562
6563 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6564 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6565 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6566 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6567 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6568 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6569
6570 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6571
6572 @table @code
6573 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6574 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6575 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6576
6577 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6578 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6579 Simplify fuzzily.
6580
6581 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6582 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6583 Remove excessive whitespace.
6584
6585 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6586 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6587 Remove all whitespace.
6588 @end table
6589
6590 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6591
6592
6593 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6594 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6595 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6596 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6597 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6598 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6599 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6600 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6601
6602 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6603 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6604 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6605 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6606 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6607 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6608 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6609 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6610 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6611 cholera:
6612
6613 @table @code
6614 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6615 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6616 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6617 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6618
6619 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6620 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6621 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6622 @end table
6623
6624 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6625 something like:
6626
6627 @lisp
6628 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6629 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6630 @end lisp
6631
6632 @end table
6633
6634
6635 @node Filling In Threads
6636 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6637
6638 @table @code
6639 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6640 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6641 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6642 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6643 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6644 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6645 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6646 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6647 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6648 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6649 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6650 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6651 do about that.
6652
6653 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6654 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6655 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6656
6657 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6658 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6659 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6660 newsgroups.
6661
6662 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6663 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6664 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6665 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6666 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6667 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6668 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6669 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6670 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6671 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6672 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6673 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6674 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6675 @code{nil} by default.
6676
6677 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6678 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6679 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6680 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6681 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6682 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6683 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6684
6685 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6686 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6687 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6688
6689 @end table
6690
6691
6692 @node More Threading
6693 @subsubsection More Threading
6694
6695 @table @code
6696 @item gnus-show-threads
6697 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6698 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6699 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6700 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6701 slower and more awkward.
6702
6703 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6704 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6705 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6706 generated.
6707
6708 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6709 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6710 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6711
6712 Here's an example:
6713
6714 @lisp
6715 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6716 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6717 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6718 @end lisp
6719
6720 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6721 unread, but you get my drift.)
6722
6723
6724 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6725 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6726 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6727 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6728 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6729 threads are expunged.
6730
6731 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6732 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6733 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6734 will be hidden.
6735
6736 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6737 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6738 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6739 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6740 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6741 result in a new thread.
6742
6743 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6744 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6745 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6746 The default is 4.
6747
6748 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6749 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6750 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6751 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6752 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6753 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6754 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6755 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6756 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6757 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6758 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6759
6760 @end table
6761
6762
6763 @node Low-Level Threading
6764 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6765
6766 @table @code
6767
6768 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6769 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6770 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6771
6772 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6773 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6774 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6775 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6776 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6777 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6778 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6779 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6780 meaningful. Here's one example:
6781
6782 @lisp
6783 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6784
6785 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6786 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6787 (when (string-match
6788 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6789 (mail-header-set-id
6790 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6791 header))))
6792 @end lisp
6793
6794 @end table
6795
6796
6797 @node Thread Commands
6798 @subsection Thread Commands
6799 @cindex thread commands
6800
6801 @table @kbd
6802
6803 @item T k
6804 @itemx C-M-k
6805 @kindex T k (Summary)
6806 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6807 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6808 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6809 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6810 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6811 articles instead.
6812
6813 @item T l
6814 @itemx C-M-l
6815 @kindex T l (Summary)
6816 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6817 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6818 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6819 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6820
6821 @item T i
6822 @kindex T i (Summary)
6823 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6824 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6825 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6826
6827 @item T #
6828 @kindex T # (Summary)
6829 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6830 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6831 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6832
6833 @item T M-#
6834 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6835 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6836 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6837 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6838
6839 @item T T
6840 @kindex T T (Summary)
6841 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6842 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6843
6844 @item T s
6845 @kindex T s (Summary)
6846 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6847 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6848 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6849
6850 @item T h
6851 @kindex T h (Summary)
6852 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6853 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6854
6855 @item T S
6856 @kindex T S (Summary)
6857 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6858 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6859
6860 @item T H
6861 @kindex T H (Summary)
6862 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6863 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6864
6865 @item T t
6866 @kindex T t (Summary)
6867 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6868 Re-thread the current article's thread
6869 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6870 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6871
6872 @item T ^
6873 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6874 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6875 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6876 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6877
6878 @end table
6879
6880 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6881 understand the numeric prefix.
6882
6883 @table @kbd
6884
6885 @item T n
6886 @kindex T n (Summary)
6887 @itemx C-M-f
6888 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6889 @itemx M-down
6890 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6891 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6892 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6893
6894 @item T p
6895 @kindex T p (Summary)
6896 @itemx C-M-b
6897 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6898 @itemx M-up
6899 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6900 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6901 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6902
6903 @item T d
6904 @kindex T d (Summary)
6905 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6906 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6907
6908 @item T u
6909 @kindex T u (Summary)
6910 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6911 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6912
6913 @item T o
6914 @kindex T o (Summary)
6915 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6916 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6917 @end table
6918
6919 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6920 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6921 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6922 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6923 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6924 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6925 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6926 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6927 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6928 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6929 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6930 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6931 Matching}).
6932
6933
6934 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6935 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6936
6937 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6938 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6939 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6940 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6941 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6942 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6943 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
6944 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6945 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
6946 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
6947 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6948 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6949 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6950 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6951
6952 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6953 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6954 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6955 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6956 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6957 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
6958 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
6959 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6960
6961 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6962 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6963 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6964
6965 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6966 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6967 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6968 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6969 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6970 ascending article order.
6971
6972 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6973 by number, you could do something like:
6974
6975 @lisp
6976 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6977 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6978 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6979 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6980 @end lisp
6981
6982 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6983 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6984 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6985 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6986 which the articles arrived.
6987
6988 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
6989 say something like:
6990
6991 @lisp
6992 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6993 '((lambda (t1 t2)
6994 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
6995 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
6996 @end lisp
6997
6998 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
6999 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7000 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7001 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7002 tickles your fancy.
7003
7004 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7005 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7006 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7007 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7008 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7009 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7010 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7011 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7012 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7013 variable. It is very similar to the
7014 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7015 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7016 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7017 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7018 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7019 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7020 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7021
7022 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7023 say something like:
7024
7025 @lisp
7026 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7027 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7028 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7029 @end lisp
7030
7031
7032
7033 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7034 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7035 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7036 @cindex article pre-fetch
7037 @cindex pre-fetch
7038
7039 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7040 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7041 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7042 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7043 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7044
7045 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7046 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7047
7048 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7049 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7050 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7051 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7052 connection is blocked.
7053
7054 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7055 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7056 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7057 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7058
7059 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7060 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7061 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7062 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7063 extra connection.
7064
7065 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7066 you really want to.
7067
7068 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7069 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7070 happen automatically.
7071
7072 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7073 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7074 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7075 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7076 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7077 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7078 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7079
7080 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7081 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7082 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7083 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7084 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7085 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7086 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7087 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7088 article data structure as the only parameter.
7089
7090 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7091 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7092
7093 @lisp
7094 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7095 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7096 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7097 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7098 100)))
7099
7100 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7101 @end lisp
7102
7103 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7104 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7105 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7106
7107 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7108 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7109 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7110 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7111
7112 @table @code
7113 @item read
7114 Remove articles when they are read.
7115
7116 @item exit
7117 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7118 @end table
7119
7120 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7121
7122 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7123 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7124 @c from the next group.
7125
7126
7127 @node Article Caching
7128 @section Article Caching
7129 @cindex article caching
7130 @cindex caching
7131
7132 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7133 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7134 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7135 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7136 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7137
7138 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7139
7140 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7141 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7142 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7143 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7144 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7145 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7146 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7147 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7148
7149 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7150 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7151 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7152 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7153 as dormant, and don't worry.
7154
7155 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7156
7157 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7158 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7159 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7160 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7161 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7162 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7163 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7164 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7165 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7166 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7167
7168 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7169 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7170 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7171 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7172 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7173 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7174 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7175 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7176 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7177 not then be downloaded by this command.
7178
7179 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7180 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7181 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7182 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7183 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7184 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7185
7186 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7187 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7188 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7189 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7190 variables, the group is not cached.
7191
7192 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7193 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7194 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7195 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7196 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7197 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7198 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7199 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7200 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7201 file.
7202
7203 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7204 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7205 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7206 where, isn't that cool?
7207
7208 @node Persistent Articles
7209 @section Persistent Articles
7210 @cindex persistent articles
7211
7212 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7213 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7214 useful in my opinion.
7215
7216 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7217 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7218 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7219 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7220 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7221 the expiry going on at the news server.
7222
7223 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7224 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7225 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7226
7227 @table @kbd
7228
7229 @item *
7230 @kindex * (Summary)
7231 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7232 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7233
7234 @item M-*
7235 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7236 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7237 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7238 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7239 article.
7240 @end table
7241
7242 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7243
7244 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7245 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7246 interested in persistent articles:
7247
7248 @lisp
7249 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7250 @end lisp
7251
7252
7253 @node Article Backlog
7254 @section Article Backlog
7255 @cindex backlog
7256 @cindex article backlog
7257
7258 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7259 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7260 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7261 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7262 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7263 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7264 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7265 increase memory usage some.
7266
7267 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7268 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7269 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7270 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7271 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7272 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7273 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7274
7275 The default value is 20.
7276
7277
7278 @node Saving Articles
7279 @section Saving Articles
7280 @cindex saving articles
7281
7282 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7283 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7284 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7285 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7286 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7287
7288 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7289 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7290 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7291
7292 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7293 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7294 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7295
7296 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7297 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7298 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7299 deleted before saving.
7300
7301 @table @kbd
7302
7303 @item O o
7304 @itemx o
7305 @kindex O o (Summary)
7306 @kindex o (Summary)
7307 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7309 Save the current article using the default article saver
7310 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7311
7312 @item O m
7313 @kindex O m (Summary)
7314 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7315 Save the current article in mail format
7316 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7317
7318 @item O r
7319 @kindex O r (Summary)
7320 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7321 Save the current article in Rmail format
7322 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7323
7324 @item O f
7325 @kindex O f (Summary)
7326 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7327 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7328 Save the current article in plain file format
7329 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7330
7331 @item O F
7332 @kindex O F (Summary)
7333 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7334 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7335 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7336
7337 @item O b
7338 @kindex O b (Summary)
7339 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7340 Save the current article body in plain file format
7341 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7342
7343 @item O h
7344 @kindex O h (Summary)
7345 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7346 Save the current article in mh folder format
7347 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7348
7349 @item O v
7350 @kindex O v (Summary)
7351 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7352 Save the current article in a VM folder
7353 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7354
7355 @item O p
7356 @itemx |
7357 @kindex O p (Summary)
7358 @kindex | (Summary)
7359 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7360 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7361 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7362 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7363 complete headers in the piped output.
7364
7365 @item O P
7366 @kindex O P (Summary)
7367 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7368 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7369 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7370 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7371 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7372 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7373 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7374
7375 @end table
7376
7377 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7378 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7379 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7380 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7381 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7382 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7383 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7384 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7385 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7386 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7387 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7388 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7389 files.
7390
7391
7392 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7393 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7394 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7395 functions below, or you can create your own.
7396
7397 @table @code
7398
7399 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7400 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7401 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7402 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7403 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7404 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7405 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7406
7407 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7408 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7409 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7410 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7411 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7412 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7413
7414 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7415 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7416 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7417 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7418 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7419 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7420 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7421
7422 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7423 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7424 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7425 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7426 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7427 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7428
7429 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7430 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7431 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7432 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7433 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7434
7435 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7436 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7437 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7438 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7439 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7440 @cindex rcvstore
7441 @cindex MH folders
7442 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7443 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7444 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7445 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7446 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7447
7448 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7449 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7450 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7451 reader to use this setting.
7452 @end table
7453
7454 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7455 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7456 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7457 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7458 default.
7459
7460 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7461 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7462 available functions that generate names:
7463
7464 @table @code
7465
7466 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7467 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7468 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7469
7470 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7471 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7472 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7473
7474 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7475 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7476 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7477
7478 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7479 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7480 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7481
7482 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7483 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7484 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7485 @end table
7486
7487 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7488 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7489 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7490 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7491 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7492 like:
7493
7494 @lisp
7495 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7496 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7497 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7498 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7499 @end lisp
7500
7501 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7502 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7503 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7504 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7505 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7506 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7507 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7508 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7509 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7510
7511 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7512 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7513 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7514 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7515
7516 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7517 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7518 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7519 name.
7520
7521 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7522 lots of mail groups called things like
7523 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7524 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7525 following will do just that:
7526
7527 @lisp
7528 (defun my-save-name (group)
7529 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7530 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7531
7532 (setq gnus-split-methods
7533 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7534 (my-save-name)))
7535 @end lisp
7536
7537
7538 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7539 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7540 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7541 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7542 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7543 all the files in the top level directory
7544 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7545 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7546 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7547 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7548
7549 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7550 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7551 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7552 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7553 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7554 for kill files.
7555
7556 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7557 a spool, you could
7558
7559 @lisp
7560 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7561 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7562 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7563 @end lisp
7564
7565 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7566 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7567 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7568 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7569
7570
7571 @node Decoding Articles
7572 @section Decoding Articles
7573 @cindex decoding articles
7574
7575 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7576 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7577
7578 @menu
7579 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7580 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7581 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7582 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7583 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7584 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7585 @end menu
7586
7587 @cindex series
7588 @cindex article series
7589 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7590 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7591 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7592 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7593 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7594
7595 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7596 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7597 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7598
7599 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7600 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7601 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7602
7603 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7604 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7605 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7606
7607
7608 @node Uuencoded Articles
7609 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7610 @cindex uudecode
7611 @cindex uuencoded articles
7612
7613 @table @kbd
7614
7615 @item X u
7616 @kindex X u (Summary)
7617 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7618 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7619 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7620
7621 @item X U
7622 @kindex X U (Summary)
7623 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7624 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7625 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7626
7627 @item X v u
7628 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7629 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7630 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7631
7632 @item X v U
7633 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7634 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7635 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7636 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7637
7638 @end table
7639
7640 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7641 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7642 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7643 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7644 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7645
7646 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7647 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7648 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7649 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7650 @kbd{X u}.
7651
7652 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7653 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7654 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7655 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7656 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7657 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7658 off.
7659
7660
7661 @node Shell Archives
7662 @subsection Shell Archives
7663 @cindex unshar
7664 @cindex shell archives
7665 @cindex shared articles
7666
7667 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7668 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7669 some commands to deal with these:
7670
7671 @table @kbd
7672
7673 @item X s
7674 @kindex X s (Summary)
7675 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7676 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7677
7678 @item X S
7679 @kindex X S (Summary)
7680 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7681 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7682
7683 @item X v s
7684 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7685 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7686 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7687
7688 @item X v S
7689 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7690 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7691 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7692 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7693 @end table
7694
7695
7696 @node PostScript Files
7697 @subsection PostScript Files
7698 @cindex PostScript
7699
7700 @table @kbd
7701
7702 @item X p
7703 @kindex X p (Summary)
7704 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7705 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7706
7707 @item X P
7708 @kindex X P (Summary)
7709 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7710 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7711 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7712
7713 @item X v p
7714 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7715 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7716 View the current PostScript series
7717 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7718
7719 @item X v P
7720 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7721 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7722 View and save the current PostScript series
7723 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7724 @end table
7725
7726
7727 @node Other Files
7728 @subsection Other Files
7729
7730 @table @kbd
7731 @item X o
7732 @kindex X o (Summary)
7733 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7734 Save the current series
7735 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7736
7737 @item X b
7738 @kindex X b (Summary)
7739 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7740 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7741 doesn't really work yet.
7742 @end table
7743
7744
7745 @node Decoding Variables
7746 @subsection Decoding Variables
7747
7748 Adjective, not verb.
7749
7750 @menu
7751 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7752 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7753 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7754 @end menu
7755
7756
7757 @node Rule Variables
7758 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7759 @cindex rule variables
7760
7761 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7762 variables are of the form
7763
7764 @lisp
7765 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7766 '(regexp2 command2)
7767 ...)
7768 @end lisp
7769
7770 @table @code
7771
7772 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7773 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7774 @cindex sox
7775 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7776 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7777 say something like:
7778 @lisp
7779 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7780 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7781 @end lisp
7782
7783 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7784 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7785 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7786 user and default view rules.
7787
7788 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7789 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7790 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7791 archives.
7792 @end table
7793
7794
7795 @node Other Decode Variables
7796 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7797
7798 @table @code
7799 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7800
7801 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7802 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7803 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7804 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7805 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7806
7807 @table @code
7808
7809 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7810 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7811 View the file.
7812
7813 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7814 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7815 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7816 @end table
7817
7818 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7819 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7820 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7821 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7822 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7823 time.
7824
7825 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7826 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7827 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7828
7829 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7830 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7831 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7832 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7833 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7834 kludgey.
7835
7836 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7837 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7838 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7839
7840 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7841 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7842 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7843 looking for files to display.
7844
7845 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7846 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7847 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7848 after viewing it.
7849
7850 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7851 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7852 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7853 rules.
7854
7855 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7856 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7857 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7858 unpacking commands.
7859
7860 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7861 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7862 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7863 from articles.
7864
7865 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7866 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7867 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7868 decoded articles as unread.
7869
7870 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7871 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7872 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7873 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7874
7875 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7876 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7877 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7878
7879 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7880 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7881 @cindex metamail
7882 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7883 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7884 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7885 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7886
7887 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7888 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7889 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7890 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7891 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7892 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7893 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7894 simply dropped them.
7895
7896 @end table
7897
7898
7899 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7900 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7901
7902 @table @code
7903
7904 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7905 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7906 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7907 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7908 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7909 for you when you post the article.
7910
7911 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7912 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7913 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7914 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7915
7916 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7917 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7918 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7919 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7920 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7921 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7922 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
7923
7924 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7925 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7926 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7927 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7928 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7929 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7930 Default is @code{t}.
7931
7932 @end table
7933
7934
7935 @node Viewing Files
7936 @subsection Viewing Files
7937 @cindex viewing files
7938 @cindex pseudo-articles
7939
7940 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
7941 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7942 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7943 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
7944 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7945 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7946 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7947
7948 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7949 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7950 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7951 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7952
7953 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7954 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7955 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7956
7957 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7958 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7959 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7960 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7961 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7962
7963 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7964 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7965 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7966 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7967 a list of parameters to that command.
7968
7969 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7970 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7971 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7972
7973 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7974 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7975 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7976
7977
7978 @node Article Treatment
7979 @section Article Treatment
7980
7981 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
7982 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
7983 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
7984 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
7985 these articles easier.
7986
7987 @menu
7988 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
7989 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
7990 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
7991 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
7992 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
7993 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
7994 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
7995 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
7996 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
7997 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
7998 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
7999 @end menu
8000
8001
8002 @node Article Highlighting
8003 @subsection Article Highlighting
8004 @cindex highlighting
8005
8006 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8007 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8008
8009 @table @kbd
8010
8011 @item W H a
8012 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8013 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8014 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8015 Do much highlighting of the current article
8016 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8017 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8018
8019 @item W H h
8020 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8021 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8022 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8023 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8024 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8025 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8026 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8027 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8028 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8029 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8030 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8031 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8032
8033 @item W H c
8034 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8035 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8036 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8037
8038 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8039
8040 @table @code
8041 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8042
8043 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8044 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8045 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8046
8047 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8048 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8049 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8050
8051 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8052 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8053 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8054 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8055 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8056 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8057
8058 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8059 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8060 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8061
8062 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8063 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8064 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8065
8066 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8067 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8068 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8069 that it's a citation.
8070
8071 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8072 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8073 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8074
8075 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8076 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8077 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8078
8079 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8080 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8081 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8082 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8083
8084 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8085 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8086 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8087 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8088 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8089 is @code{t}.
8090
8091 @end table
8092
8093
8094 @item W H s
8095 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8096 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8097 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8098 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8099 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8100 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8101 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8102 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8103 default.
8104
8105 @end table
8106
8107 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8108
8109
8110 @node Article Fontisizing
8111 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8112 @cindex emphasis
8113 @cindex article emphasis
8114
8115 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8116 @kindex W e (Summary)
8117 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8118 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8119 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8120 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8121
8122 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8123 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8124 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8125 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8126 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8127 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8128 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8129 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8130 highlighting.
8131
8132 @lisp
8133 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8134 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8135 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8136 @end lisp
8137
8138 @cindex slash
8139 @cindex asterisk
8140 @cindex underline
8141 @cindex /
8142 @cindex *
8143
8144 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8145 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8146 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8147 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8148 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8149 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8150 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8151 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8152 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8153 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8154 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8155 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8156 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8157
8158 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8159 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8160 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8161 say something like:
8162
8163 @lisp
8164 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8165 @end lisp
8166
8167 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8168
8169 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8170 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8171 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8172 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8173
8174 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8175
8176
8177 @node Article Hiding
8178 @subsection Article Hiding
8179 @cindex article hiding
8180
8181 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8182 too much cruft in most articles.
8183
8184 @table @kbd
8185
8186 @item W W a
8187 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8188 @findex gnus-article-hide
8189 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8190 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8191 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8192
8193 @item W W h
8194 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8195 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8196 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8197 Headers}.
8198
8199 @item W W b
8200 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8201 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8202 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8203 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8204
8205 @item W W s
8206 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8207 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8208 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8209 Signature}.
8210
8211 @item W W l
8212 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8213 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8214 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8215 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8216 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8217 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8218 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8219 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8220
8221 @table @code
8222
8223 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8224 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8225 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8226 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8227
8228 @end table
8229
8230 @item W W P
8231 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8232 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8233 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8234 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8235
8236 @item W W B
8237 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8238 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8239 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8240 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8241 @cindex banner
8242 @cindex OneList
8243 @cindex stripping advertisements
8244 @cindex advertisements
8245 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8246 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8247 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8248 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8249 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8250 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8251 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8252 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8253 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8254 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8255 used.
8256
8257 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8258 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8259 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8260
8261 @table @code
8262
8263 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8264 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8265 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8266 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8267 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8268 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8269 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8270 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8271 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8272 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8273 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8274
8275 @lisp
8276 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8277 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8278 @end lisp
8279
8280 @end table
8281
8282 @item W W c
8283 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8284 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8285 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8286 customizing the hiding:
8287
8288 @table @code
8289
8290 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8291 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8292 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8293 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8294 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8295 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8296 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8297 specs are valid:
8298
8299 @table @samp
8300 @item b
8301 Starting point of the hidden text.
8302 @item e
8303 Ending point of the hidden text.
8304 @item l
8305 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8306 @item n
8307 Number of lines of hidden text.
8308 @end table
8309
8310 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8311 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8312 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8313 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8314 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8315
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @item W W C-c
8319 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8320 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8321
8322 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8323 following two variables:
8324
8325 @table @code
8326 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8327 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8328 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8329 50), hide the cited text.
8330
8331 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8332 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8333 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8334 is hidden.
8335 @end table
8336
8337 @item W W C
8338 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8339 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8340 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8341 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8342 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8343 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8344
8345 @end table
8346
8347 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8348 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8349 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8350
8351 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8352 citation customization.
8353
8354 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8355 automatically.
8356
8357
8358 @node Article Washing
8359 @subsection Article Washing
8360 @cindex washing
8361 @cindex article washing
8362
8363 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8364 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8365
8366 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8367 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8368 Cleaner, perhaps.
8369
8370 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8371 articles by default.
8372
8373 @table @kbd
8374
8375 @item C-u g
8376 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8377 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8378 the server.
8379
8380 @item g
8381 Force redisplaying of the current article
8382 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8383 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8384 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8385 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8386
8387 @item W l
8388 @kindex W l (Summary)
8389 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8390 Remove page breaks from the current article
8391 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8392 delimiters.
8393
8394 @item W r
8395 @kindex W r (Summary)
8396 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8397 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8398 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8399 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8400 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8401 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8402
8403 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8404 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8405 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8406 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8407
8408 @item W m
8409 @kindex W m (Summary)
8410 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8411 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8412
8413 @item W t
8414 @item t
8415 @kindex W t (Summary)
8416 @kindex t (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8418 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8419 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8420
8421 @item W v
8422 @kindex W v (Summary)
8423 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8424 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8425 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8426
8427 @item W o
8428 @kindex W o (Summary)
8429 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8430 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8431
8432 @item W d
8433 @kindex W d (Summary)
8434 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8435 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8436 @cindex Smartquotes
8437 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8438 @cindex Latin 1
8439 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8440 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8441 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8442 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8443 interactively.
8444
8445 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8446 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8447 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8448 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8449
8450 @item W Y f
8451 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8452 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8453 @cindex Outlook Express
8454 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8455 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8456 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8457
8458 @item W Y u
8459 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8460 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8461 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8462 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8463 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8464 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8465 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8466 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8467 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8468 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8469
8470 @item W Y a
8471 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8472 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8473 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8474 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8475
8476 @item W Y c
8477 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8478 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8479 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8480 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8481
8482 @item W w
8483 @kindex W w (Summary)
8484 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8485 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8486
8487 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8488 when filling.
8489
8490 @item W Q
8491 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8492 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8493 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8494
8495 @item W C
8496 @kindex W C (Summary)
8497 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8498 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8499 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8500
8501 @item W c
8502 @kindex W c (Summary)
8503 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8504 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8505 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8506 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8507 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8508
8509 @item W q
8510 @kindex W q (Summary)
8511 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8512 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8513 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8514 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8515 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8516 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8517 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8518 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8519 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8520
8521 @item W 6
8522 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8523 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8524 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8525 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8526 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8527 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8528 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8529 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8530
8531 @item W Z
8532 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8533 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8534 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8535 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8536 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8537
8538 @item W u
8539 @kindex W u (Summary)
8540 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8541 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8542 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8543 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8544 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8545
8546 @item W h
8547 @kindex W h (Summary)
8548 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8549 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8550 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8551 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8552
8553 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8554
8555 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8556 The default is to use the function specified by
8557 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8558 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8559 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8560 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8561 can use include:
8562
8563 @table @code
8564 @item w3
8565 Use Emacs/w3.
8566
8567 @item w3m
8568 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8569
8570 @item links
8571 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8572
8573 @item lynx
8574 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8575
8576 @item html2text
8577 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8578
8579 @end table
8580
8581 @item W b
8582 @kindex W b (Summary)
8583 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8584 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8585 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8586
8587 @item W B
8588 @kindex W B (Summary)
8589 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8590 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8591 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8592
8593 @item W p
8594 @kindex W p (Summary)
8595 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8596 Verify a signed control message
8597 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8598 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8599 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8600 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8601 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8602 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8603
8604 @item W s
8605 @kindex W s (Summary)
8606 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8607 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8608 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8609 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8610
8611 @item W a
8612 @kindex W a (Summary)
8613 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8614 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8615 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8616
8617 @item W E l
8618 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8619 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8620 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8621 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8622
8623 @item W E m
8624 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8625 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8626 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8627 lines with a single empty line.
8628 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8629
8630 @item W E t
8631 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8633 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8634 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8635
8636 @item W E a
8637 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8638 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8639 Do all the three commands above
8640 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8641
8642 @item W E A
8643 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8644 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8645 Remove all blank lines
8646 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8647
8648 @item W E s
8649 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8650 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8651 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8652 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8653
8654 @item W E e
8655 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8656 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8657 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8658 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8659
8660 @end table
8661
8662 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8663
8664
8665 @node Article Header
8666 @subsection Article Header
8667
8668 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8669
8670 @table @kbd
8671
8672 @item W G u
8673 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8674 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8675 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8676
8677 @item W G n
8678 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8679 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8680 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8681 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8682
8683 @item W G f
8684 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8685 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8686 Fold all the message headers
8687 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8688
8689 @item W E w
8690 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8691 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8692 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8693 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8694
8695 @end table
8696
8697
8698 @node Article Buttons
8699 @subsection Article Buttons
8700 @cindex buttons
8701
8702 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8703 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8704 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8705 button on these references.
8706
8707 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8708 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8709 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8710 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8711 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8712
8713 @table @code
8714
8715 @item gnus-button-alist
8716 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8717 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8718
8719 @lisp
8720 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8721 @end lisp
8722
8723 @table @var
8724
8725 @item regexp
8726 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8727 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8728 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8729 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8730 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8731
8732 @item button-par
8733 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8734 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8735 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8736
8737 @item use-p
8738 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8739 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8740 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8741 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8742 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8743
8744 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8745
8746 @item function
8747 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8748
8749 @item data-par
8750 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8751 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8752
8753 @end table
8754
8755 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8756
8757 @lisp
8758 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8759 @end lisp
8760
8761 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8762 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8763 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8764 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8765 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8766
8767 @lisp
8768 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8769 @end lisp
8770
8771 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8772 @end table
8773
8774 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8775
8776 @table @code
8777 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8778 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8779
8780 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8781
8782 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8783 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8784 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8785 default values of the variables above.
8786
8787 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8788
8789 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8790 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8791 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8792 argument with a string naming the man page.
8793
8794 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8795
8796 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8797 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8798 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8799
8800 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8801 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8802 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8803 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8804 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8805 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8806 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8807 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8808 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8809 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8810 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8811 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8812
8813 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8814 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8815 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8816 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8817 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8818 string is invalid.
8819
8820 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8821 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8822 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8823 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8824
8825 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8826
8827 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8828 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8829 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8830 argument, the string naming the URL.
8831
8832 @item gnus-ctan-url
8833 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8834 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8835 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8836
8837 @c Misc stuff
8838
8839 @item gnus-article-button-face
8840 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8841 Face used on buttons.
8842
8843 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8844 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8845 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8846
8847 @end table
8848
8849 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8850
8851
8852 @node Article Button Levels
8853 @subsection Article button levels
8854 @cindex button levels
8855 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8856 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8857 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8858 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8859 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8860 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8861 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8862 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8863
8864 @lisp
8865 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8866 (setq gnus-parameters
8867 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8868 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8869 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8870 @end lisp
8871
8872 @table @code
8873
8874 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8875 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8876 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8877 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8878 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8879 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8880
8881 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8882 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8883 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8884 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8885 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8886 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8887 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8888 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8889 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8890 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8891 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8892 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8893 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8894
8895 @item gnus-button-man-level
8896 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8897 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
8898 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
8899
8900 @item gnus-button-message-level
8901 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
8902 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
8903 Related variables and functions include
8904 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
8905 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
8906 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
8907 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
8908
8909 @item gnus-button-tex-level
8910 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
8911 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
8912 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
8913 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
8914 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
8915 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
8916
8917 @end table
8918
8919
8920 @node Article Date
8921 @subsection Article Date
8922
8923 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8924 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8925 when the article was sent.
8926
8927 @table @kbd
8928
8929 @item W T u
8930 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8931 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8932 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8933 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8934
8935 @item W T i
8936 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8937 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8938 @cindex ISO 8601
8939 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8940 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8941
8942 @item W T l
8943 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8944 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8945 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8946
8947 @item W T p
8948 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8949 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8950 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8951 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8952
8953 @item W T s
8954 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8955 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8956 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8957 @findex format-time-string
8958 Display the date using a user-defined format
8959 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8960 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8961 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8962 for a list of possible format specs.
8963
8964 @item W T e
8965 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8966 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8967 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8968 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8969 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8970 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8971
8972 @example
8973 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8974 @end example
8975
8976 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
8977 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8978 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
8979 replace it.
8980
8981 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
8982 into wonderful absurdities.
8983
8984 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
8985
8986 @lisp
8987 (gnus-start-date-timer)
8988 @end lisp
8989
8990 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
8991 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
8992 command.
8993
8994 @item W T o
8995 @kindex W T o (Summary)
8996 @findex gnus-article-date-original
8997 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
8998 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
8999 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9000 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9001 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9002
9003 @end table
9004
9005 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9006 preferred format automatically.
9007
9008
9009 @node Article Display
9010 @subsection Article Display
9011 @cindex picons
9012 @cindex x-face
9013 @cindex smileys
9014
9015 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9016 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9017
9018 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9019 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9020
9021 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9022 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9023
9024 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9025 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9026
9027 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9028 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9029
9030 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9031 they'll be removed.
9032
9033 @table @kbd
9034 @item W D x
9035 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9036 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9037 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9038 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9039
9040 @item W D d
9041 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9042 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9043 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9044 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9045
9046 @item W D s
9047 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9048 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9049 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9050
9051 @item W D f
9052 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9053 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9054 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9055
9056 @item W D m
9057 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9058 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9059 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9060 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9061
9062 @item W D n
9063 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9064 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9065 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9066 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9067
9068 @item W D D
9069 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9070 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9071 Remove all images from the article buffer
9072 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9073
9074 @end table
9075
9076
9077
9078 @node Article Signature
9079 @subsection Article Signature
9080 @cindex signatures
9081 @cindex article signature
9082
9083 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9084 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9085 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9086 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9087 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9088 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9089 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9090 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9091 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9092
9093 @lisp
9094 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9095 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9096 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9097 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9098 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9099 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9100 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9101 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9102 @end lisp
9103
9104 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9105 positives.
9106
9107 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9108 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9109 signature when displaying articles.
9110
9111 @enumerate
9112 @item
9113 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9114 that integer.
9115 @item
9116 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9117 than that number.
9118 @item
9119 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9120 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9121 @item
9122 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9123 in question is not a signature.
9124 @end enumerate
9125
9126 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9127 listed above. Here's an example:
9128
9129 @lisp
9130 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9131 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9132 @end lisp
9133
9134 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9135 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9136 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9137 signature after all.
9138
9139
9140 @node Article Miscellanea
9141 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9142
9143 @table @kbd
9144 @item A t
9145 @kindex A t (Summary)
9146 @findex gnus-article-babel
9147 Translate the article from one language to another
9148 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9149
9150 @end table
9151
9152
9153 @node MIME Commands
9154 @section MIME Commands
9155 @cindex MIME decoding
9156 @cindex attachments
9157 @cindex viewing attachments
9158
9159 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9160 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9161
9162 @table @kbd
9163 @item b
9164 @itemx K v
9165 @kindex b (Summary)
9166 @kindex K v (Summary)
9167 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9168
9169 @item K o
9170 @kindex K o (Summary)
9171 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9172
9173 @item K c
9174 @kindex K c (Summary)
9175 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9176
9177 @item K e
9178 @kindex K e (Summary)
9179 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9180
9181 @item K i
9182 @kindex K i (Summary)
9183 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9184
9185 @item K |
9186 @kindex K | (Summary)
9187 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9191 the same manner:
9192
9193 @table @kbd
9194 @item K b
9195 @kindex K b (Summary)
9196 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9197 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9198 parts.
9199
9200 @item K m
9201 @kindex K m (Summary)
9202 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9203 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9204 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9205 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9206 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9207
9208 @item X m
9209 @kindex X m (Summary)
9210 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9211 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9212 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9213 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9214
9215 @item M-t
9216 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9217 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9218 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9219 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9220
9221 @item W M w
9222 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9223 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9224 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9225 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9226
9227 @item W M c
9228 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9229 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9230 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9231 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9232
9233 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9234 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9235 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9236 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9237 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9238 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9239
9240 @item W M v
9241 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9242 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9243 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9244 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9245
9246 @end table
9247
9248 Relevant variables:
9249
9250 @table @code
9251 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9252 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9253 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9254 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9255 @code{nil}.
9256
9257 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9258
9259 @lisp
9260 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9261 '("text/x-vcard"))
9262 @end lisp
9263
9264 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9265 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9266 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9267 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9268 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9269 default is @code{nil}.
9270
9271 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9272 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9273 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9274 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9275 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9276 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9277 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9278
9279 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9280 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9281 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9282 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9283 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9284 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9285 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9286 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9287
9288 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9289 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9290 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9291 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9292 displayed. This variable overrides
9293 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9294 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9295 is @code{nil}.
9296
9297 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9298 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9299 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9300
9301 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9302 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9303 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9304 default value is @code{nil}.
9305
9306 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9307 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9308 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9309 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9310 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9311 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9312 save all jpegs into some directory).
9313
9314 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9315
9316 @lisp
9317 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9318 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9319 (with-temp-buffer
9320 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9321 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9322 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9323 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9324 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9325 @end lisp
9326
9327 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9328 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9329 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9330
9331 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9332 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9333 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9334 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9335
9336 Ready-made functions include@*
9337 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9338 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9339 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9340 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9341 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9342 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9343 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9344 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9345 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9346 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9347 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9348 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9349
9350 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9351 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9352
9353 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9354 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9355 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9356
9357 @lisp
9358 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9359 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9360 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9361 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9362 @end lisp
9363
9364 @noindent
9365 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9366
9367 @end table
9368
9369
9370 @node Charsets
9371 @section Charsets
9372 @cindex charsets
9373
9374 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9375 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9376 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9377 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9378 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9379 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9380 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
9381
9382 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9383 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9384 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9385 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9386
9387 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9388 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9389 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9390 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9391 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9392 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9393 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9394 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9395 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9396
9397 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9398 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9399 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9400 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9401 quoted-printable header encoding.
9402
9403 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9404 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9405 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9406
9407 @table @var
9408 @item test
9409 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9410 variable to query,
9411 @item header
9412 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9413 means encode all charsets),
9414 @item body-list
9415 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9416 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9417 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9418 @end table
9419
9420 @cindex Russian
9421 @cindex koi8-r
9422 @cindex koi8-u
9423 @cindex iso-8859-5
9424 @cindex coding system aliases
9425 @cindex preferred charset
9426
9427 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9428
9429 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9430 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9431
9432 @lisp
9433 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9434 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9435 @end lisp
9436
9437 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9438 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9439
9440 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9441
9442 @lisp
9443 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9444 @end lisp
9445
9446 This will almost do the right thing.
9447
9448 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9449 something like
9450
9451 @lisp
9452 (codepage-setup 1251)
9453 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9454 @end lisp
9455
9456
9457 @node Article Commands
9458 @section Article Commands
9459
9460 @table @kbd
9461
9462 @item A P
9463 @cindex PostScript
9464 @cindex printing
9465 @kindex A P (Summary)
9466 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9467 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9468 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9469 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9470 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9471 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9472
9473 @end table
9474
9475
9476 @node Summary Sorting
9477 @section Summary Sorting
9478 @cindex summary sorting
9479
9480 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9481 can't really see why you'd want that.
9482
9483 @table @kbd
9484
9485 @item C-c C-s C-n
9486 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9487 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9488 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9489
9490 @item C-c C-s C-a
9491 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9492 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9493 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9494
9495 @item C-c C-s C-s
9496 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9497 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9498 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9499
9500 @item C-c C-s C-d
9501 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9502 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9503 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9504
9505 @item C-c C-s C-l
9506 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9507 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9508 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9509
9510 @item C-c C-s C-c
9511 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9512 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9513 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9514
9515 @item C-c C-s C-i
9516 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9517 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9518 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9519
9520 @item C-c C-s C-r
9521 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9522 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9523 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9524
9525 @item C-c C-s C-o
9526 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9527 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9528 Sort using the default sorting method
9529 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9530 @end table
9531
9532 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9533 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9534 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9535 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9536 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9537 Commands}).
9538
9539
9540 @node Finding the Parent
9541 @section Finding the Parent
9542 @cindex parent articles
9543 @cindex referring articles
9544
9545 @table @kbd
9546 @item ^
9547 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9548 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9549 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9550 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9551 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9552 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9553 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9554 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9555 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9556 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9557
9558 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9559 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9560 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9561 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9562 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9563 article.
9564
9565 @item A R (Summary)
9566 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9567 @kindex A R (Summary)
9568 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9569 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9570
9571 @item A T (Summary)
9572 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9573 @kindex A T (Summary)
9574 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9575 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9576 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9577 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9578 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9579 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9580 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9581
9582 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9583 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9584 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9585 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9586 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9587 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9588
9589 @item M-^ (Summary)
9590 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9591 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9592 @cindex Message-ID
9593 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9594 You can also ask the @acronym{NNTP} server for an arbitrary article, no
9595 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
9596 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
9597 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
9598 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
9599 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9600 @end table
9601
9602 The current select method will be used when fetching by
9603 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
9604 by giving this command a prefix.
9605
9606 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9607 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9608 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9609 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9610 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9611 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9612 necessary.
9613
9614 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9615 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9616 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9617 match.
9618
9619 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9620 then ask Google if that fails:
9621
9622 @lisp
9623 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9624 '(current
9625 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9626 @end lisp
9627
9628 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9629 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9630 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9631 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9632 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9633 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9634 not support this at all.
9635
9636
9637 @node Alternative Approaches
9638 @section Alternative Approaches
9639
9640 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9641 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9642
9643 @menu
9644 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9645 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9646 @end menu
9647
9648
9649 @node Pick and Read
9650 @subsection Pick and Read
9651 @cindex pick and read
9652
9653 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9654 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9655 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9656 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9657
9658 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9659 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9660 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9661 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9662 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9663 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9664
9665 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9666
9667 @table @kbd
9668 @item .
9669 @kindex . (Pick)
9670 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9671 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9672 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9673 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9674 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9675 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9676 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9677 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9678
9679 @item SPACE
9680 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9681 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9682 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9683 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9684
9685 @item u
9686 @kindex u (Pick)
9687 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9688 Unpick the thread or article
9689 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9690 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9691 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9692 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9693 the thread or article at that line.
9694
9695 @item RET
9696 @kindex RET (Pick)
9697 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9698 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9699 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9700 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9701 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9702 will still be visible when you are reading.
9703
9704 @end table
9705
9706 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9707 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9708 which is mapped to the same function
9709 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9710
9711 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9712
9713 @lisp
9714 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9715 @end lisp
9716
9717 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9718 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9719
9720 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9721 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9722 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9723
9724 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9725 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9726 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9727 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9728 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9729 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9730 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9731
9732
9733 @node Binary Groups
9734 @subsection Binary Groups
9735 @cindex binary groups
9736
9737 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9738 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9739 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9740 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9741 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9742 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9743 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9744
9745 @kindex g (Binary)
9746 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9747 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9748 command, when you have turned on this mode
9749 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9750
9751 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9752 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9753
9754
9755 @node Tree Display
9756 @section Tree Display
9757 @cindex trees
9758
9759 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9760 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9761 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9762 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9763 in the tree buffer.
9764
9765 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9766
9767 @table @code
9768 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9769 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9770 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9771
9772 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9773 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9774 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9775 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9776 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9777
9778 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9779 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9780 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9781 default is @code{modeline}.
9782
9783 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9784 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9785 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9786 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9787 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9788 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9789 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9790
9791 Valid specs are:
9792
9793 @table @samp
9794 @item n
9795 The name of the poster.
9796 @item f
9797 The @code{From} header.
9798 @item N
9799 The number of the article.
9800 @item [
9801 The opening bracket.
9802 @item ]
9803 The closing bracket.
9804 @item s
9805 The subject.
9806 @end table
9807
9808 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9809
9810 Variables related to the display are:
9811
9812 @table @code
9813 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9814 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9815 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9816 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9817 @example
9818 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9819 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9820 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9821 @end example
9822 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9823
9824 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9825 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9826 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9827 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9828
9829 @end table
9830
9831 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9832 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9833 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9834 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9835 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9836 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9837 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9838 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9839 other windows displayed next to it.
9840
9841 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9842 at all times:
9843
9844 @lisp
9845 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9846 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9847 @end lisp
9848
9849 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9850 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9851 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9852 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9853 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9854 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9855 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9856
9857 @end table
9858
9859 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9860
9861 @example
9862 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9863 | \[Jan]
9864 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9865 | \(***)-[Eri]
9866 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9867 \[Bjo]
9868 \[Gun]
9869 \[Gun]-[Jor]
9870 @end example
9871
9872 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9873
9874 @example
9875 @group
9876 @{***@}
9877 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9878 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9879 |--\-----\-----\ |
9880 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9881 | | |--\
9882 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9883 |
9884 [Paa]
9885 @end group
9886 @end example
9887
9888 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9889 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9890 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
9891
9892 @lisp
9893 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9894 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9895 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9896 (gnus-add-configuration
9897 '(article
9898 (vertical 1.0
9899 (horizontal 0.25
9900 (summary 0.75 point)
9901 (tree 1.0))
9902 (article 1.0))))
9903 @end lisp
9904
9905 @xref{Window Layout}.
9906
9907
9908 @node Mail Group Commands
9909 @section Mail Group Commands
9910 @cindex mail group commands
9911
9912 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9913 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9914
9915 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9916 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9917
9918 @table @kbd
9919
9920 @item B e
9921 @kindex B e (Summary)
9922 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9923 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9924 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9925 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9926 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9927
9928 @item B C-M-e
9929 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9930 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9931 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9932 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9933 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9934 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9935
9936 @item B DEL
9937 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9938 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9939 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9940 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9941 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9942 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9943
9944 @item B m
9945 @kindex B m (Summary)
9946 @cindex move mail
9947 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9948 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
9949 Move the article from one mail group to another
9950 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9951 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9952
9953 @item B c
9954 @kindex B c (Summary)
9955 @cindex copy mail
9956 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
9957 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
9958 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
9959 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9960 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9961
9962 @item B B
9963 @kindex B B (Summary)
9964 @cindex crosspost mail
9965 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
9966 Crosspost the current article to some other group
9967 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
9968 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
9969 be properly updated.
9970
9971 @item B i
9972 @kindex B i (Summary)
9973 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
9974 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
9975 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
9976 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
9977
9978 @item B I
9979 @kindex B I (Summary)
9980 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
9981 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
9982 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
9983 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
9984
9985 @item B r
9986 @kindex B r (Summary)
9987 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
9988 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
9989 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
9990 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
9991 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
9992 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
9993 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
9994 (which is the default).
9995
9996 @item B w
9997 @itemx e
9998 @kindex B w (Summary)
9999 @kindex e (Summary)
10000 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10001 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10002 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10003 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10004 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10005 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10006 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10007
10008 @item B q
10009 @kindex B q (Summary)
10010 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10011 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10012 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10013 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10014
10015 @item B t
10016 @kindex B t (Summary)
10017 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10018 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10019 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10020
10021 @item B p
10022 @kindex B p (Summary)
10023 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10024 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10025 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10026 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10027 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10028 article from your news server (or rather, from
10029 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10030 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10031 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10032 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10033 just not have arrived yet.
10034
10035 @item K E
10036 @kindex K E (Summary)
10037 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10038 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10039 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10040 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10041 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10042
10043 @end table
10044
10045 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10046 @cindex moving articles
10047 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10048 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10049 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10050 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10051 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10052 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10053 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10054
10055 @lisp
10056 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10057 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10058 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10059 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10060 @end lisp
10061
10062
10063 @node Various Summary Stuff
10064 @section Various Summary Stuff
10065
10066 @menu
10067 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10068 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10069 * Summary Generation Commands::
10070 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10071 @end menu
10072
10073 @table @code
10074 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10075 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10076 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10077 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10078 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10079 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10080
10081 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10082 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10083 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10084 current article.
10085
10086 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10087 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10088 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10089
10090 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10091 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10092 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10093 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10094 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10095 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10096 have been set.
10097
10098 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10099 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10100 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10101 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10102 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10103
10104 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10105 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10106 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10107 generated.
10108
10109 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10110 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10111 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10112 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10113 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10114 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10115 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10116 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10117 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10118 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10119
10120 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10121 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10122 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10123 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10124 list of articles to be selected.
10125
10126 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10127 the list in one particular group:
10128
10129 @lisp
10130 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10131 (if (string= group "some.group")
10132 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10133 articles))
10134 @end lisp
10135
10136 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10137 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10138 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10139 variables and their default values (when the default values are not
10140 @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary buffer is
10141 active. These variables can be used to set variables in the group
10142 parameters while still allowing them to affect operations done in
10143 other buffers. For example:
10144
10145 @lisp
10146 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10147 '(message-use-followup-to
10148 (gnus-visible-headers .
10149 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10150 @end lisp
10151
10152 @end table
10153
10154
10155 @node Summary Group Information
10156 @subsection Summary Group Information
10157
10158 @table @kbd
10159
10160 @item H f
10161 @kindex H f (Summary)
10162 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10163 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10164 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10165 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10166 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10167 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10168 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10169 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10170 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10171
10172 @item H d
10173 @kindex H d (Summary)
10174 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10175 Give a brief description of the current group
10176 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10177 rereading the description from the server.
10178
10179 @item H h
10180 @kindex H h (Summary)
10181 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10182 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10183 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10184
10185 @item H i
10186 @kindex H i (Summary)
10187 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10188 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10189 @end table
10190
10191
10192 @node Searching for Articles
10193 @subsection Searching for Articles
10194
10195 @table @kbd
10196
10197 @item M-s
10198 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10199 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10200 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10201 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10202
10203 @item M-r
10204 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10205 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10206 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10207 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10208
10209 @item &
10210 @kindex & (Summary)
10211 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10212 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10213 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10214 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10215 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10216 search backward instead.
10217
10218 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10219 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10220
10221 @item M-&
10222 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10223 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10224 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10225 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10226 @end table
10227
10228 @node Summary Generation Commands
10229 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10230
10231 @table @kbd
10232
10233 @item Y g
10234 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10235 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10236 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10237
10238 @item Y c
10239 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10240 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10241 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10242 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10243
10244 @item Y d
10245 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10246 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10247 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10248 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10249
10250 @end table
10251
10252
10253 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10254 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10255
10256 @table @kbd
10257
10258 @item A D
10259 @itemx C-d
10260 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10261 @kindex A D (Summary)
10262 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10263 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10264 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10265 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10266 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10267 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10268 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10269 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10270 fashion.
10271
10272 @item C-M-d
10273 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10274 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10275 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10276 several documents into one biiig group
10277 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10278 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10279 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10280 command understands the process/prefix convention
10281 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10282
10283 @item C-t
10284 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10285 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10286 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10287 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10288 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10289 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10290
10291 @item =
10292 @kindex = (Summary)
10293 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10294 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10295 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10296
10297 @item C-M-e
10298 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10299 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10300 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10301 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10302
10303 @item C-M-a
10304 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10305 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10306 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10307 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10308
10309 @end table
10310
10311
10312 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10313 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10314 @cindex summary exit
10315 @cindex exiting groups
10316
10317 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10318 group and return you to the group buffer.
10319
10320 @table @kbd
10321
10322 @item Z Z
10323 @itemx Z Q
10324 @itemx q
10325 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10326 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10327 @kindex q (Summary)
10328 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10329 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10330 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10331 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10332 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10333 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10334 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10335 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10336 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10337 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10338 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10339 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10340
10341 @item Z E
10342 @itemx Q
10343 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10344 @kindex Q (Summary)
10345 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10346 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10347 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10348
10349 @item Z c
10350 @itemx c
10351 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10352 @kindex c (Summary)
10353 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10354 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10355 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10356 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10357
10358 @item Z C
10359 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10360 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10361 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10362 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10363
10364 @item Z n
10365 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10366 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10367 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10368 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10369
10370 @item Z R
10371 @itemx C-x C-s
10372 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10373 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10374 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10375 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10376 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10377 all articles, both read and unread.
10378
10379 @item Z G
10380 @itemx M-g
10381 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10382 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10383 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10384 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10385 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10386 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10387 articles, both read and unread.
10388
10389 @item Z N
10390 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10391 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10392 Exit the group and go to the next group
10393 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10394
10395 @item Z P
10396 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10397 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10398 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10399 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10400
10401 @item Z s
10402 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10403 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10404 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10405 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10406 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10407 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10408 @end table
10409
10410 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10411 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10412 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10413 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10414
10415 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10416 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10417 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10418 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10419 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10420 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10421 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10422 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10423 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10424 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10425 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10426 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10427
10428 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10429
10430 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10431 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10432 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10433 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10434 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10435 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10436 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10437 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10438 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10439
10440
10441 @node Crosspost Handling
10442 @section Crosspost Handling
10443
10444 @cindex velveeta
10445 @cindex spamming
10446 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10447 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10448 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10449 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10450 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10451 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10452 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10453
10454 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10455 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10456 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10457 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10458 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10459
10460 @cindex cross-posting
10461 @cindex Xref
10462 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10463 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10464 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10465 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10466 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10467 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10468 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10469 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10470 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10471 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10472 the cross reference mechanism.
10473
10474 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10475 @cindex overview.fmt
10476 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10477 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10478 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10479 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10480 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10481 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10482 overview files.
10483
10484 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10485 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10486 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10487 considerably.
10488
10489 C'est la vie.
10490
10491 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10492
10493
10494 @node Duplicate Suppression
10495 @section Duplicate Suppression
10496
10497 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10498 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10499 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10500 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10501 reasons.
10502
10503 @enumerate
10504 @item
10505 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10506 is evil and not very common.
10507
10508 @item
10509 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10510 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10511
10512 @item
10513 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10514 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10515
10516 @item
10517 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10518 @end enumerate
10519
10520 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10521 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10522
10523 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10524 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10525 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10526 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10527 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10528 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10529 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10530 once.
10531
10532 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10533 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10534 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10535 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10536 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10537 saw the article in.
10538
10539 @table @code
10540 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10541 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10542 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10543
10544 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10545 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10546 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10547 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10548 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10549 session are suppressed.
10550
10551 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10552 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10553 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10554 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10555
10556 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10557 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10558 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10559 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10560 @end table
10561
10562 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10563 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10564 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10565 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10566 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10567 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10568 to you to figure out, I think.
10569
10570 @node Security
10571 @section Security
10572
10573 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10574 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10575 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10576 things to work:
10577
10578 @enumerate
10579 @item
10580 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10581 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10582 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10583 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10584
10585 @item
10586 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10587 or newer is recommended.
10588
10589 @end enumerate
10590
10591 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10592 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10593
10594 @table @code
10595 @item mm-verify-option
10596 @vindex mm-verify-option
10597 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10598 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10599 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10600
10601 @item mm-decrypt-option
10602 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10603 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10604 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10605 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10606
10607 @item mml1991-use
10608 @vindex mml1991-use
10609 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10610 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10611 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10612 deprecated.
10613
10614 @item mml2015-use
10615 @vindex mml2015-use
10616 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10617 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10618 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10619 deprecated.
10620
10621 @end table
10622
10623 @cindex snarfing keys
10624 @cindex importing PGP keys
10625 @cindex PGP key ring import
10626 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10627 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10628 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10629 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10630 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10631 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10632 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10633 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10634 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10635
10636 @example
10637 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10638 @end example
10639 @noindent
10640 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10641 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10642
10643 @node Mailing List
10644 @section Mailing List
10645 @cindex mailing list
10646 @cindex RFC 2396
10647
10648 @kindex A M (summary)
10649 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10650 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10651 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10652 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10653 summary buffer.
10654
10655 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10656
10657 @table @kbd
10658
10659 @item C-c C-n h
10660 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10661 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10662 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10663
10664 @item C-c C-n s
10665 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10666 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10667 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10668
10669 @item C-c C-n u
10670 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10671 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10672 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10673 field exists.
10674
10675 @item C-c C-n p
10676 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10677 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10678 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10679
10680 @item C-c C-n o
10681 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10682 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10683 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10684
10685 @item C-c C-n a
10686 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10687 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10688 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10689
10690 @end table
10691
10692
10693 @node Article Buffer
10694 @chapter Article Buffer
10695 @cindex article buffer
10696
10697 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10698 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10699 tell Gnus otherwise.
10700
10701 @menu
10702 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10703 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10704 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10705 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10706 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10707 @end menu
10708
10709
10710 @node Hiding Headers
10711 @section Hiding Headers
10712 @cindex hiding headers
10713 @cindex deleting headers
10714
10715 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10716 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10717
10718 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10719 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10720 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10721 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10722 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10723 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10724 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10725 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10726 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10727
10728 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10729
10730 @table @code
10731
10732 @item gnus-visible-headers
10733 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10734 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10735 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10736 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10737
10738 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10739 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10740
10741 @lisp
10742 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10743 @end lisp
10744
10745 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10746 remain visible.
10747
10748 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10749 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10750 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10751 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10752 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10753 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10754
10755 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10756 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10757
10758 @lisp
10759 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10760 @end lisp
10761
10762 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10763 be removed.
10764
10765 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10766 variable will have no effect.
10767
10768 @end table
10769
10770 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10771 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10772 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10773 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10774 the headers are to be displayed.
10775
10776 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10777 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10778
10779 @lisp
10780 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10781 @end lisp
10782
10783 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10784 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10785
10786 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10787 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10788 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10789 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10790 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10791 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10792 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10793 from sight.
10794
10795 These conditions are:
10796 @table @code
10797 @item empty
10798 Remove all empty headers.
10799 @item followup-to
10800 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10801 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10802 @item reply-to
10803 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10804 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10805 parameter is set.
10806 @item newsgroups
10807 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10808 name.
10809 @item to-address
10810 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10811 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10812 @item to-list
10813 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10814 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10815 @item cc-list
10816 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10817 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10818 @item date
10819 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10820 old.
10821 @item long-to
10822 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10823 @item many-to
10824 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10825 @end table
10826
10827 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10828
10829 @lisp
10830 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10831 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10832 @end lisp
10833
10834 This is also the default value for this variable.
10835
10836
10837 @node Using MIME
10838 @section Using MIME
10839 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10840
10841 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10842 while people stand around yawning.
10843
10844 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10845 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10846
10847 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10848 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10849 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10850
10851 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
10852 @findex gnus-display-mime
10853 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
10854 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
10855 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
10856 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
10857
10858 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
10859 @acronym{MIME} button:
10860
10861 @table @kbd
10862 @findex gnus-article-press-button
10863 @item RET (Article)
10864 @kindex RET (Article)
10865 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
10866 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
10867 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
10868 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
10869 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
10870 object is displayed inline.
10871
10872 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
10873 @item M-RET (Article)
10874 @kindex M-RET (Article)
10875 @itemx v (Article)
10876 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10877 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
10878
10879 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
10880 @item t (Article)
10881 @kindex t (Article)
10882 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
10883 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
10884
10885 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
10886 @item C (Article)
10887 @kindex C (Article)
10888 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
10889 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
10890
10891 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
10892 @item o (Article)
10893 @kindex o (Article)
10894 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
10895 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
10896
10897 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
10898 @item C-o (Article)
10899 @kindex C-o (Article)
10900 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
10901 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
10902 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
10903 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
10904 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10905 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
10906
10907 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
10908 @item d (Article)
10909 @kindex d (Article)
10910 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
10911 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
10912 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
10913
10914 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
10915 @item c (Article)
10916 @kindex c (Article)
10917 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
10918 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
10919 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
10920 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
10921 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
10922
10923 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
10924 @item p (Article)
10925 @kindex p (Article)
10926 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
10927 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
10928 @file{.mailcap} file.
10929
10930 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
10931 @item i (Article)
10932 @kindex i (Article)
10933 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
10934 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
10935 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
10936 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
10937 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
10938 Article}).
10939
10940 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
10941 @item E (Article)
10942 @kindex E (Article)
10943 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
10944 viewer is available, use an external viewer
10945 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
10946
10947 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
10948 @item e (Article)
10949 @kindex e (Article)
10950 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
10951 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
10952
10953 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
10954 @item | (Article)
10955 @kindex | (Article)
10956 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
10957
10958 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
10959 @item . (Article)
10960 @kindex . (Article)
10961 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
10962 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
10963
10964 @end table
10965
10966 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
10967 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
10968 @acronym{MIME} manual.
10969
10970 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
10971 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
10972 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
10973 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
10974 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
10975 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
10976 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
10977 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
10978 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
10979
10980 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
10981
10982 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
10983
10984
10985 @node Customizing Articles
10986 @section Customizing Articles
10987 @cindex article customization
10988
10989 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
10990 exist. You can call these functions interactively
10991 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
10992 called automatically when you select the articles.
10993
10994 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
10995 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
10996 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
10997 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
10998
10999 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11000 for sensible values.
11001
11002 @enumerate
11003 @item
11004 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11005
11006 @item
11007 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11008
11009 @item
11010 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11011
11012 @item
11013 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11014
11015 @item
11016 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11017 than this number.
11018
11019 @item
11020 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11021 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11022 regexps in the list.
11023
11024 @item
11025 A list where the first element is not a string:
11026
11027 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11028 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11029 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11030
11031 @lisp
11032 (or last
11033 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11034 @end lisp
11035
11036 @end enumerate
11037
11038 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11039 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11040 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11041 considered to contain just a single part.
11042
11043 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11044 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11045 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11046 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11047 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11048 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11049 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11050
11051 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11052 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11053 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11054 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11055
11056 @table @code
11057 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11058 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11059
11060 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11061
11062 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11063 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11064 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11065 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11066 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11067 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11068 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11069 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11070 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11071 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11072
11073 @xref{Article Washing}.
11074
11075 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11076 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11077 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11078 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11079 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11080 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11081 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11082
11083 @xref{Article Date}.
11084
11085 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11086 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11087 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11088
11089 @xref{Picons}.
11090
11091 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11092
11093 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11094
11095 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11096 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11097 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11098
11099 @xref{Smileys}.
11100
11101 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11102
11103 @xref{X-Face}.
11104
11105 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11106
11107 @xref{Face}.
11108
11109 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11110 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11111 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11112 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11113 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11114 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11115 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11116 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11117 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11118 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11119
11120 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11121
11122 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11123 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11124 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11125
11126 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11127
11128 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11129 @item gnus-treat-translate
11130 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11131
11132 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11133 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11134 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11135 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11136
11137 @xref{Article Header}.
11138
11139
11140 @end table
11141
11142 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11143 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11144 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11145 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11146 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11147 everything.
11148
11149
11150 @node Article Keymap
11151 @section Article Keymap
11152
11153 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11154 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11155 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11156 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11157 buffer.
11158
11159 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11160
11161 @table @kbd
11162
11163 @item SPACE
11164 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11165 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11166 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11167 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11168
11169 @item DEL
11170 @kindex DEL (Article)
11171 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11172 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11173 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11174
11175 @item C-c ^
11176 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11177 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11178 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11179 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11180 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11181
11182 @item C-c C-m
11183 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11184 @findex gnus-article-mail
11185 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11186 given a prefix, include the mail.
11187
11188 @item s
11189 @kindex s (Article)
11190 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11191 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11192 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11193
11194 @item ?
11195 @kindex ? (Article)
11196 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11197 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11198 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11199
11200 @item TAB
11201 @kindex TAB (Article)
11202 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11203 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11204 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11205
11206 @item M-TAB
11207 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11208 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11209 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11210
11211 @item R
11212 @kindex R (Article)
11213 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11214 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11215 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11216 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11217 region.
11218
11219 @item F
11220 @kindex F (Article)
11221 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11222 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11223 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11224 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11225 region.
11226
11227
11228 @end table
11229
11230
11231 @node Misc Article
11232 @section Misc Article
11233
11234 @table @code
11235
11236 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11237 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11238 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11239 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11240 article buffer.
11241
11242 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11243 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11244 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11245 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11246 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11247
11248 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11249 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11250 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11251 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11252 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11253 the contents of the article buffer.
11254
11255 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11256 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11257 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11258
11259 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11260 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11261 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11262 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11263
11264 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11265 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11266 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11267 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11268
11269 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11270 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11271 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11272 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
11273 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with two
11274 extensions:
11275
11276 @table @samp
11277
11278 @item w
11279 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11280 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11281 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11282
11283 @table @samp
11284
11285 @item c
11286 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11287
11288 @item h
11289 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11290
11291 @item p
11292 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11293 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11294 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11295
11296 @item s
11297 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11298
11299 @item o
11300 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11301
11302 @item e
11303 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11304
11305 @end table
11306
11307 @item m
11308 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11309
11310 @end table
11311
11312 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11313
11314 @item gnus-break-pages
11315 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11316 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11317 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11318 paging will not be done.
11319
11320 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11321 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11322 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11323 (formfeed).
11324
11325 @cindex IDNA
11326 @cindex internationalized domain names
11327 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11328 @item gnus-use-idna
11329 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11330 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11331 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11332 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11333 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11334
11335 @end table
11336
11337
11338 @node Composing Messages
11339 @chapter Composing Messages
11340 @cindex composing messages
11341 @cindex messages
11342 @cindex mail
11343 @cindex sending mail
11344 @cindex reply
11345 @cindex followup
11346 @cindex post
11347 @cindex using gpg
11348 @cindex using s/mime
11349 @cindex using smime
11350
11351 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11352 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11353 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11354 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11355 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11356 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11357
11358 @menu
11359 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11360 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11361 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11362 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11363 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11364 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11365 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11366 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11367 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11368 @end menu
11369
11370 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11371 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11372
11373
11374 @node Mail
11375 @section Mail
11376
11377 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11378
11379 @table @code
11380 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11381 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11382 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11383 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11384 @code{nil} include all headers.
11385
11386 @item gnus-add-to-list
11387 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11388 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11389 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11390
11391 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11392 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11393 This can also be a function receiving the group name as the only
11394 parameter which should return non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is
11395 needed, or a regular expression matching group names, where
11396 confirmation is should be asked for.
11397
11398 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11399 press R anyway, this variable might be for you.
11400
11401 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11402 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11403 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11404 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11405 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11406
11407 @end table
11408
11409
11410 @node Posting Server
11411 @section Posting Server
11412
11413 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11414 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11415
11416 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11417
11418 It can be quite complicated.
11419
11420 @vindex gnus-post-method
11421 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11422 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11423 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11424 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11425 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11426 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11427 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11428 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11429 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11430
11431 @lisp
11432 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11433 @end lisp
11434
11435 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11436 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11437 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11438 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11439
11440 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11441 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11442
11443 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11444 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11445 for posting.
11446
11447 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11448 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11449
11450 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11451 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11452 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11453 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11454 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11455 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11456 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11457 package correctly. An example:
11458
11459 @lisp
11460 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11461 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11462 @end lisp
11463
11464 To the thing similar to this, there is
11465 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11466 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11467 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11468
11469 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11470 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11471 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11472
11473 @node POP before SMTP
11474 @section POP before SMTP
11475 @cindex pop before smtp
11476 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11477 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11478
11479 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11480 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11481 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11482 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11483 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11484
11485 @lisp
11486 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11487 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11488 @end lisp
11489
11490 @noindent
11491 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11492 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11493 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11494 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11495 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11496 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11497 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11498 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11499
11500 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11501 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11502 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11503 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11504 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11505 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11506
11507 @lisp
11508 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11509 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11510 :password "secret"))
11511 @end lisp
11512
11513 @noindent
11514 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11515 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11516
11517 @lisp
11518 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11519 (lambda ()
11520 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11521 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11522 :password "secret")))
11523 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11524 @end lisp
11525
11526 @node Mail and Post
11527 @section Mail and Post
11528
11529 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11530 posting:
11531
11532 @table @code
11533 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11534 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11535 @cindex mailing lists
11536
11537 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11538 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11539 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11540 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11541 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11542 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11543 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11544 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11545 still a pain, though.
11546
11547 @item gnus-user-agent
11548 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11549 @cindex User-Agent
11550
11551 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11552 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11553 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11554 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11555 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11556 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11557 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11558
11559 @end table
11560
11561 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11562 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11563 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11564
11565 @cindex ispell
11566 @findex ispell-message
11567 @lisp
11568 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11569 @end lisp
11570
11571 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11572 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11573
11574 @lisp
11575 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11576 (lambda ()
11577 (cond
11578 ((string-match
11579 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11580 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11581 (t
11582 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11583 @end lisp
11584
11585 Modify to suit your needs.
11586
11587
11588 @node Archived Messages
11589 @section Archived Messages
11590 @cindex archived messages
11591 @cindex sent messages
11592
11593 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11594 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11595 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11596 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11597 is the default.
11598
11599 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11600 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11601 Group Commands}).
11602
11603 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11604 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11605 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11606
11607 @lisp
11608 (nnfolder "archive"
11609 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11610 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11611 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11612 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11613 @end lisp
11614
11615 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11616 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11617 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11618 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11619
11620 @lisp
11621 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11622 '(nnfolder "archive"
11623 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11624 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11625 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11626 @end lisp
11627
11628 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11629 @cindex Gcc
11630 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11631 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11632 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11633
11634 This variable can be used to do the following:
11635
11636 @table @asis
11637 @item a string
11638 Messages will be saved in that group.
11639
11640 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11641 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11642 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11643 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11644 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11645 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11646 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11647 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11648 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11649
11650 @item a list of strings
11651 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11652
11653 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11654 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11655
11656 @item @code{nil}
11657 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11658 @end table
11659
11660 Let's illustrate:
11661
11662 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11663 @lisp
11664 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11665 @end lisp
11666
11667 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11668 @lisp
11669 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11670 @end lisp
11671
11672 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11673 @lisp
11674 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11675 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11676 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11677 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11678 @end lisp
11679
11680 More complex stuff:
11681 @lisp
11682 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11683 '((if (message-news-p)
11684 "misc-news"
11685 "misc-mail")))
11686 @end lisp
11687
11688 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11689 messages in one file per month:
11690
11691 @lisp
11692 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11693 '((if (message-news-p)
11694 "misc-news"
11695 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11696 @end lisp
11697
11698 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11699 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11700
11701 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11702 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11703 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11704 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11705 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11706 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11707 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11708 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11709 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11710 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11711
11712 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11713 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11714 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11715 this will disable archiving.
11716
11717 @table @code
11718 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11719 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11720 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11721 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11722 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11723 group names.
11724
11725 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11726 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11727 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11728 of names).
11729
11730 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11731 but the latter is the preferred method.
11732
11733 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11734 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11735 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11736
11737 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11738 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11739 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11740 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11741 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11742 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11743 changed in the future.
11744
11745 @end table
11746
11747
11748 @node Posting Styles
11749 @section Posting Styles
11750 @cindex posting styles
11751 @cindex styles
11752
11753 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11754
11755 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11756 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11757 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11758 on?
11759
11760 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11761 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11762 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11763 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11764 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11765 variable:
11766
11767 @lisp
11768 ((".*"
11769 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11770 (organization "What me?"))
11771 ("^comp"
11772 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11773 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11774 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11775 @end lisp
11776
11777 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11778 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11779 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11780 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11781 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11782 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11783 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11784 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11785
11786 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11787 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11788 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11789 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11790 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11791 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11792 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11793 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11794 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11795 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11796 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11797 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11798 said to @dfn{match}.
11799
11800 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11801 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11802 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11803 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11804 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11805 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11806 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11807 name can be one of:
11808
11809 @itemize @bullet
11810 @item @code{signature}
11811 @item @code{signature-file}
11812 @item @code{x-face-file}
11813 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11814 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11815 @item @code{body}
11816 @end itemize
11817
11818 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11819 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11820 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11821 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11822 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11823
11824 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11825 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11826 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11827 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11828 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11829 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11830 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11831 references chars lines xref extra.
11832
11833 @vindex message-reply-headers
11834
11835 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11836 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11837 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11838
11839 @findex message-mail-p
11840 @findex message-news-p
11841
11842 So here's a new example:
11843
11844 @lisp
11845 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11846 '((".*"
11847 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11848 (name "User Name")
11849 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11850 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11851 ("^rec.humor"
11852 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11853 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
11854 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11855 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
11856 (signature my-news-signature))
11857 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
11858 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11859 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
11860 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
11861 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11862 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
11863 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11864 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11865 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11866 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11867 ("nnml:.*"
11868 (From (save-excursion
11869 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11870 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11871 ("^nn.+:"
11872 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11873 @end lisp
11874
11875 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11876 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11877 if you fill many roles.
11878
11879
11880 @node Drafts
11881 @section Drafts
11882 @cindex drafts
11883
11884 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11885 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11886 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11887 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11888 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11889
11890 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11891 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11892 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11893 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11894 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11895 group.)
11896
11897 @cindex nndraft
11898 @vindex nndraft-directory
11899 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11900 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11901 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11902 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11903 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11904 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11905
11906 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11907 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11908 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
11909 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
11910 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
11911 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
11912 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
11913 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
11914 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
11915
11916 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11917 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11918 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11919 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11920 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11921 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11922 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11923 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11924 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11925 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11926 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11927 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11928 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11929 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11930 @c
11931 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11932 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11933 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11934
11935 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11936 @kindex D e (Draft)
11937 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
11938 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
11939 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
11940
11941 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
11942 Articles}).
11943
11944 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
11945 @kindex D s (Draft)
11946 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
11947 @kindex D S (Draft)
11948 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
11949 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
11950 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
11951 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
11952 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
11953 in the buffer.
11954
11955 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
11956 @kindex D t (Draft)
11957 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
11958 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
11959 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
11960
11961
11962 @node Rejected Articles
11963 @section Rejected Articles
11964 @cindex rejected articles
11965
11966 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
11967 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
11968 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
11969 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
11970
11971 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
11972 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
11973 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
11974 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
11975 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
11976
11977 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
11978 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
11979 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
11980
11981 @node Signing and encrypting
11982 @section Signing and encrypting
11983 @cindex using gpg
11984 @cindex using s/mime
11985 @cindex using smime
11986
11987 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
11988 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
11989 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
11990 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
11991
11992 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
11993 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
11994 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
11995 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
11996 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
11997 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
11998 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
11999 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12000 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12001 automatically encrypted messages.
12002
12003 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12004 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12005 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12006
12007 @table @kbd
12008
12009 @item C-c C-m s s
12010 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12011 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12012
12013 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12014
12015 @item C-c C-m s o
12016 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12017 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12018
12019 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12020
12021 @item C-c C-m s p
12022 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12023 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12024
12025 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12026
12027 @item C-c C-m c s
12028 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12029 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12030
12031 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12032
12033 @item C-c C-m c o
12034 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12035 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12036
12037 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12038
12039 @item C-c C-m c p
12040 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12041 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12042
12043 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12044
12045 @item C-c C-m C-n
12046 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12047 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12048 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12049
12050 @end table
12051
12052 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12053
12054 @node Select Methods
12055 @chapter Select Methods
12056 @cindex foreign groups
12057 @cindex select methods
12058
12059 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12060 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12061 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12062 personal mail group.
12063
12064 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12065 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12066 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12067 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12068 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12069 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12070
12071 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12072 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12073
12074 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12075 group as.
12076
12077 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12078 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12079 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12080 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12081 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12082
12083 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12084
12085 @menu
12086 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12087 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12088 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12089 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12090 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12091 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12092 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12093 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12094 @end menu
12095
12096
12097 @node Server Buffer
12098 @section Server Buffer
12099
12100 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12101 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12102 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12103 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12104 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12105 back end represents a virtual server.
12106
12107 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12108 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12109 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12110 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12111
12112 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12113 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12114 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12115 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12116 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12117 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12118 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12119
12120 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12121 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12122
12123 @menu
12124 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12125 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12126 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12127 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12128 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12129 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12130 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12131 @end menu
12132
12133 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12134 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12135
12136
12137 @node Server Buffer Format
12138 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12139 @cindex server buffer format
12140
12141 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12142 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12143 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12144 variable, with some simple extensions:
12145
12146 @table @samp
12147
12148 @item h
12149 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12150
12151 @item n
12152 The name of this server.
12153
12154 @item w
12155 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12156
12157 @item s
12158 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12159 @end table
12160
12161 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12162 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12163 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12164 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12165
12166 @table @samp
12167 @item S
12168 Server name.
12169
12170 @item M
12171 Server method.
12172 @end table
12173
12174 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12175
12176
12177 @node Server Commands
12178 @subsection Server Commands
12179 @cindex server commands
12180
12181 @table @kbd
12182
12183 @item a
12184 @kindex a (Server)
12185 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12186 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12187
12188 @item e
12189 @kindex e (Server)
12190 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12191 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12192
12193 @item SPACE
12194 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12195 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12196 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12197
12198 @item q
12199 @kindex q (Server)
12200 @findex gnus-server-exit
12201 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12202
12203 @item k
12204 @kindex k (Server)
12205 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12206 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12207
12208 @item y
12209 @kindex y (Server)
12210 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12211 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12212
12213 @item c
12214 @kindex c (Server)
12215 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12216 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12217
12218 @item l
12219 @kindex l (Server)
12220 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12221 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12222
12223 @item s
12224 @kindex s (Server)
12225 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12226 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12227 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12228 servers.
12229
12230 @item g
12231 @kindex g (Server)
12232 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12233 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12234 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12235 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12236
12237 @end table
12238
12239
12240 @node Example Methods
12241 @subsection Example Methods
12242
12243 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12244
12245 @lisp
12246 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12247 @end lisp
12248
12249 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12250
12251 @lisp
12252 (nnspool "")
12253 @end lisp
12254
12255 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12256 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12257 will.
12258
12259 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12260 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12261
12262 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12263 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12264 look like then:
12265
12266 @lisp
12267 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12268 @end lisp
12269
12270 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12271 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12272
12273 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12274 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12275 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12276 your private mail:
12277
12278 @lisp
12279 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12280 @end lisp
12281
12282 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12283 that.)
12284
12285 Here's the method for a public spool:
12286
12287 @lisp
12288 (nnmh "public"
12289 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12290 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12291 @end lisp
12292
12293 @cindex proxy
12294 @cindex firewall
12295
12296 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12297 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12298 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12299 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12300 should probably look something like this:
12301
12302 @lisp
12303 (nntp "firewall"
12304 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12305 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12306 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12307 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12308 @end lisp
12309
12310 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12311 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12312 configuration to the example above:
12313
12314 @lisp
12315 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12316 @end lisp
12317
12318 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12319
12320 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12321 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12322 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12323
12324 @lisp
12325 (nntp "outside"
12326 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12327 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12328 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12329 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12330 @end lisp
12331
12332 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12333 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12334 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12335 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12336
12337
12338 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12339 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12340
12341 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12342 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12343
12344 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12345 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12346 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12347
12348 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12349
12350 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12351 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12352 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12353 will contain the following:
12354
12355 @lisp
12356 (nnml "cache")
12357 @end lisp
12358
12359 Change that to:
12360
12361 @lisp
12362 (nnml "cache"
12363 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12364 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12365 @end lisp
12366
12367 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12368 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12369 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12370
12371
12372 @node Server Variables
12373 @subsection Server Variables
12374 @cindex server variables
12375 @cindex server parameters
12376
12377 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12378 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12379 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12380 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12381 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12382
12383 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12384 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12385 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12386 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12387 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12388 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12389 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12390 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12391 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12392
12393 @lisp
12394 (nnml "public"
12395 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12396 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12397 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12398 @end lisp
12399
12400 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12401
12402 @node Servers and Methods
12403 @subsection Servers and Methods
12404
12405 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12406 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12407 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12408 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12409 over.
12410
12411
12412 @node Unavailable Servers
12413 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12414
12415 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12416 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12417 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12418 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12419 actually the case or not.
12420
12421 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12422 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12423 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12424 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12425 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12426 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12427 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12428 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12429
12430 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12431 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12432
12433 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12434 with the following commands:
12435
12436 @table @kbd
12437
12438 @item O
12439 @kindex O (Server)
12440 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12441 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12442 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12443
12444 @item C
12445 @kindex C (Server)
12446 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12447 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12448 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12449
12450 @item D
12451 @kindex D (Server)
12452 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12453 Mark the current server as unreachable
12454 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12455
12456 @item M-o
12457 @kindex M-o (Server)
12458 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12459 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12460 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12461
12462 @item M-c
12463 @kindex M-c (Server)
12464 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12465 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12466 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12467
12468 @item R
12469 @kindex R (Server)
12470 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12471 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12472 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12473
12474 @item L
12475 @kindex L (Server)
12476 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12477 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12478
12479 @end table
12480
12481
12482 @node Getting News
12483 @section Getting News
12484 @cindex reading news
12485 @cindex news back ends
12486
12487 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12488 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12489 or it can read from a local spool.
12490
12491 @menu
12492 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12493 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12494 @end menu
12495
12496
12497 @node NNTP
12498 @subsection NNTP
12499 @cindex nntp
12500
12501 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12502 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12503 server as the, uhm, address.
12504
12505 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12506 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12507 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12508 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12509
12510 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12511 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12512 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12513
12514 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12515 server:
12516
12517 @table @code
12518
12519 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12520 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12521 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12522 @cindex authinfo
12523 @cindex authentification
12524 @cindex nntp authentification
12525 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12526 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12527 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12528 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12529 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12530 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12531 present in this hook.
12532
12533 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12534 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12535 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12536 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12537 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12538 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12539 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12540 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12541 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12542 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12543 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12544 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12545
12546 @enumerate
12547 @item
12548 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12549
12550 @item
12551 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12552
12553 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12554 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12555 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12556 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12557 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12558 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12559 @samp{force} is explained below.
12560
12561 @end enumerate
12562
12563 Here's an example file:
12564
12565 @example
12566 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12567 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12568 @end example
12569
12570 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12571 have to be first, for instance.
12572
12573 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12574 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12575 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12576 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12577 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12578 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12579 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12580
12581 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12582 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12583
12584 @example
12585 default force yes
12586 @end example
12587
12588 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12589 previously mentioned.
12590
12591 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12592
12593 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12594 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12595 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12596 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12597 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12598
12599 @lisp
12600 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12601 '(("innd" (ding))))
12602 @end lisp
12603
12604 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12605
12606 The default value is
12607
12608 @lisp
12609 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12610 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12611 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12612 @end lisp
12613
12614 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12615 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12616
12617 @item nntp-maximum-request
12618 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12619 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12620 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12621 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12622 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12623 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12624 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12625
12626 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12627 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12628 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12629 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12630 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12631 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12632 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12633 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12634 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12635 no timeouts are done.
12636
12637 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
12638 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
12639 @c @cindex PPP connections
12640 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
12641 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
12642 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
12643 @c changes after connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will simply sit
12644 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
12645 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
12646 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
12647 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
12648 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
12649 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
12650 @c
12651 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
12652 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
12653 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
12654 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
12655 @c described above.
12656
12657 @item nntp-server-hook
12658 @vindex nntp-server-hook
12659 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @acronym{NNTP}
12660 server.
12661
12662 @item nntp-buggy-select
12663 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
12664 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
12665
12666 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12667 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12668 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12669 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12670 can be used.
12671
12672 @item nntp-xover-commands
12673 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12674 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12675 @cindex XOVER
12676 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12677 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12678 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12679
12680 @item nntp-nov-gap
12681 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12682 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12683 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12684 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12685 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12686 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12687 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12688 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12689 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12690 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12691 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12692
12693 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12694 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12695 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12696
12697 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12698 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
12699 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
12700 server closes connection.
12701
12702 @item nntp-record-commands
12703 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12704 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12705 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12706 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12707 that doesn't seem to work.
12708
12709 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12710 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12711 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12712 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12713 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12714 Five pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12715 two categories: direct connection functions (three pre-made), and
12716 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12717
12718 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12719 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12720 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12721 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12722 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12723 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12724 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12725
12726 @lisp
12727 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12728 @end lisp
12729
12730 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12731 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12732
12733 @item nntp-read-timeout
12734 @vindex nntp-read-timeout
12735 How long nntp should wait between checking for the end of output.
12736 Shorter values mean quicker response, but is more CPU intensive. The
12737 default is 0.1 seconds. If you have a slow line to the server (and
12738 don't like to see Emacs eat your available CPU power), you might set
12739 this to, say, 1.
12740
12741 @end table
12742
12743 @menu
12744 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12745 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12746 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12747 @end menu
12748
12749
12750 @node Direct Functions
12751 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12752 @cindex direct connection functions
12753
12754 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12755 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12756 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12757 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12758
12759 @table @code
12760 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12761 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12762 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12763 remote system.
12764
12765 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12766 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12767 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12768 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12769 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12770
12771 @lisp
12772 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12773 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12774 ;;
12775 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12776 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12777 (nntp-port-number )
12778 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12779 @end lisp
12780
12781 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12782 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12783 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12784 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12785 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12786 then define a server as follows:
12787
12788 @lisp
12789 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12790 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12791 ;;
12792 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12793 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12794 (nntp-port-number 563)
12795 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12796 @end lisp
12797
12798 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12799 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12800 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12801 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12802 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12803 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12804 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12805 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12806
12807 @lisp
12808 (nntp "socksified"
12809 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12810 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12811 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12812 @end lisp
12813
12814 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12815 session, which is not a good idea.
12816 @end table
12817
12818
12819 @node Indirect Functions
12820 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12821 @cindex indirect connection functions
12822
12823 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12824 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12825 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12826 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12827 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12828 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12829
12830 @table @code
12831 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12832 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12833 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12834 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12835 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12836
12837 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12838
12839 @table @code
12840 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12841 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12842 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12843 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12844
12845 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12846 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12847 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12848 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12849 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12850 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12851 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12852 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12853 host.
12854 @end table
12855
12856 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12857 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12858 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12859 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12860
12861 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12862
12863 @table @code
12864 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12865 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12866 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12867 @samp{telnet}.
12868
12869 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12870 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12871 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12872 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12873
12874 @item nntp-via-user-password
12875 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12876 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12877
12878 @item nntp-via-envuser
12879 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12880 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12881 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12882 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12883
12884 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12885 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12886 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12887 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12888
12889 @end table
12890
12891 @end table
12892
12893
12894 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12895 functions:
12896
12897 @table @code
12898
12899 @item nntp-via-user-name
12900 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12901 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12902
12903 @item nntp-via-address
12904 @vindex nntp-via-address
12905 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12906
12907 @end table
12908
12909
12910 @node Common Variables
12911 @subsubsection Common Variables
12912
12913 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12914 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12915 affected.
12916
12917 @table @code
12918
12919 @item nntp-pre-command
12920 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12921 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
12922 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
12923 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}. This is
12924 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
12925
12926 @item nntp-address
12927 @vindex nntp-address
12928 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12929
12930 @item nntp-port-number
12931 @vindex nntp-port-number
12932 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12933 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
12934 @acronym{tls}/@acronym{ssl}, you may want to use integer ports rather
12935 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
12936 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
12937 not work with named ports.
12938
12939 @item nntp-end-of-line
12940 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12941 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
12942 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12943 using a non native connection function.
12944
12945 @item nntp-telnet-command
12946 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12947 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
12948 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
12949 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
12950 @samp{telnet}.
12951
12952 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12953 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12954 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12955 is @samp{("-8")}.
12956
12957 @end table
12958
12959
12960 @node News Spool
12961 @subsection News Spool
12962 @cindex nnspool
12963 @cindex news spool
12964
12965 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
12966 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
12967 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
12968 instance.
12969
12970 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
12971 anything else) as the address.
12972
12973 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
12974 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
12975 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
12976 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
12977
12978 @table @code
12979
12980 @item nnspool-inews-program
12981 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
12982 Program used to post an article.
12983
12984 @item nnspool-inews-switches
12985 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
12986 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
12987
12988 @item nnspool-spool-directory
12989 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
12990 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
12991 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
12992
12993 @item nnspool-nov-directory
12994 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
12995 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
12996 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
12997
12998 @item nnspool-lib-dir
12999 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13000 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13001
13002 @item nnspool-active-file
13003 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13004 The name of the active file.
13005
13006 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13007 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13008 The name of the group descriptions file.
13009
13010 @item nnspool-history-file
13011 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13012 The name of the news history file.
13013
13014 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13015 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13016 The name of the active date file.
13017
13018 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13019 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13020 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13021 that it finds.
13022
13023 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13024 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13025 @cindex sed
13026 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13027 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13028 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13029 there.
13030
13031 @end table
13032
13033
13034 @node Getting Mail
13035 @section Getting Mail
13036 @cindex reading mail
13037 @cindex mail
13038
13039 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13040 course.
13041
13042 @menu
13043 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13044 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13045 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13046 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13047 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13048 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13049 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13050 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13051 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13052 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13053 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13054 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13055 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13056 @end menu
13057
13058
13059 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13060 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13061
13062 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13063 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13064 of a culture shock.
13065
13066 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13067 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13068
13069 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13070 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13071 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13072 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13073
13074 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13075
13076 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13077 deleted? How awful!
13078
13079 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13080 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13081 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13082 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13083 Mail}.
13084
13085 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13086 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13087 they want to treat a message.
13088
13089 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13090 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13091 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13092 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13093 archived somewhere else.
13094
13095 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13096 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13097 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13098 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13099 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13100
13101 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13102 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13103 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13104
13105 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13106 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13107 differently.
13108
13109 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13110 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13111 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13112 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13113 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13114
13115 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13116 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13117 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13118 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13119 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13120 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13121 You Do.)
13122
13123
13124 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13125 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13126
13127 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13128 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13129 and things will happen automatically.
13130
13131 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13132 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13133
13134 @lisp
13135 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13136 @end lisp
13137
13138 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13139 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13140 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13141 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13142 like any other group.
13143
13144 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13145
13146 @lisp
13147 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13148 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13149 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13150 ("other" "")))
13151 @end lisp
13152
13153 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13154 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13155 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13156 last group.
13157
13158 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13159 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13160 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13161
13162
13163 @node Splitting Mail
13164 @subsection Splitting Mail
13165 @cindex splitting mail
13166 @cindex mail splitting
13167 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13168
13169 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13170 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13171 to be split into groups.
13172
13173 @lisp
13174 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13175 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13176 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13177 ("mail.other" "")))
13178 @end lisp
13179
13180 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13181 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13182 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13183 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13184 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13185 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13186 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13187
13188 @lisp
13189 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13190 @end lisp
13191
13192 @noindent
13193 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13194 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13195
13196 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13197 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13198 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13199 mail belongs in that group.
13200
13201 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13202 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{*} so that it matches any mails
13203 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13204 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
13205 rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled.
13206 In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.)
13207
13208 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13209 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13210 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13211 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13212 thinks should carry this mail message.
13213
13214 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13215 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13216 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13217 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13218
13219 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13220 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13221 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13222 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13223 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{*}) group.
13224
13225 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13226 @cindex crosspost
13227 @cindex links
13228 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13229 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13230 links. If that's the case for you, set
13231 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13232 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13233
13234 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13235 @findex nnmail-split-history
13236 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13237 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13238 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13239 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13240 Group Commands}).
13241
13242 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13243 Header lines longer than the value of
13244 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13245 function.
13246
13247 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13248 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13249 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13250 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13251 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13252 charset for decoding. The behaviour can be turned off completely by
13253 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13254 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13255
13256 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13257 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13258 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13259 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13260 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13261 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13262 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13263 other kinds of entries.)
13264
13265 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13266 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13267 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13268 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13269 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13270 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13271 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13272 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13273 month's rent money.
13274
13275
13276 @node Mail Sources
13277 @subsection Mail Sources
13278
13279 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13280 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13281 maildir, for instance.
13282
13283 @menu
13284 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13285 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13286 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13287 @end menu
13288
13289
13290 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13291 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13292 @cindex POP
13293 @cindex mail server
13294 @cindex procmail
13295 @cindex mail spool
13296 @cindex mail source
13297
13298 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13299 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13300
13301 Here's an example:
13302
13303 @lisp
13304 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13305 @end lisp
13306
13307 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13308 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13309 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13310 default values.
13311
13312 The following mail source types are available:
13313
13314 @table @code
13315 @item file
13316 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13317
13318 Keywords:
13319
13320 @table @code
13321 @item :path
13322 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13323 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13324 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13325
13326 @item :prescript
13327 @itemx :postscript
13328 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13329 @end table
13330
13331 An example file mail source:
13332
13333 @lisp
13334 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13335 @end lisp
13336
13337 Or using the default file name:
13338
13339 @lisp
13340 (file)
13341 @end lisp
13342
13343 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13344 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13345 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13346 mail spool while moving the mail.
13347
13348 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13349
13350 @lisp
13351 (setq mail-sources
13352 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13353 @end lisp
13354
13355 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13356
13357 @example
13358 #!/bin/sh
13359 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13360 # flu@@iki.fi
13361
13362 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13363 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13364 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13365 @end example
13366
13367 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13368
13369
13370 @item directory
13371 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13372 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13373 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13374 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13375 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13376 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13377 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13378 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13379 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13380 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13381
13382 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13383 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13384 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13385 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13386
13387 Keywords:
13388
13389 @table @code
13390 @item :path
13391 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13392 value.
13393
13394 @item :suffix
13395 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13396 @samp{.spool}.
13397
13398 @item :predicate
13399 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13400 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13401 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13402 predicate are considered.
13403
13404 @item :prescript
13405 @itemx :postscript
13406 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13407
13408 @end table
13409
13410 An example directory mail source:
13411
13412 @lisp
13413 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13414 :suffix ".prcml")
13415 @end lisp
13416
13417 @item pop
13418 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13419
13420 Keywords:
13421
13422 @table @code
13423 @item :server
13424 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13425 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13426
13427 @item :port
13428 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13429 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13430 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13431 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13432 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13433
13434 @item :user
13435 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13436 name.
13437
13438 @item :password
13439 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13440 the user is prompted.
13441
13442 @item :program
13443 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13444 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13445
13446 @example
13447 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13448 @end example
13449
13450 The valid format specifier characters are:
13451
13452 @table @samp
13453 @item t
13454 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13455 included in this string.
13456
13457 @item s
13458 The name of the server.
13459
13460 @item P
13461 The port number of the server.
13462
13463 @item u
13464 The user name to use.
13465
13466 @item p
13467 The password to use.
13468 @end table
13469
13470 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13471 corresponding keywords.
13472
13473 @item :prescript
13474 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13475 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13476
13477 @item :postscript
13478 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13479 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13480
13481 @item :function
13482 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13483 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13484 mail should be moved to.
13485
13486 @item :authentication
13487 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13488 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13489 @code{password}.
13490
13491 @end table
13492
13493 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13494 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13495 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13496 left on the POP server after fetching.
13497
13498 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13499 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13500
13501 @lisp
13502 (pop)
13503 @end lisp
13504
13505 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13506
13507 @lisp
13508 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13509 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13510 @end lisp
13511
13512 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13513
13514 @lisp
13515 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13516 @end lisp
13517
13518 @item maildir
13519 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13520 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13521 contains exactly one mail.
13522
13523 Keywords:
13524
13525 @table @code
13526 @item :path
13527 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13528 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13529 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13530 @item :subdirs
13531 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13532 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13533
13534 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13535 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13536 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13537 @c below.
13538
13539 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13540 from locking problems).
13541
13542 @end table
13543
13544 Two example maildir mail sources:
13545
13546 @lisp
13547 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13548 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13549 @end lisp
13550
13551 @lisp
13552 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13553 :subdirs ("new"))
13554 @end lisp
13555
13556 @item imap
13557 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13558 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13559 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13560 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13561 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13562
13563 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13564 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13565
13566 Keywords:
13567
13568 @table @code
13569 @item :server
13570 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13571 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13572
13573 @item :port
13574 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13575 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13576
13577 @item :user
13578 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13579 name.
13580
13581 @item :password
13582 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13583 prompted.
13584
13585 @item :stream
13586 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13587 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13588 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13589 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13590
13591 @item :authentication
13592 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13593 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13594 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13595 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13596
13597 @item :program
13598 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13599 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13600 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13601
13602 @example
13603 ssh %s imapd
13604 @end example
13605
13606 The valid format specifier characters are:
13607
13608 @table @samp
13609 @item s
13610 The name of the server.
13611
13612 @item l
13613 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13614
13615 @item p
13616 The port number of the server.
13617 @end table
13618
13619 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13620 corresponding keywords.
13621
13622 @item :mailbox
13623 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13624 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13625
13626 @item :predicate
13627 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13628 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13629 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13630 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13631 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13632 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13633
13634 @item :fetchflag
13635 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13636 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13637 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13638 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13639
13640 @item :dontexpunge
13641 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13642 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13643
13644 @end table
13645
13646 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13647
13648 @lisp
13649 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13650 :stream kerberos4
13651 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13652 @end lisp
13653
13654 @item webmail
13655 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13656 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13657 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13658
13659 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13660 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13661
13662 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13663
13664 Keywords:
13665
13666 @table @code
13667 @item :subtype
13668 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13669 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13670
13671 @item :user
13672 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13673 name.
13674
13675 @item :password
13676 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13677 prompted.
13678
13679 @item :dontexpunge
13680 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13681 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13682
13683 @end table
13684
13685 An example webmail source:
13686
13687 @lisp
13688 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13689 :user "user-name"
13690 :password "secret")
13691 @end lisp
13692 @end table
13693
13694 @table @dfn
13695 @item Common Keywords
13696 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13697
13698 Keywords:
13699
13700 @table @code
13701 @item :plugged
13702 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13703 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13704 example:
13705
13706 @lisp
13707 (setq mail-sources
13708 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13709 :suffix ""
13710 :plugged t)))
13711 @end lisp
13712
13713 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13714 useful when you use local mail and news.
13715
13716 @end table
13717 @end table
13718
13719 @subsubsection Function Interface
13720
13721 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13722 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13723 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13724 consider the following mail-source setting:
13725
13726 @lisp
13727 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13728 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13729 @end lisp
13730
13731 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13732 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13733 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13734 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13735 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13736
13737 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13738
13739
13740 @node Mail Source Customization
13741 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13742
13743 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13744 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13745 variables.
13746
13747 @table @code
13748 @item mail-source-crash-box
13749 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13750 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13751 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13752
13753 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13754 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13755 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13756 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13757 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13758 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13759 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13760 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13761
13762 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13763 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13764 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13765 files. This variable only applies when
13766 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13767
13768 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13769 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13770 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13771
13772 @item mail-source-directory
13773 @vindex mail-source-directory
13774 Directory where files (if any) will be stored. The default is
13775 @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for is to say
13776 where the incoming files will be stored if the previous variable is
13777 @code{nil}.
13778
13779 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13780 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13781 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13782 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13783 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13784 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
13785
13786 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13787 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13788 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13789
13790 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13791 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13792 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13793 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13794
13795 @end table
13796
13797
13798 @node Fetching Mail
13799 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13800
13801 @vindex mail-sources
13802 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13803 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13804 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13805 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13806
13807 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13808 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13809 themselves.
13810
13811 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13812 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13813
13814 @lisp
13815 (setq mail-sources
13816 '((file)
13817 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13818 :password "secret")))
13819 @end lisp
13820
13821 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13822
13823 @lisp
13824 (setq mail-sources
13825 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13826 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13827 :user "user-name"
13828 :port "pop3"
13829 :password "secret")))
13830 @end lisp
13831
13832
13833 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13834 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13835 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13836 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13837 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13838 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13839
13840
13841
13842 @node Mail Back End Variables
13843 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13844
13845 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13846 mail back ends.
13847
13848 @table @code
13849 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13850 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13851 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13852 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13853
13854 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13855 @item nnmail-split-hook
13856 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
13857 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
13858 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
13859 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13860 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13861 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13862 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13863 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13864 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13865 to this hook.
13866
13867 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13868 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13869 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13870 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13871 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13872 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13873 starting to handle the new mail) and
13874 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13875 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13876 default file modes the new mail files get:
13877
13878 @lisp
13879 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13880 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13881
13882 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13883 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13884 @end lisp
13885
13886 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13887 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13888 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13889 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13890 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13891 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13892 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13893
13894 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13895 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13896 @findex delete-file
13897 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13898
13899 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13900 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13901 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13902 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13903 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13904
13905 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13906 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13907 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13908 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13909 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13910
13911 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13912 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13913 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13914
13915 @end table
13916
13917
13918 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13919 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13920 @cindex mail splitting
13921 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13922
13923 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13924 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13925 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13926 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13927 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13928 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13929
13930 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13931
13932 @lisp
13933 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
13934 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
13935 ;; @r{from real errors.}
13936 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13937 "mail.misc"))
13938 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
13939 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
13940 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
13941 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13942 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13943 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
13944 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13945 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13946 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
13947 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
13948 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
13949 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
13950 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13951 (any "mypackage@@somewhere\" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
13952 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
13953 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
13954 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
13955 "misc.misc")
13956 @end lisp
13957
13958 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
13959 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
13960 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
13961
13962 @table @code
13963
13964 @item group
13965 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
13966 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
13967
13968 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split})
13969 If the split is a list, the first element of which is a string, then
13970 store the message as specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field}
13971 (a regexp) contains @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict}
13972 (yet another regexp) matches some string after @var{field} and before
13973 the end of the matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If
13974 none of the @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
13975
13976 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
13977 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
13978 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
13979 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
13980 stored in one or more groups.
13981
13982 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
13983 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
13984 process all @var{split}s in the list.
13985
13986 @item junk
13987 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
13988 this message. Use with extreme caution.
13989
13990 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
13991 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
13992 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
13993 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
13994
13995 @cindex body split
13996 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
13997 body of the messages:
13998
13999 @lisp
14000 (defun split-on-body ()
14001 (save-excursion
14002 (save-restriction
14003 (widen)
14004 (goto-char (point-min))
14005 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14006 "string.group"))))
14007 @end lisp
14008
14009 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14010 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14011 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14012 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14013 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14014 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to t to do that (@pxref{Splitting in
14015 IMAP}).
14016
14017 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14018 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14019 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14020 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14021 should return a split.
14022
14023 @item nil
14024 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14025
14026 @end table
14027
14028 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14029 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
14030 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
14031 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
14032 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
14033
14034 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14035 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14036 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14037 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14038 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14039 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14040 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14041
14042 @table @code
14043 @item from
14044 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14045 @item to
14046 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14047 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14048 @item any
14049 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14050 @end table
14051
14052 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14053 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14054 when all this splitting is performed.
14055
14056 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14057 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14058 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14059
14060 @example
14061 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14062 @end example
14063
14064 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14065 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14066
14067 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14068 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14069 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14070 groupings 1 through 9.
14071
14072 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14073 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14074 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14075 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14076 groups when users send to an address using different case
14077 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14078 is @code{t}.
14079
14080 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14081 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} controls whether partial
14082 words are matched during fancy splitting.
14083
14084 Normally, regular expressions given in @code{nnmail-split-fancy} are
14085 implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers, which are word
14086 delimiters. If this variable is true, they are not implicitly
14087 surrounded by anything.
14088
14089 @example
14090 (any "joe" "joemail")
14091 @end example
14092
14093 In this example, messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will
14094 normally not be filed in @samp{joemail}. With
14095 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} set to t, however, the
14096 match will happen. In effect, the requirement of a word boundary is
14097 removed and instead the match becomes more like a grep.
14098
14099 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14100 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14101 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14102 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14103 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14104 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14105 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14106 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14107 it once per thread.
14108
14109 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14110 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14111 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14112 using the colon feature, like so:
14113 @lisp
14114 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14115 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14116 nnmail-split-fancy
14117 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14118 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14119 ))
14120 @end lisp
14121
14122 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14123 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14124 in the file specified by the variable
14125 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14126 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14127 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14128 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14129 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14130 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14131 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14132 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14133 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14134 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14135 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14136 300 kBytes in size.)
14137 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14138 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14139 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14140 messages goes into the new group.
14141
14142 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14143 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14144 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14145 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14146 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14147 ``outgoing'' group.
14148
14149
14150 @node Group Mail Splitting
14151 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14152 @cindex mail splitting
14153 @cindex group mail splitting
14154
14155 @findex gnus-group-split
14156 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14157 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14158 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14159 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14160 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14161 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14162 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14163 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14164
14165 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14166 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14167 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14168 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14169
14170 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14171 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14172 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14173 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14174 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14175 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14176 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14177
14178 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14179 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14180 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14181 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14182 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14183 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14184 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14185
14186 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14187 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14188 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14189 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14190 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14191 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14192 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14193 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14194 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14195 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14196 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14197 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14198 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14199
14200 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14201 been defined:
14202
14203 @example
14204 nnml:mail.bar:
14205 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14206 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14207 nnml:mail.foo:
14208 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14209 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14210 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14211 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14212 nnml:mail.others:
14213 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14214 @end example
14215
14216 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14217 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14218 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14219
14220 @lisp
14221 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14222 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14223 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14224 "mail.others")
14225 @end lisp
14226
14227 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14228 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14229 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14230 splits like this:
14231
14232 @lisp
14233 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14234 @end lisp
14235
14236 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14237 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14238 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14239 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14240 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14241 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14242 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14243 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14244 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14245
14246 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14247 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14248 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14249 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14250 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14251 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14252 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14253 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14254 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14255
14256 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14257 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14258 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14259 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14260 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14261 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14262
14263 @lisp
14264 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14265 @end lisp
14266
14267 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14268 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14269 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14270 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14271 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14272 value.
14273
14274 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14275 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14276 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14277 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14278
14279 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14280 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14281 @cindex incorporating old mail
14282 @cindex import old mail
14283
14284 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14285 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14286 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14287 your mail groups.
14288
14289 Doing so can be quite easy.
14290
14291 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14292 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14293 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14294 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14295 your @code{nnml} groups.
14296
14297 Here's how:
14298
14299 @enumerate
14300 @item
14301 Go to the group buffer.
14302
14303 @item
14304 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14305 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14306
14307 @item
14308 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14309
14310 @item
14311 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14312 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14313
14314 @item
14315 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14316 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14317 @end enumerate
14318
14319 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14320 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14321 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14322 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14323 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14324
14325 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14326 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14327 using the new mail back end.
14328
14329
14330 @node Expiring Mail
14331 @subsection Expiring Mail
14332 @cindex article expiry
14333
14334 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14335 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14336 different approach to mail reading.
14337
14338 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14339 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14340 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14341 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14342 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14343 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14344 course.
14345
14346 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14347 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14348 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14349 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14350 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14351 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14352 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14353 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14354 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14355
14356 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14357 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14358 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14359 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14360 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14361 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14362 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14363 expirable.
14364
14365 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14366 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14367 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14368 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14369 into its own group.)
14370
14371 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14372 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14373 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14374 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14375 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14376 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14377 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14378 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14379 scoring.
14380
14381 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14382 Groups that match the regular expression
14383 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14384 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14385 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14386
14387 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14388 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14389 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14390 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14391 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14392
14393 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14394 @lisp
14395 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14396 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14397 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14398 @end lisp
14399
14400 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14401 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14402 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14403 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14404 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14405
14406 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14407 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14408
14409 @lisp
14410 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14411 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14412 @end lisp
14413
14414 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14415 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14416
14417 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14418 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14419 don't really mix very well.
14420
14421 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14422 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14423 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14424 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14425 days.
14426
14427 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14428 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14429 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14430 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14431 everywhere else:
14432
14433 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14434 @lisp
14435 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14436 (lambda (group)
14437 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14438 31)
14439 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14440 1)
14441 ((string= group "important")
14442 'never)
14443 (t
14444 6))))
14445 @end lisp
14446
14447 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14448 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14449
14450 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14451 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14452 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14453 @code{never}.
14454
14455 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14456 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14457
14458 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14459 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14460 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14461 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14462 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14463 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14464 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14465 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14466 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14467 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14468 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14469 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14470 name or @code{delete}.
14471
14472 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14473 @lisp
14474 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14475 @end lisp
14476
14477 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14478 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14479 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14480 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14481 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14482
14483 @lisp
14484 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14485 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14486 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14487 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14488 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14489 @end lisp
14490
14491 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14492 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14493 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14494 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14495 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14496 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14497
14498 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14499 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14500 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14501 easier for procmail users.
14502
14503 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14504 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14505 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14506 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14507 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14508 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14509 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14510 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14511 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14512 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14513 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14514 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14515 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14516 with! So there!
14517
14518 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14519
14520 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14521 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14522 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14523 auto-expire turned on.
14524
14525
14526 @node Washing Mail
14527 @subsection Washing Mail
14528 @cindex mail washing
14529 @cindex list server brain damage
14530 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14531
14532 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14533 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14534 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14535 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14536 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14537 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14538
14539 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14540 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14541 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14542 laugh.
14543
14544 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14545 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14546 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14547 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14548
14549 @table @code
14550 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14551 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14552 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14553 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14554 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14555
14556 @table @code
14557 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14558 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14559 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14560 Emacs running on MS machines.
14561
14562 @end table
14563
14564 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14565 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14566 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14567 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14568
14569 @table @code
14570 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14571 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14572 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14573 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14574
14575 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14576 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14577 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14578 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14579 into a feature by documenting it.)
14580
14581 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14582 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14583 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14584 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14585 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14586 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14587 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14588 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14589
14590 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14591 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14592
14593 @lisp
14594 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14595 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14596 @end lisp
14597
14598 This can also be done non-destructively with
14599 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14600
14601 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14602 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14603 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14604
14605 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14606 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14607 @cindex Eudora
14608 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14609 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14610 @code{References} headers.
14611
14612 @end table
14613
14614 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14615 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14616 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14617 include:
14618
14619 @table @code
14620 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14621 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14622 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14623
14624 @end table
14625 @end table
14626
14627
14628 @node Duplicates
14629 @subsection Duplicates
14630
14631 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14632 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14633 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14634 @cindex duplicate mails
14635 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14636 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14637 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14638 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14639 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14640 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14641 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14642 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14643 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14644 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14645 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14646 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14647 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14648
14649 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14650 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14651 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14652 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14653
14654 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14655 @code{nil}.
14656
14657 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14658 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14659 methods:
14660
14661 @lisp
14662 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14663 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14664 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14665 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14666 (any mail "mail.misc")
14667 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14668 [...] ))
14669 @end lisp
14670 @noindent
14671 Or something like:
14672 @lisp
14673 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14674 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14675 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14676 [...]))
14677 @end lisp
14678
14679 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14680 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14681 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14682 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14683 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14684
14685
14686 @node Not Reading Mail
14687 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14688
14689 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14690 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14691 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14692
14693 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14694 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14695 mail, which should help.
14696
14697 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14698 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14699 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14700 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14701 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14702 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14703 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14704 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14705 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14706 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14707 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14708
14709 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14710 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14711 incoming mail.
14712
14713
14714 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14715 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14716
14717 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14718 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14719 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14720
14721 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14722 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14723 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14724 Spool}).
14725
14726 @menu
14727 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14728 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14729 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14730 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14731 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14732 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14733 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14734 @end menu
14735
14736
14737 @node Unix Mail Box
14738 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14739 @cindex nnmbox
14740 @cindex unix mail box
14741
14742 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14743 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14744 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14745 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14746 which group it belongs in.
14747
14748 Virtual server settings:
14749
14750 @table @code
14751 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14752 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14753 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14754 @file{~/mbox}.
14755
14756 @item nnmbox-active-file
14757 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14758 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14759 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14760
14761 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14762 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14763 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14764 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14765 @end table
14766
14767
14768 @node Rmail Babyl
14769 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14770 @cindex nnbabyl
14771 @cindex Rmail mbox
14772
14773 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14774 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14775 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14776 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14777 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14778
14779 Virtual server settings:
14780
14781 @table @code
14782 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14783 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14784 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14785
14786 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14787 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14788 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14789 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14790
14791 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14792 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14793 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14794 @code{t}
14795 @end table
14796
14797
14798 @node Mail Spool
14799 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14800 @cindex nnml
14801 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14802
14803 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14804 format. It should be used with some caution.
14805
14806 @vindex nnml-directory
14807 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14808 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14809 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14810 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14811
14812 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14813 care of all that.
14814
14815 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14816 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14817 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14818 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14819 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14820 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14821 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14822 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14823
14824 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14825 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14826 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14827 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
14828
14829 @cindex self contained nnml servers
14830 @cindex marks
14831 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
14832 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14833 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14834 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
14835 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
14836 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
14837 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
14838 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
14839 directory).
14840
14841 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
14842 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
14843 them next time it starts.
14844
14845 Virtual server settings:
14846
14847 @table @code
14848 @item nnml-directory
14849 @vindex nnml-directory
14850 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
14851 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
14852 is @file{~/Mail}).
14853
14854 @item nnml-active-file
14855 @vindex nnml-active-file
14856 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
14857 @file{~/Mail/active}.
14858
14859 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
14860 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
14861 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14862 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
14863
14864 @item nnml-get-new-mail
14865 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14866 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
14867 @code{t}.
14868
14869 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
14870 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
14871 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
14872 default is @code{nil}.
14873
14874 @item nnml-nov-file-name
14875 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
14876 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
14877
14878 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14879 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
14880 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
14881
14882 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
14883 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
14884 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14885 default is @code{nil}.
14886
14887 @item nnml-marks-file-name
14888 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
14889 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
14890
14891 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
14892 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
14893 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
14894 files.
14895
14896 @end table
14897
14898 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
14899 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
14900 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
14901 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
14902 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
14903 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
14904 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
14905 Commands}).
14906
14907
14908 @node MH Spool
14909 @subsubsection MH Spool
14910 @cindex nnmh
14911 @cindex mh-e mail spool
14912
14913 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
14914 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
14915 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
14916 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
14917 for.
14918
14919 Virtual server settings:
14920
14921 @table @code
14922 @item nnmh-directory
14923 @vindex nnmh-directory
14924 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14925 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14926 @file{~/Mail})
14927
14928 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14929 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14930 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14931 @code{t}.
14932
14933 @item nnmh-be-safe
14934 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14935 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14936 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
14937 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14938 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14939 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
14940 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14941 @end table
14942
14943
14944 @node Maildir
14945 @subsubsection Maildir
14946 @cindex nnmaildir
14947 @cindex maildir
14948
14949 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
14950 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
14951 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
14952 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
14953 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
14954 within a maildir.
14955
14956 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
14957 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
14958 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
14959 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
14960 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
14961 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
14962 that appear as group in Gnus.
14963
14964 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
14965 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
14966 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
14967
14968 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
14969 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
14970 another, and you will keep your marks.
14971
14972 Virtual server settings:
14973
14974 @table @code
14975 @item directory
14976 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
14977 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
14978 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
14979 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
14980 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
14981 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
14982 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
14983 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
14984 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
14985 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
14986
14987 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
14988 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
14989 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
14990 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
14991 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
14992 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
14993 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
14994 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
14995 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
14996 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
14997 value.
14998
14999 @item target-prefix
15000 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15001 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15002 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15003 closed.
15004
15005 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15006 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15007 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15008 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15009 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15010 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15011 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15012 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15013 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15014
15015 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15016 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15017 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15018 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15019 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15020
15021 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15022 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15023 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15024 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15025 @code{force} argument.
15026
15027 @item directory-files
15028 This should be a function with the same interface as
15029 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15030 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15031 parameter is optional; the default is
15032 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15033 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15034 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15035 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15036 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15037 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15038
15039 @item get-new-mail
15040 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15041 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15042 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15043 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15044 value is @code{nil}.
15045
15046 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15047 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15048 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15049 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15050 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15051 @end table
15052
15053 @subsubsection Group parameters
15054
15055 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15056 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15057 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15058 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15059 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15060 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15061 another back end.
15062
15063 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15064 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15065 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15066 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15067 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15068 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15069 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15070 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15071 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15072
15073 @table @code
15074 @item expire-age
15075 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15076 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15077 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15078 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15079 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (overrideable by
15080 the @code{expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) group parameters. If you
15081 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15082 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15083 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15084 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15085 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15086 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15087
15088 @item expire-group
15089 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15090 @example
15091 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15092 @end example
15093 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15094 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15095 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15096 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15097 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15098 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15099 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15100 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15101 article. So that form can refer to
15102 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15103 article. @emph{If this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir} does
15104 not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15105 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15106
15107 @item read-only
15108 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15109 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15110 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15111 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15112 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15113 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15114 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15115 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15116 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15117 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15118 contain extra copies of the articles.
15119
15120 @item directory-files
15121 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15122 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15123 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15124 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15125
15126 @item distrust-Lines:
15127 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15128 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15129 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15130
15131 @item always-marks
15132 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15133 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15134 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15135 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15136 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15137 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15138
15139 @item never-marks
15140 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15141 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15142 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15143 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15144 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15145 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15146 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15147
15148 @item nov-cache-size
15149 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15150 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15151 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15152 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15153 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15154 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15155 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15156 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15157 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15158 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15159 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15160 @end table
15161
15162 @subsubsection Article identification
15163 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15164 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15165 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15166 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15167 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15168 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15169 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15170 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15171 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15172 request the article in the summary buffer.
15173
15174 @subsubsection NOV data
15175 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15176 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15177 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15178 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15179 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15180 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15181 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15182 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15183 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15184 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15185 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15186
15187 @subsubsection Article marks
15188 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15189 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15190 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15191 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15192 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15193 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15194 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15195 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15196
15197 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15198 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15199 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15200 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15201 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15202 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15203 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15204 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15205 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15206
15207
15208 @node Mail Folders
15209 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15210 @cindex nnfolder
15211 @cindex mbox folders
15212 @cindex mail folders
15213
15214 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15215 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15216 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15217 numbers and arrival dates.
15218
15219 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15220 @cindex marks
15221 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15222 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15223 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15224 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15225 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15226 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15227 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15228 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15229 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15230 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15231
15232 Virtual server settings:
15233
15234 @table @code
15235 @item nnfolder-directory
15236 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15237 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15238 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15239 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15240
15241 @item nnfolder-active-file
15242 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15243 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15244
15245 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15246 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15247 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15248 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15249
15250 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15251 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15252 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15253 default is @code{t}
15254
15255 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15256 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15257 @cindex backup files
15258 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15259 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15260 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15261 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15262
15263 @lisp
15264 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15265 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15266
15267 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15268 @end lisp
15269
15270 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15271 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15272 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15273 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15274 extract some information from it before removing it.
15275
15276 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15277 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15278 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15279 default is @code{nil}.
15280
15281 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15282 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15283 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15284
15285 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15286 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15287 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15288 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15289
15290 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15291 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15292 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15293 default is @code{nil}.
15294
15295 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15296 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15297 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15298
15299 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15300 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15301 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15302 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15303
15304 @end table
15305
15306
15307 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15308 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15309 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15310 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15311 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15312 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15313 though.
15314
15315 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15316 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15317
15318 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15319 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15320 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15321 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15322 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15323
15324 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15325 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15326 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15327 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15328 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15329 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15330 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15331 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15332 via NFS).
15333
15334 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15335 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15336 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15337 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15338
15339 @table @code
15340 @item nnmbox
15341
15342 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15343 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15344 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15345 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15346 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15347 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15348 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15349 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15350 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15351 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15352 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15353 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15354 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15355 what's where.
15356
15357 @item nnbabyl
15358
15359 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15360 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15361 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15362 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15363 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15364 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15365 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15366 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15367 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15368 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15369 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15370 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15371 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15372 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15373
15374 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15375 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15376 look at your mail.
15377
15378 @item nnml
15379
15380 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15381 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15382 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15383 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15384 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15385 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15386 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15387 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15388 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15389 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15390 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15391 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15392 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15393 provided by the active file and overviews.
15394
15395 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15396 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15397 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15398 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15399 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15400 wins big.
15401
15402 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15403 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15404 tiny files.
15405
15406 @item nnmh
15407
15408 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15409 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15410 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15411 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15412 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15413 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15414 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15415
15416 @item nnfolder
15417
15418 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15419 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15420 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15421 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15422 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15423 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15424 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15425 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15426 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15427
15428 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15429 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15430 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15431 friendly mail back end all over.
15432
15433 @item nnmaildir
15434
15435 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15436 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15437 mail back ends.
15438
15439 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15440 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15441 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15442 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15443 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15444 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15445 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15446 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15447 file system.
15448
15449 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15450 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15451 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15452 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15453 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15454 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15455 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15456 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15457 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15458 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15459 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15460
15461 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15462 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15463 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15464 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15465 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15466 @code{nnmaildir}.
15467
15468 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15469 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15470 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15471 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15472 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15473 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15474 removed in the future.
15475
15476 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15477 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15478 on your file system.
15479
15480 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15481 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15482
15483 @end table
15484
15485
15486 @node Browsing the Web
15487 @section Browsing the Web
15488 @cindex web
15489 @cindex browsing the web
15490 @cindex www
15491 @cindex http
15492
15493 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15494 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15495 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15496 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15497 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15498 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15499 even know what a news group is.
15500
15501 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15502 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15503 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15504 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15505 you mad in the end.
15506
15507 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15508 to do it instead?
15509
15510 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15511 interfaces to these sources.
15512
15513 @menu
15514 * Archiving Mail::
15515 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15516 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15517 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15518 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15519 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15520 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
15521 @end menu
15522
15523 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
15524
15525 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15526 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15527 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15528 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15529 though, you should be ok.
15530
15531 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15532 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15533 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15534 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15535 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15536
15537 @node Archiving Mail
15538 @subsection Archiving Mail
15539 @cindex archiving mail
15540 @cindex backup of mail
15541
15542 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15543 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15544 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15545 marks is fairly simple.
15546
15547 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15548 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15549 though.)
15550
15551 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15552 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15553 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15554 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15555 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15556 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15557 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15558 before you restore the data.
15559
15560 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15561 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15562 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15563 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15564 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15565 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15566 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15567 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15568 is unnecessary in that case.
15569
15570 @node Web Searches
15571 @subsection Web Searches
15572 @cindex nnweb
15573 @cindex Google
15574 @cindex dejanews
15575 @cindex gmane
15576 @cindex Usenet searches
15577 @cindex searching the Usenet
15578
15579 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15580 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15581 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15582 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15583 searches without having to use a browser.
15584
15585 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15586 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15587 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15588 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15589 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15590
15591 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15592 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15593 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15594 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15595 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15596 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15597 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15598 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15599 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15600 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15601 group as read.
15602
15603 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15604 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15605 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15606 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15607 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15608 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15609
15610 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
15611 to use @code{nnweb}.
15612
15613 Virtual server variables:
15614
15615 @table @code
15616 @item nnweb-type
15617 @vindex nnweb-type
15618 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15619 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15620 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15621
15622 @item nnweb-search
15623 @vindex nnweb-search
15624 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15625
15626 @item nnweb-max-hits
15627 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15628 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15629 999.
15630
15631 @item nnweb-type-definition
15632 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15633 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15634 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15635 present:
15636
15637 @table @code
15638 @item article
15639 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15640 understands.
15641
15642 @item map
15643 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15644
15645 @item search
15646 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15647
15648 @item address
15649 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15650 to.
15651
15652 @item id
15653 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15654 @end table
15655
15656 @end table
15657
15658
15659 @node Slashdot
15660 @subsection Slashdot
15661 @cindex Slashdot
15662 @cindex nnslashdot
15663
15664 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15665 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15666 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15667
15668 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15669 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15670
15671 @lisp
15672 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15673 '((nnslashdot "")))
15674 @end lisp
15675
15676 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15677 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15678 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15679 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15680 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15681 Methods}).
15682
15683 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15684 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15685
15686 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15687 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15688 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15689 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15690 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15691 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15692 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15693
15694 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15695
15696 @table @code
15697 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15698 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15699 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15700 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15701 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15702 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15703 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15704
15705 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15706 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15707 The login name to use when posting.
15708
15709 @item nnslashdot-password
15710 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15711 The password to use when posting.
15712
15713 @item nnslashdot-directory
15714 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15715 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15716 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15717
15718 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15719 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15720 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15721 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15722 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15723
15724 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15725 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15726 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15727
15728 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15729 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15730 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15731 article. The default is
15732 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15733
15734 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15735 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15736 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15737
15738 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15739 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15740 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15741 updated. The default is 0.
15742
15743 @end table
15744
15745
15746
15747 @node Ultimate
15748 @subsection Ultimate
15749 @cindex nnultimate
15750 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15751
15752 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15753 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15754 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15755 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15756
15757 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15758 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15759 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15760 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15761 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15762 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15763 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15764
15765 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15766
15767 @table @code
15768 @item nnultimate-directory
15769 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15770 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15771 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15772 @end table
15773
15774
15775 @node Web Archive
15776 @subsection Web Archive
15777 @cindex nnwarchive
15778 @cindex Web Archive
15779
15780 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15781 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15782 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15783 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15784 groups updated.
15785
15786 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15787 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15788 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15789 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15790 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15791 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15792 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15793 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15794
15795 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15796
15797 @table @code
15798 @item nnwarchive-directory
15799 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15800 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15801 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15802
15803 @item nnwarchive-login
15804 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15805 The account name on the web server.
15806
15807 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15808 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15809 The password for your account on the web server.
15810 @end table
15811
15812 @node RSS
15813 @subsection RSS
15814 @cindex nnrss
15815 @cindex RSS
15816
15817 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15818 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15819 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15820 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15821 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15822
15823 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15824 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15825
15826 @kindex G R (Summary)
15827 Use @kbd{G R} from the summary buffer to subscribe to a feed---you
15828 will be prompted for the location of the feed.
15829
15830 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
15831 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET y}, then
15832 subscribe to groups.
15833
15834 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
15835
15836 @table @code
15837 @item nnrss-directory
15838 @vindex nnrss-directory
15839 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
15840 @file{~/News/rss/}.
15841
15842 @item nnrss-use-local
15843 @vindex nnrss-use-local
15844 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
15845 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
15846 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
15847 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
15848 download script using @command{wget}.
15849 @end table
15850
15851 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
15852 the summary buffer.
15853
15854 @lisp
15855 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
15856 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
15857
15858 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
15859 (let ((descr
15860 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
15861 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
15862 @end lisp
15863
15864 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
15865 summary buffer.
15866 @lisp
15867 (require 'browse-url)
15868
15869 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
15870 (interactive "p")
15871 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
15872 (mail-header-extra
15873 (gnus-data-header
15874 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
15875 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
15876 (if url
15877 (progn
15878 (browse-url (cdr url))
15879 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
15880 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
15881
15882 (eval-after-load "gnus"
15883 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
15884 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
15885 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
15886 @end lisp
15887
15888 @node Customizing w3
15889 @subsection Customizing w3
15890 @cindex w3
15891 @cindex html
15892 @cindex url
15893 @cindex Netscape
15894
15895 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
15896 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
15897 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
15898
15899 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
15900 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
15901 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
15902
15903 @lisp
15904 (eval-after-load "w3"
15905 '(progn
15906 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
15907 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
15908 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
15909 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
15910 (browse-url url)
15911 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
15912 @end lisp
15913
15914 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
15915 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
15916 follow the link.
15917
15918
15919 @node IMAP
15920 @section IMAP
15921 @cindex nnimap
15922 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
15923
15924 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
15925 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
15926 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
15927 specify the network address of the server.
15928
15929 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
15930 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
15931 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
15932 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
15933 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
15934 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
15935
15936 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
15937 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
15938 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
15939 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
15940
15941 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
15942 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
15943 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
15944 usage explained in this section.
15945
15946 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
15947 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
15948 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
15949 see below.)
15950
15951 @lisp
15952 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15953 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
15954 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
15955 (nnimap "dolk"
15956 (nnimap-address "localhost")
15957 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
15958 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
15959 (nnimap "barbar"
15960 (nnimap-server-port 143)
15961 (nnimap-address "localhost")
15962 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
15963 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
15964 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
15965 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
15966 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
15967 (nnimap-stream network))
15968 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
15969 (nnimap "vic20"
15970 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
15971 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
15972 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
15973 @end lisp
15974
15975 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
15976 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
15977 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
15978 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
15979
15980 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
15981 server:
15982
15983 @table @code
15984
15985 @item nnimap-address
15986 @vindex nnimap-address
15987
15988 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
15989 server name if not specified.
15990
15991 @item nnimap-server-port
15992 @vindex nnimap-server-port
15993 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
15994
15995 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
15996
15997 @lisp
15998 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
15999 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16000 @end lisp
16001
16002 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16003 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16004 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16005 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16006 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16007 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16008 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16009
16010 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16011 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16012 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16013 mailbox.
16014
16015 Example server specification:
16016
16017 @lisp
16018 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16019 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16020 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16021 @end lisp
16022
16023 @item nnimap-stream
16024 @vindex nnimap-stream
16025 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16026 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16027 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16028 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16029 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16030
16031 Example server specification:
16032
16033 @lisp
16034 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16035 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16036 @end lisp
16037
16038 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16039
16040 @itemize @bullet
16041 @item
16042 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16043 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16044 @item
16045 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16046 @item
16047 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16048 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16049 @samp{starttls}.
16050 @item
16051 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16052 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16053 @item
16054 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16055 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16056 @item
16057 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16058 @item
16059 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16060 @end itemize
16061
16062 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16063 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16064 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16065 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16066 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16067 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16068 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16069 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16070 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16071 program.
16072
16073 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16074 needed. It is available from
16075 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16076
16077 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16078 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16079 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16080 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16081 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16082 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16083 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16084 tried.
16085
16086 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16087 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16088 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16089 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16090 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16091 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16092 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16093 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16094
16095 @vindex imap-shell-program
16096 @vindex imap-shell-host
16097 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16098 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16099
16100 @item nnimap-authenticator
16101 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16102
16103 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16104 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16105
16106 Example server specification:
16107
16108 @lisp
16109 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16110 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16111 @end lisp
16112
16113 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16114
16115 @itemize @bullet
16116 @item
16117 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16118 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16119 @item
16120 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16121 @code{imtest}.
16122 @item
16123 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16124 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16125 @item
16126 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16127 @item
16128 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16129 @item
16130 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16131 @end itemize
16132
16133 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16134 @cindex expunging
16135 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16136 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16137 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16138 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16139 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16140 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16141 similar).
16142
16143 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16144 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16145 running in circles yet?
16146
16147 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16148 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16149 variable.
16150
16151 The possible options are:
16152
16153 @table @code
16154
16155 @item always
16156 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16157 closing a mailbox.
16158 @item never
16159 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16160 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16161 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16162 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16163 @item ask
16164 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16165 articles or not.
16166
16167 @end table
16168
16169 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16170 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16171
16172 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16173 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16174 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16175 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16176 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16177 has only one.)
16178
16179 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
16180 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16181
16182 @lisp
16183 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16184 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16185 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16186 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16187 @end lisp
16188
16189 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16190 as ticked for other users.
16191
16192 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16193 @cindex expunging
16194 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16195
16196 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16197 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16198 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16199 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16200
16201 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16202 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16203 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16204 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16205
16206 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16207 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16208
16209 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16210 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16211 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16212 @ref{NNTP}.
16213
16214 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16215 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16216
16217 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16218 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16219 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16220
16221 @end table
16222
16223 @menu
16224 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16225 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16226 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16227 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16228 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16229 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16230 @end menu
16231
16232
16233
16234 @node Splitting in IMAP
16235 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16236 @cindex splitting imap mail
16237
16238 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16239 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16240 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16241 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16242 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16243
16244 And it does.
16245
16246 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16247 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16248 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16249
16250 Here are the variables of interest:
16251
16252 @table @code
16253
16254 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16255 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16256 @cindex crosspost
16257 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16258
16259 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16260 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16261 found will be used.
16262
16263 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16264
16265 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16266 @cindex splitting, inbox
16267 @cindex inbox
16268 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16269
16270 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16271 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16272 splitting is disabled!
16273
16274 @lisp
16275 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16276 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16277 @end lisp
16278
16279 No nnmail equivalent.
16280
16281 @item nnimap-split-rule
16282 @cindex splitting, rules
16283 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16284
16285 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16286 this variable.
16287
16288 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16289 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16290 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16291 Neither did I, we need examples.
16292
16293 @lisp
16294 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16295 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16296 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16297 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16298 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16299 @end lisp
16300
16301 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16302 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16303 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16304
16305 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16306 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16307 instance:
16308
16309 @lisp
16310 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16311 @end lisp
16312
16313 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16314 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16315
16316 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16317 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16318 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16319 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16320
16321 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16322 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16323 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16324 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16325 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16326 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16327
16328 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16329 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16330 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16331
16332 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16333 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16334 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16335
16336 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16337
16338 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16339 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16340 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16341
16342 @lisp
16343 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16344 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16345 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16346 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16347 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16348 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16349 @end lisp
16350
16351 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16352 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16353 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16354 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16355 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16356 group/function elements.
16357
16358 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16359
16360 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16361 @cindex splitting
16362 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16363
16364 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16365 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16366
16367 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16368 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16369 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16370 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16371
16372 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16373 @cindex splitting, fancy
16374 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16375 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16376
16377 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16378 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16379 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16380
16381 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16382 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16383 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16384 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16385
16386 Example:
16387
16388 @lisp
16389 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16390 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16391 @end lisp
16392
16393 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16394
16395 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16396 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16397 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16398
16399 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16400 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16401 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16402 splitting function that analyses the body to split the article.
16403
16404 @end table
16405
16406 @node Expiring in IMAP
16407 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16408 @cindex expiring imap mail
16409
16410 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16411 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16412 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16413 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16414 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16415 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16416 process.
16417
16418 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16419 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16420 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16421 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16422 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16423 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16424 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16425 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16426
16427 @table @code
16428
16429 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16430 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16431
16432 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16433 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16434
16435 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16436
16437 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16438 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16439 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16440 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16441
16442 @end table
16443
16444 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16445 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16446 @cindex editing imap acls
16447 @cindex Access Control Lists
16448 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16449 @kindex G l (Group)
16450 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16451
16452 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16453 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16454 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16455 doesn't.
16456
16457 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16458 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16459 editing window with detailed instructions.
16460
16461 Some possible uses:
16462
16463 @itemize @bullet
16464 @item
16465 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16466 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16467 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16468 @item
16469 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16470 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16471 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16472 INBOX.mailbox).
16473 @end itemize
16474
16475 @node Expunging mailboxes
16476 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16477 @cindex expunging
16478
16479 @cindex expunge
16480 @cindex manual expunging
16481 @kindex G x (Group)
16482 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16483
16484 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16485 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16486 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16487
16488 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16489 delete them.
16490
16491 @node A note on namespaces
16492 @subsection A note on namespaces
16493 @cindex IMAP namespace
16494 @cindex namespaces
16495
16496 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16497 by the following text in the RFC:
16498
16499 @display
16500 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16501
16502 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16503 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16504 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16505 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16506
16507 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16508 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16509 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16510 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16511 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16512 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16513 @end display
16514
16515 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16516 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16517 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16518
16519 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16520 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16521 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16522 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16523 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16524 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16525 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16526 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16527 Gnus.
16528
16529 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16530 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16531 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16532
16533 @node Debugging IMAP
16534 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16535 @cindex IMAP debugging
16536 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16537
16538 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16539 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16540 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behaviour, chances
16541 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16542
16543 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16544 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16545 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16546 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16547 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16548 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16549 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16550
16551
16552 @vindex imap-log
16553 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16554 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16555 follows:
16556
16557 @lisp
16558 (setq imap-log t)
16559 @end lisp
16560
16561 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16562 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16563 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16564 @code{BAD} - but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16565 data.
16566
16567 @node Other Sources
16568 @section Other Sources
16569
16570 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16571 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16572 newsgroups.
16573
16574 @menu
16575 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16576 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16577 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16578 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16579 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16580 @end menu
16581
16582
16583 @node Directory Groups
16584 @subsection Directory Groups
16585 @cindex nndir
16586 @cindex directory groups
16587
16588 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16589 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16590 names, of course.
16591
16592 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16593 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16594 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16595 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16596
16597 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16598 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16599 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16600 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16601 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16602
16603 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16604
16605 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16606 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16607 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16608 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16609
16610
16611 @node Anything Groups
16612 @subsection Anything Groups
16613 @cindex nneething
16614
16615 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16616 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16617 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16618 true.
16619
16620 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16621 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16622 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16623 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16624 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16625 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16626 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16627 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16628 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16629 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16630 elements.
16631
16632 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16633 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16634 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16635 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16636
16637 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16638 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16639 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16640 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16641
16642 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16643 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16644 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16645 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16646 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16647 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16648 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16649 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16650
16651 Some variables:
16652
16653 @table @code
16654 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16655 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16656 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16657 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16658
16659 @item nneething-exclude-files
16660 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16661 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16662 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16663
16664 @item nneething-include-files
16665 @vindex nneething-include-files
16666 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16667 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16668
16669 @item nneething-map-file
16670 @vindex nneething-map-file
16671 Name of the map files.
16672 @end table
16673
16674
16675 @node Document Groups
16676 @subsection Document Groups
16677 @cindex nndoc
16678 @cindex documentation group
16679 @cindex help group
16680
16681 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16682 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16683
16684 @table @code
16685 @cindex Babyl
16686 @cindex Rmail mbox
16687
16688 @item babyl
16689 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16690 @cindex mbox
16691 @cindex Unix mbox
16692
16693 @item mbox
16694 The standard Unix mbox file.
16695
16696 @cindex MMDF mail box
16697 @item mmdf
16698 The MMDF mail box format.
16699
16700 @item news
16701 Several news articles appended into a file.
16702
16703 @item rnews
16704 @cindex rnews batch files
16705 The rnews batch transport format.
16706 @cindex forwarded messages
16707
16708 @item forward
16709 Forwarded articles.
16710
16711 @item nsmail
16712 Netscape mail boxes.
16713
16714 @item mime-parts
16715 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16716
16717 @item standard-digest
16718 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16719
16720 @item mime-digest
16721 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16722
16723 @item lanl-gov-announce
16724 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16725
16726 @item rfc822-forward
16727 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16728
16729 @item outlook
16730 The Outlook mail box.
16731
16732 @item oe-dbx
16733 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16734
16735 @item exim-bounce
16736 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16737
16738 @item forward
16739 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16740
16741 @item rfc934
16742 An RFC934-forwarded message.
16743
16744 @item mailman
16745 A mailman digest.
16746
16747 @item clari-briefs
16748 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
16749
16750 @item slack-digest
16751 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
16752
16753 @item mail-in-mail
16754 The last resort.
16755 @end table
16756
16757 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
16758 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
16759 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
16760 file is.
16761
16762 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
16763 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
16764 group. And that's it.
16765
16766 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
16767 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
16768 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
16769 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
16770 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
16771 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
16772 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
16773 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
16774 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
16775 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
16776
16777 Virtual server variables:
16778
16779 @table @code
16780 @item nndoc-article-type
16781 @vindex nndoc-article-type
16782 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
16783 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
16784 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
16785 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
16786 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
16787
16788 @item nndoc-post-type
16789 @vindex nndoc-post-type
16790 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
16791 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
16792 and @code{news}.
16793 @end table
16794
16795 @menu
16796 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
16797 @end menu
16798
16799
16800 @node Document Server Internals
16801 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
16802
16803 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
16804 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
16805 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
16806 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
16807
16808 First, here's an example document type definition:
16809
16810 @example
16811 (mmdf
16812 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
16813 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
16814 @end example
16815
16816 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
16817 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
16818 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
16819 types can be defined with very few settings:
16820
16821 @table @code
16822 @item first-article
16823 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
16824 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
16825 totally ignored.
16826
16827 @item article-begin
16828 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
16829 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
16830
16831 @item head-begin-function
16832 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
16833 the article.
16834
16835 @item nndoc-head-begin
16836 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
16837 article.
16838
16839 @item nndoc-head-end
16840 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
16841 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
16842
16843 @item body-begin-function
16844 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
16845 of the article.
16846
16847 @item body-begin
16848 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
16849 to @samp{^\n}.
16850
16851 @item body-end-function
16852 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
16853 the article.
16854
16855 @item body-end
16856 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
16857
16858 @item file-end
16859 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
16860 regexp will be totally ignored.
16861
16862 @end table
16863
16864 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
16865 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
16866 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
16867 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
16868 something that's palatable for Gnus:
16869
16870 @table @code
16871 @item prepare-body-function
16872 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
16873 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
16874 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
16875
16876 @item article-transform-function
16877 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
16878 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
16879 body of the article.
16880
16881 @item generate-head-function
16882 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
16883 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
16884 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
16885 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
16886
16887 @end table
16888
16889 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
16890 digests:
16891
16892 @example
16893 (standard-digest
16894 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16895 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
16896 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
16897 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
16898 (head-end . "^ ?$")
16899 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
16900 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
16901 (subtype digest guess))
16902 @end example
16903
16904 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
16905 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
16906 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
16907 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
16908 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
16909
16910 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
16911 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
16912 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
16913 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
16914 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
16915 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
16916 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
16917 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
16918 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
16919 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
16920 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
16921 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
16922
16923
16924 @node SOUP
16925 @subsection SOUP
16926 @cindex SOUP
16927 @cindex offline
16928
16929 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
16930 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
16931 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
16932
16933 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
16934 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
16935 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
16936 newsreaders.
16937
16938 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
16939 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
16940 that interested in doing things properly.
16941
16942 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
16943 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
16944 fiddly.
16945
16946 First some terminology:
16947
16948 @table @dfn
16949
16950 @item server
16951 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
16952 get news and/or mail from.
16953
16954 @item home machine
16955 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
16956 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
16957
16958 @item packet
16959 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
16960 of packets:
16961
16962 @table @dfn
16963 @item message packets
16964 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
16965 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
16966 default, where @var{x} is a number.
16967
16968 @item response packets
16969 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
16970 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
16971 default, where @var{x} is a number.
16972
16973 @end table
16974
16975 @end table
16976
16977
16978 @enumerate
16979
16980 @item
16981 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
16982 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
16983 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
16984 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
16985
16986 @item
16987 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
16988
16989 @item
16990 You put the packet in your home directory.
16991
16992 @item
16993 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
16994 the native or secondary server.
16995
16996 @item
16997 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
16998 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
16999
17000 @item
17001 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17002 packet.
17003
17004 @item
17005 You transfer this packet to the server.
17006
17007 @item
17008 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17009
17010 @item
17011 You then repeat until you die.
17012
17013 @end enumerate
17014
17015 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17016 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17017
17018 @menu
17019 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17020 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17021 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17022 @end menu
17023
17024
17025 @node SOUP Commands
17026 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17027
17028 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17029
17030 @table @kbd
17031 @item G s b
17032 @kindex G s b (Group)
17033 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17034 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17035 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17036 process/prefix convention.
17037
17038 @item G s w
17039 @kindex G s w (Group)
17040 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17041 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17042
17043 @item G s s
17044 @kindex G s s (Group)
17045 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17046 Send all replies from the replies packet
17047 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17048
17049 @item G s p
17050 @kindex G s p (Group)
17051 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17052 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17053
17054 @item G s r
17055 @kindex G s r (Group)
17056 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17057 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17058
17059 @item O s
17060 @kindex O s (Summary)
17061 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17062 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17063 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17064 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17065
17066 @end table
17067
17068
17069 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17070 thingies:
17071
17072 @table @code
17073
17074 @item gnus-soup-directory
17075 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17076 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17077 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17078
17079 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17080 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17081 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17082 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17083
17084 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17085 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17086 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17087 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17088
17089 @item gnus-soup-packer
17090 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17091 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17092 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17093
17094 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17095 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17096 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17097 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17098
17099 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17100 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17101 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17102
17103 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17104 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17105 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17106 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17107
17108 @end table
17109
17110
17111 @node SOUP Groups
17112 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17113 @cindex nnsoup
17114
17115 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17116 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17117 you can read them at leisure.
17118
17119 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17120
17121 @table @code
17122
17123 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17124 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17125 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17126 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17127
17128 @item nnsoup-directory
17129 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17130 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17131 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17132
17133 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17134 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17135 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17136 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17137
17138 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17139 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17140 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17141 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17142 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17143
17144 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17145 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17146 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17147 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17148
17149 @item nnsoup-active-file
17150 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17151 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17152 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17153 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17154 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17155
17156 @item nnsoup-packer
17157 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17158 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17159 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17160
17161 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17162 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17163 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17164 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17165
17166 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17167 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17168 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17169 @file{~/}.
17170
17171 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17172 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17173 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17174 @samp{Soupout}.
17175
17176 @item nnsoup-always-save
17177 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17178 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17179
17180 @end table
17181
17182
17183 @node SOUP Replies
17184 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17185
17186 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17187 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17188 more for that to happen.
17189
17190 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17191 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17192 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17193 @sc{soup} system.
17194
17195 In specific, this is what it does:
17196
17197 @lisp
17198 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17199 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17200 @end lisp
17201
17202 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17203 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17204 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17205
17206
17207 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17208 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17209 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17210 @cindex gateways
17211
17212 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17213 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17214 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17215
17216 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17217 used to post with.
17218
17219 Server variables:
17220
17221 @table @code
17222 @item nngateway-address
17223 @vindex nngateway-address
17224 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17225
17226 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17227 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17228 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17229 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17230 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17231 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17232 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17233 gateway address.
17234
17235 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17236 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17237 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17238
17239 @example
17240 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17241 @end example
17242
17243 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17244
17245 @example
17246 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17247 @end example
17248
17249 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17250
17251 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17252 @table @code
17253
17254 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17255 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17256 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17257
17258 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17259
17260 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17261 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17262 @code{nngateway-address}.
17263 @end table
17264
17265 @end table
17266
17267 Here's an example:
17268
17269 @lisp
17270 (setq gnus-post-method
17271 '(nngateway
17272 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17273 (nngateway-header-transformation
17274 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17275 @end lisp
17276
17277 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17278
17279 @lisp
17280 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17281 @end lisp
17282
17283
17284
17285 @node Combined Groups
17286 @section Combined Groups
17287
17288 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17289 groups.
17290
17291 @menu
17292 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17293 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17294 @end menu
17295
17296
17297 @node Virtual Groups
17298 @subsection Virtual Groups
17299 @cindex nnvirtual
17300 @cindex virtual groups
17301 @cindex merging groups
17302
17303 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17304 other groups.
17305
17306 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17307 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17308 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17309
17310 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17311 regexp to match component groups.
17312
17313 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17314 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17315 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17316 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17317 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17318 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17319 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17320 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17321
17322 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17323 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17324
17325 @lisp
17326 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17327 @end lisp
17328
17329 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17330 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17331
17332 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17333 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17334 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17335 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17336
17337 @example
17338 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17339 @end example
17340
17341 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17342 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17343 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17344
17345 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17346 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17347 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17348 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17349 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17350
17351 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17352 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17353 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17354
17355 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17356 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
17357 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
17358 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
17359 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
17360 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
17361 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
17362 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
17363 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
17364 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
17365 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
17366
17367 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17368 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17369 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17370 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17371 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17372 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17373 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17374
17375 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17376 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17377
17378 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17379 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17380 inherited.
17381
17382
17383 @node Kibozed Groups
17384 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17385 @cindex nnkiboze
17386 @cindex kibozing
17387
17388 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17389 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17390 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17391 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17392
17393 @kindex G k (Group)
17394 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17395 buffer.
17396
17397 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17398 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17399 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17400 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17401
17402 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17403 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17404 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17405
17406 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17407 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17408 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17409 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17410 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17411 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17412 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17413 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17414
17415 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17416 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17417 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17418 Stranger things have happened.
17419
17420 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17421 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17422
17423 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17424 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17425 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17426 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17427 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17428 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17429 component articles.
17430
17431 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17432 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17433
17434
17435 @node Gnus Unplugged
17436 @section Gnus Unplugged
17437 @cindex offline
17438 @cindex unplugged
17439 @cindex agent
17440 @cindex Gnus agent
17441 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17442
17443 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17444 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17445 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17446 read news. Believe it or not.
17447
17448 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17449 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17450 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17451 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17452 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17453
17454 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17455 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17456 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17457 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17458 reading news on a machine.
17459
17460 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17461 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17462
17463 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17464
17465 @menu
17466 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17467 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17468 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17469 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17470 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17471 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17472 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17473 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17474 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17475 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17476 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17477 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17478 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17479 @end menu
17480
17481
17482 @node Agent Basics
17483 @subsection Agent Basics
17484
17485 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17486
17487 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17488 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17489 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17490 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17491
17492 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17493 connected to the net continuously.
17494
17495 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17496 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17497
17498 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17499 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17500 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17501 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17502 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17503
17504 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17505 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17506 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17507 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17508 they're kinda like plugged always).
17509
17510 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17511 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17512 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17513 the culprit.
17514
17515 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17516 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17517 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17518 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17519 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17520
17521 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17522
17523 @itemize @bullet
17524
17525 @item
17526 @findex gnus-unplugged
17527 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17528 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17529 already fetched while in this mode.
17530
17531 @item
17532 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17533 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17534 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17535 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17536 Source Specifiers}).
17537
17538 @item
17539 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17540 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17541 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17542 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17543 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17544
17545 @item
17546 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17547 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17548 then you read the news offline.
17549
17550 @item
17551 And then you go to step 2.
17552 @end itemize
17553
17554 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17555 the Agent.
17556
17557 @itemize @bullet
17558
17559 @item
17560 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17561 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17562 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17563 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17564 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17565 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17566 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17567 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17568
17569 @item
17570 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17571 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17572 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17573 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17574
17575 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17576 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17577 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17578 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17579 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17580 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17581 configure them.
17582
17583 @item
17584 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17585 @end itemize
17586
17587
17588 @node Agent Categories
17589 @subsection Agent Categories
17590
17591 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17592 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17593 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17594 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17595 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17596 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17597 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17598
17599 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17600 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17601 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17602 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17603 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17604
17605 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17606 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17607 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17608 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17609 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17610 sink.
17611
17612 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17613 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17614 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17615 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17616 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17617 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17618 your settings.
17619
17620 @menu
17621 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17622 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17623 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17624 @end menu
17625
17626
17627 @node Category Syntax
17628 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17629
17630 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17631 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17632 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17633 listed below.
17634
17635 @cindex Agent Parameters
17636 @table @code
17637 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17638 The name of the category.
17639
17640 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17641 The list of groups that are in this category.
17642
17643 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17644 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17645 are eligible for downloading; and
17646
17647 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17648 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17649 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17650 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17651
17652 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17653 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17654 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17655 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17656 only groups that should not be expired.
17657
17658 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17659 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17660 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17661
17662 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17663 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17664
17665 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17666 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17667
17668 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17669 an integer that overrides the value of
17670 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17671
17672 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17673 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17674
17675 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17676 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17677 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17678 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17679 @c all other symbols disable them.
17680
17681 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17682 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17683 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17684 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17685 all other symbols enable them.
17686 @end table
17687
17688 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17689 created.
17690
17691 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17692 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17693 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17694 category.
17695
17696 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17697 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17698 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17699 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17700
17701 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17702 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17703 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17704
17705 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17706 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17707 operators sprinkled in between.
17708
17709 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17710
17711 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17712 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17713
17714 @lisp
17715 short
17716 @end lisp
17717
17718 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
17719 short (for some value of ``short'').
17720
17721 Here's a more complex predicate:
17722
17723 @lisp
17724 (or high
17725 (and
17726 (not low)
17727 (not long)))
17728 @end lisp
17729
17730 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
17731 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
17732 drift.
17733
17734 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
17735 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
17736 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
17737
17738 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
17739 you want to do, you can write your own.
17740
17741 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
17742 bound to the value determined by calling
17743 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
17744 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
17745 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
17746 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
17747 predicate to individual groups.
17748
17749 @table @code
17750 @item short
17751 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
17752 lines; default 100.
17753
17754 @item long
17755 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
17756 lines; default 200.
17757
17758 @item low
17759 True iff the article has a download score less than
17760 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
17761
17762 @item high
17763 True iff the article has a download score greater than
17764 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
17765
17766 @item spam
17767 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
17768 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
17769 checksum and sees whether articles match.
17770
17771 @item true
17772 Always true.
17773
17774 @item false
17775 Always false.
17776 @end table
17777
17778 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
17779 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
17780 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
17781 useful values.
17782
17783 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
17784 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
17785 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
17786 something along the lines of the following:
17787
17788 @lisp
17789 (defun my-article-old-p ()
17790 "Say whether an article is old."
17791 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
17792 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
17793 @end lisp
17794
17795 with the predicate then defined as:
17796
17797 @lisp
17798 (not my-article-old-p)
17799 @end lisp
17800
17801 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
17802 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
17803 wherever.
17804
17805 @lisp
17806 (require 'gnus-agent)
17807 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
17808 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
17809 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
17810 @end lisp
17811
17812 and simply specify your predicate as:
17813
17814 @lisp
17815 (not old)
17816 @end lisp
17817
17818 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
17819 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
17820 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
17821 just don't give a damn.
17822
17823 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
17824 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
17825 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
17826 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
17827 parameters like so:
17828
17829 @lisp
17830 (agent-predicate . short)
17831 @end lisp
17832
17833 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
17834 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
17835 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
17836
17837 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
17838
17839 @lisp
17840 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
17841 @end lisp
17842
17843 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
17844 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
17845 predicate is assumed to be a list.
17846
17847
17848 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
17849 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
17850 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
17851 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
17852 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
17853 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
17854
17855 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
17856 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
17857 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
17858 if it's to be specific to that group.
17859
17860 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
17861 three forms:
17862
17863 @enumerate
17864 @item
17865 Score rule
17866
17867 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
17868 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
17869
17870 example:
17871
17872 @itemize @bullet
17873 @item
17874 Category specification
17875
17876 @lisp
17877 (("from"
17878 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17879 ("lines"
17880 (500 -100 nil <)))
17881 @end lisp
17882
17883 @item
17884 Group/Topic Parameter specification
17885
17886 @lisp
17887 (agent-score ("from"
17888 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
17889 ("lines"
17890 (500 -100 nil <)))
17891 @end lisp
17892
17893 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
17894 @end itemize
17895
17896 @item
17897 Agent score file
17898
17899 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
17900 keywords stated above.
17901
17902 example:
17903
17904 @itemize @bullet
17905 @item
17906 Category specification
17907
17908 @lisp
17909 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
17910 @end lisp
17911
17912 or perhaps
17913
17914 @lisp
17915 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
17916 @end lisp
17917
17918 @item
17919 Group Parameter specification
17920
17921 @lisp
17922 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
17923 @end lisp
17924
17925 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
17926 about parenthesis?
17927 @end itemize
17928
17929 @item
17930 Use @code{normal} score files
17931
17932 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
17933 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
17934 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
17935 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
17936
17937 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
17938 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
17939 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
17940 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
17941
17942 @itemize @bullet
17943 @item
17944 Category Specification
17945
17946 @lisp
17947 file
17948 @end lisp
17949
17950 @item
17951 Group Parameter specification
17952
17953 @lisp
17954 (agent-score . file)
17955 @end lisp
17956 @end itemize
17957 @end enumerate
17958
17959 @node Category Buffer
17960 @subsubsection Category Buffer
17961
17962 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
17963 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
17964 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
17965
17966 The following commands are available in this buffer:
17967
17968 @table @kbd
17969 @item q
17970 @kindex q (Category)
17971 @findex gnus-category-exit
17972 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
17973
17974 @item e
17975 @kindex e (Category)
17976 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
17977 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
17978 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
17979
17980 @item k
17981 @kindex k (Category)
17982 @findex gnus-category-kill
17983 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
17984
17985 @item c
17986 @kindex c (Category)
17987 @findex gnus-category-copy
17988 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
17989
17990 @item a
17991 @kindex a (Category)
17992 @findex gnus-category-add
17993 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
17994
17995 @item p
17996 @kindex p (Category)
17997 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
17998 Edit the predicate of the current category
17999 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18000
18001 @item g
18002 @kindex g (Category)
18003 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18004 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18005 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18006
18007 @item s
18008 @kindex s (Category)
18009 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18010 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18011 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18012
18013 @item l
18014 @kindex l (Category)
18015 @findex gnus-category-list
18016 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18017 @end table
18018
18019
18020 @node Category Variables
18021 @subsubsection Category Variables
18022
18023 @table @code
18024 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18025 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18026 Hook run in category buffers.
18027
18028 @item gnus-category-line-format
18029 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18030 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18031 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18032
18033 @table @samp
18034 @item c
18035 The name of the category.
18036
18037 @item g
18038 The number of groups in the category.
18039 @end table
18040
18041 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18042 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18043 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18044
18045 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18046 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18047 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18048
18049 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18050 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18051 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18052
18053 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18054 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18055 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18056 0.
18057
18058 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18059 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18060 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18061 0.
18062
18063 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18064 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18065 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18066 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18067 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18068 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18069 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18070 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18071 read.
18072 Default 7.
18073
18074 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18075 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18076 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18077 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18078 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18079 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18080 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18081
18082 @end table
18083
18084
18085 @node Agent Commands
18086 @subsection Agent Commands
18087 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18088 @kindex J j (Agent)
18089
18090 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18091 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18092 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18093
18094
18095 @menu
18096 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18097 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18098 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18099 @end menu
18100
18101
18102
18103
18104 @node Group Agent Commands
18105 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18106
18107 @table @kbd
18108 @item J u
18109 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18110 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18111 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18112 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18113
18114 @item J c
18115 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18116 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18117 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18118
18119 @item J s
18120 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18121 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18122 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18123 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18124
18125 @item J S
18126 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18127 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18128 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18129 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18130
18131 @item J a
18132 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18133 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18134 Add the current group to an Agent category
18135 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18136 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18137
18138 @item J r
18139 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18140 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18141 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18142 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18143 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18144
18145 @item J Y
18146 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18147 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18148 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18149
18150
18151 @end table
18152
18153
18154 @node Summary Agent Commands
18155 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18156
18157 @table @kbd
18158 @item J #
18159 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18160 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18161 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18162
18163 @item J M-#
18164 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18165 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18166 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18167 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18168
18169 @cindex %
18170 @item @@
18171 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18172 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18173 Toggle whether to download the article
18174 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18175 default.
18176
18177 @item J c
18178 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18179 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18180 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18181
18182 @item J S
18183 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18184 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18185 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18186 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18187
18188 @item J s
18189 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18190 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18191 Download all processable articles in this group.
18192 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18193
18194 @item J u
18195 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18196 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18197 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18198 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18199
18200 @end table
18201
18202
18203 @node Server Agent Commands
18204 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18205
18206 @table @kbd
18207 @item J a
18208 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18209 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18210 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18211 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18212
18213 @item J r
18214 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18215 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18216 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18217 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18218
18219 @end table
18220
18221
18222 @node Agent Visuals
18223 @subsection Agent Visuals
18224
18225 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18226 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18227 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18228 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18229 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18230 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18231 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18232 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18233 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18234 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18235
18236 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18237 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18238 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18239 way, "If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18240 less than satisfying unplugged session". For this reason, the Agent
18241 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18242 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18243 articles will be available when unplugged.
18244
18245 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18246 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18247 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18248 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18249 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18250 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18251 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18252 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18253
18254 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18255 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18256 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18257 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18258 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18259 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18260 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18261 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18262 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18263
18264 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18265 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18266 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18267 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18268 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18269
18270 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18271 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18272 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18273 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18274 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18275 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18276 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18277 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second, if
18278 you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18279 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to t. This
18280 parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an Agent
18281 Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18282 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18283
18284 @node Agent as Cache
18285 @subsection Agent as Cache
18286
18287 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18288 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18289 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18290 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18291 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18292 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18293 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18294 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18295 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18296
18297 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18298 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18299 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18300 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18301 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18302
18303 @node Agent Expiry
18304 @subsection Agent Expiry
18305
18306 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18307 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18308 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18309 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18310 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18311 @cindex agent expiry
18312 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18313 @cindex expiry
18314
18315 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18316 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18317 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18318 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18319 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18320 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18321 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18322 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18323
18324 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18325 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18326 synchronized with the group.
18327
18328 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18329 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18330
18331 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18332 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18333 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18334 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18335 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18336 be kept indefinitely.
18337
18338 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18339 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18340 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18341 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18342
18343 @node Agent Regeneration
18344 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18345
18346 @cindex agent regeneration
18347 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18348 @cindex regeneration
18349
18350 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18351 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18352 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18353 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18354 internal inconsistencies.
18355
18356 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18357 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18358 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18359 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18360 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18361 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18362
18363 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18364 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18365 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18366 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18367 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18368 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18369
18370 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18371 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18372 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18373 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18374 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18375 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18376 agent as unread.
18377
18378 @node Agent and IMAP
18379 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18380
18381 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18382 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18383 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18384 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18385
18386 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18387 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18388 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18389 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18390
18391 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18392 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18393 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18394 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18395
18396 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18397 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18398 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18399 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18400 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18401 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18402
18403 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18404 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18405 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18406 in the group buffer.
18407
18408 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18409 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18410
18411 @itemize @bullet
18412
18413 @item
18414 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18415
18416 @item
18417 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18418
18419 @end itemize
18420
18421 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18422 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18423 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18424 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18425 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18426 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18427 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18428 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18429
18430
18431 @node Outgoing Messages
18432 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18433
18434 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18435 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18436 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18437
18438 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18439 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18440 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18441 messages in the draft group.
18442
18443
18444
18445 @node Agent Variables
18446 @subsection Agent Variables
18447
18448 @table @code
18449 @item gnus-agent-directory
18450 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18451 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18452 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18453
18454 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18455 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18456 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18457 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18458 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18459 by default.
18460
18461 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18462 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18463 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18464
18465 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18466 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18467 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18468
18469 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18470 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18471 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18472
18473 @item gnus-agent-cache
18474 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18475 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18476 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18477 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18478
18479 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18480 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18481 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18482 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18483 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18484 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18485 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18486 online status.
18487
18488 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18489 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18490 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18491 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18492 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18493 read. The default is t.
18494
18495 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18496 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18497 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18498 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18499 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18500 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18501 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18502 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18503 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18504 over and over again.
18505
18506 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18507 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18508 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18509 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18510 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18511 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18512 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18513 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18514 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18515 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18516 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18517 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18518 see any cycling.
18519
18520 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18521 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18522 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18523 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18524 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18525 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18526 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18527 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18528 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18529
18530 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18531 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18532 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18533 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18534 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18535 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18536
18537 The legal values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18538 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18539 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18540 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18541 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18542
18543 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18544 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18545 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18546 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18547 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18548 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18549 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18550 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18551 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18552 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18553 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18554
18555 @end table
18556
18557
18558 @node Example Setup
18559 @subsection Example Setup
18560
18561 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18562 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18563 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18564
18565 @lisp
18566 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18567 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18568 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18569
18570 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18571 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18572 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18573
18574 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18575 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18576
18577 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18578 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18579 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18580 @end lisp
18581
18582 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18583 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18584 gnus}.
18585
18586 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18587 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18588 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18589 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18590 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18591 once.
18592
18593 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18594 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18595 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18596 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18597 back all the killed groups.)
18598
18599 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18600 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18601 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18602
18603
18604 @node Batching Agents
18605 @subsection Batching Agents
18606 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18607
18608 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18609 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18610 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18611
18612 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18613 following incantation:
18614
18615 @example
18616 #!/bin/sh
18617 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18618 @end example
18619
18620
18621 @node Agent Caveats
18622 @subsection Agent Caveats
18623
18624 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18625 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18626 may ask:
18627
18628 @table @dfn
18629 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18630
18631 @strong{No}. If you want this behaviour, add
18632 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18633 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18634
18635 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18636 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18637
18638 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18639
18640 @end table
18641
18642 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18643 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18644 locally stored articles.
18645
18646
18647 @node Scoring
18648 @chapter Scoring
18649 @cindex scoring
18650
18651 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18652 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18653 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18654 attention!
18655
18656 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18657 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18658 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18659 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18660 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18661
18662 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18663 before generating the summary buffer.
18664
18665 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18666 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18667 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18668
18669 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18670 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18671 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18672 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18673
18674 @menu
18675 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18676 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18677 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18678 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18679 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18680 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18681 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18682 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18683 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18684 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18685 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18686 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18687 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18688 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18689 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18690 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18691 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18692 @end menu
18693
18694
18695 @node Summary Score Commands
18696 @section Summary Score Commands
18697 @cindex score commands
18698
18699 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18700 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18701 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18702 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18703 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18704
18705 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18706 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18707 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18708 score file the current one.
18709
18710 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18711
18712 @table @kbd
18713
18714 @item V s
18715 @kindex V s (Summary)
18716 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
18717 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
18718
18719 @item V S
18720 @kindex V S (Summary)
18721 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
18722 Display the score of the current article
18723 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
18724
18725 @item V t
18726 @kindex V t (Summary)
18727 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
18728 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
18729 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
18730 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
18731 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
18732 score file and edit it.
18733
18734 @item V w
18735 @kindex V w (Summary)
18736 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
18737 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
18738
18739 @item V R
18740 @kindex V R (Summary)
18741 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
18742 Run the current summary through the scoring process
18743 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
18744 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
18745 effect you're having.
18746
18747 @item V c
18748 @kindex V c (Summary)
18749 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
18750 Make a different score file the current
18751 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
18752
18753 @item V e
18754 @kindex V e (Summary)
18755 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
18756 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
18757 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
18758 File Editing}).
18759
18760 @item V f
18761 @kindex V f (Summary)
18762 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
18763 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
18764 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
18765
18766 @item V F
18767 @kindex V F (Summary)
18768 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18769 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
18770 after editing score files.
18771
18772 @item V C
18773 @kindex V C (Summary)
18774 @findex gnus-score-customize
18775 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
18776 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
18777
18778 @end table
18779
18780 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
18781
18782 @table @kbd
18783
18784 @item V m
18785 @kindex V m (Summary)
18786 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
18787 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
18788 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
18789
18790 @item V x
18791 @kindex V x (Summary)
18792 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
18793 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
18794 expunge all articles below this score
18795 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
18796 @end table
18797
18798 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
18799 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
18800 them.)
18801
18802 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
18803 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
18804
18805 @enumerate
18806 @item
18807 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
18808 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
18809 @item
18810 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
18811 keys are available:
18812 @table @kbd
18813
18814 @item a
18815 Score on the author name.
18816
18817 @item s
18818 Score on the subject line.
18819
18820 @item x
18821 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
18822
18823 @item r
18824 Score on the @code{References} line.
18825
18826 @item d
18827 Score on the date.
18828
18829 @item l
18830 Score on the number of lines.
18831
18832 @item i
18833 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
18834
18835 @item e
18836 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
18837 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
18838
18839 @item f
18840 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
18841 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
18842 @file{ADAPT} files.)
18843
18844 @item b
18845 Score on the body.
18846
18847 @item h
18848 Score on the head.
18849
18850 @item t
18851 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
18852 files.)
18853
18854 @end table
18855
18856 @item
18857 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
18858 what headers you are scoring on.
18859
18860 @table @code
18861
18862 @item strings
18863
18864 @table @kbd
18865
18866 @item e
18867 Exact matching.
18868
18869 @item s
18870 Substring matching.
18871
18872 @item f
18873 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
18874
18875 @item r
18876 Regexp matching
18877 @end table
18878
18879 @item date
18880 @table @kbd
18881
18882 @item b
18883 Before date.
18884
18885 @item a
18886 After date.
18887
18888 @item n
18889 This date.
18890 @end table
18891
18892 @item number
18893 @table @kbd
18894
18895 @item <
18896 Less than number.
18897
18898 @item =
18899 Equal to number.
18900
18901 @item >
18902 Greater than number.
18903 @end table
18904 @end table
18905
18906 @item
18907 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
18908 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
18909 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
18910 file.
18911 @table @kbd
18912
18913 @item t
18914 Temporary score entry.
18915
18916 @item p
18917 Permanent score entry.
18918
18919 @item i
18920 Immediately scoring.
18921 @end table
18922
18923 @item
18924 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
18925 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
18926 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
18927
18928 @end enumerate
18929
18930 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
18931 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
18932 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
18933 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
18934
18935 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
18936 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
18937 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
18938 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
18939 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
18940
18941 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
18942 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
18943 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
18944 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
18945 current score file.
18946
18947 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
18948 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
18949 pretend they are keymaps or not.
18950
18951
18952 @node Group Score Commands
18953 @section Group Score Commands
18954 @cindex group score commands
18955
18956 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
18957
18958 @table @kbd
18959
18960 @item W f
18961 @kindex W f (Group)
18962 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
18963 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
18964 all the time. This command will flush the cache
18965 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
18966
18967 @end table
18968
18969 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
18970
18971 @findex gnus-batch-score
18972 @cindex batch scoring
18973 @example
18974 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
18975 @end example
18976
18977
18978 @node Score Variables
18979 @section Score Variables
18980 @cindex score variables
18981
18982 @table @code
18983
18984 @item gnus-use-scoring
18985 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
18986 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
18987 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
18988
18989 @item gnus-kill-killed
18990 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
18991 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
18992 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
18993 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
18994 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
18995 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
18996 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
18997
18998 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
18999 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19000 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19001 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19002 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19003
19004 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19005 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19006 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19007 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19008
19009 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19010 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19011 @cindex score cache
19012 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19013 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19014 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19015 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19016 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19017 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19018 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19019 be cached.
19020
19021 @item gnus-save-score
19022 @vindex gnus-save-score
19023 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19024 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19025 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19026
19027 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19028 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19029 across group visits.
19030
19031 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19032 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19033 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19034 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19035 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19036 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19037 manually entered data.
19038
19039 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19040 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19041 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19042
19043 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19044 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19045 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19046 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19047 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19048 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19049
19050 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19051 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19052 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19053 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19054
19055 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19056 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19057 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19058 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19059
19060 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19061 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19062 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19063 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19064
19065 Predefined functions available are:
19066 @table @code
19067
19068 @item gnus-score-find-single
19069 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19070 Only apply the group's own score file.
19071
19072 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19073 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19074 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19075 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19076 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19077 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19078 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19079 then a regexp match is done.
19080
19081 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19082 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19083
19084 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19085 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19086 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19087 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19088
19089 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19090 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19091 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19092 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19093 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19094 server.
19095
19096 @end table
19097 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19098 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19099 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19100 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19101 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19102 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19103 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19104 Phu.
19105
19106 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19107 overall score file, you could use the value
19108 @example
19109 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19110 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19111 @end example
19112
19113 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19114 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19115 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19116 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19117 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19118
19119 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19120 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19121 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19122 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19123 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19124 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19125 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19126 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19127
19128 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19129 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19130 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19131
19132 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19133 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19134 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19135 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19136 threading---according to the current value of
19137 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19138 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19139 simplified in this manner.
19140
19141 @end table
19142
19143
19144 @node Score File Format
19145 @section Score File Format
19146 @cindex score file format
19147
19148 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19149 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19150 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19151
19152 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19153
19154 @lisp
19155 (("from"
19156 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19157 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19158 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19159 ("subject"
19160 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19161 ("xref"
19162 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19163 ("lines"
19164 (2 -100 nil <))
19165 (mark 0)
19166 (expunge -1000)
19167 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19168 (read-only nil)
19169 (orphan -10)
19170 (adapt t)
19171 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19172 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19173 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19174 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19175 (eval (ding)))
19176 @end lisp
19177
19178 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19179 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19180
19181 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19182 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19183 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19184
19185 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19186
19187 @table @code
19188
19189 @item STRING
19190 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19191 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19192 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19193 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19194 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19195 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19196 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19197 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19198 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19199 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19200 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19201 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19202 to articles that matches these score entries.
19203
19204 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19205 score entry has one to four elements.
19206 @enumerate
19207
19208 @item
19209 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19210 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19211 integer.
19212
19213 @item
19214 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19215 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19216 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19217 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19218 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19219 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19220
19221 @item
19222 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19223 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19224 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19225 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19226 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19227
19228 @item
19229 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19230 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19231 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19232 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19233 @table @dfn
19234
19235 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19236 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19237 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19238 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19239 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19240 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19241 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19242 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19243 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19244 instead, if you feel like.
19245
19246 @item Extra
19247 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19248 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19249 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19250 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19251 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19252 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19253 overviews:
19254
19255 @lisp
19256 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19257 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19258 @end lisp
19259
19260 @item Lines, Chars
19261 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19262 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19263
19264 These predicates are true if
19265
19266 @example
19267 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19268 @end example
19269
19270 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19271 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19272 following form:
19273
19274 @lisp
19275 (< header-value 4)
19276 @end lisp
19277
19278 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19279 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19280 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19281 it's not. I think.)
19282
19283 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19284 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19285 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19286 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19287
19288 @item Date
19289 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19290 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19291 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19292 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19293 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19294 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19295 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19296
19297 @cindex ISO8601
19298 @cindex date
19299 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19300 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19301 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19302 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19303 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19304 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19305 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19306 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19307 whole family, eh?)
19308
19309 @item Head, Body, All
19310 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19311 header uses.
19312
19313 @item Followup
19314 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19315 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19316 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19317 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19318 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19319 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19320 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19321 files.)
19322
19323 @item Thread
19324 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19325 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19326 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19327 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19328 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19329 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19330 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19331 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19332 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19333 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19334 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19335 @end table
19336 @end enumerate
19337
19338 @cindex score file atoms
19339 @item mark
19340 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19341 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19342
19343 @item expunge
19344 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19345 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19346
19347 @item mark-and-expunge
19348 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19349 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19350 summary buffer.
19351
19352 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19353 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19354 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19355 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19356 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19357
19358 @item files
19359 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19360 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19361 this one was.
19362
19363 @item exclude-files
19364 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19365 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19366 other.
19367
19368 @item eval
19369 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19370 ignored when handling global score files.
19371
19372 @item read-only
19373 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19374 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19375 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19376 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19377
19378 @item orphan
19379 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19380 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19381 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19382 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19383
19384 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19385
19386 @example
19387 (orphan -500)
19388 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19389 @end example
19390
19391 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19392 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19393 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19394 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19395 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19396
19397 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19398 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19399 scoring rules exist.
19400
19401 @item adapt
19402 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19403 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19404 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19405 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19406 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19407 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19408 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19409 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19410 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19411 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19412 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19413 it.
19414
19415 @item adapt-file
19416 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19417 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19418 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19419 file for a number of groups.
19420
19421 @item local
19422 @cindex local variables
19423 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19424 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19425 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19426 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19427 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19428 be evaluated.
19429 @end table
19430
19431
19432 @node Score File Editing
19433 @section Score File Editing
19434
19435 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19436 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19437 with a mode for that.
19438
19439 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19440 additional commands:
19441
19442 @table @kbd
19443
19444 @item C-c C-c
19445 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19446 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19447 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19448 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19449
19450 @item C-c C-d
19451 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19452 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19453 Insert the current date in numerical format
19454 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19455 you were wondering.
19456
19457 @item C-c C-p
19458 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19459 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19460 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19461 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19462 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19463 you.
19464
19465 @end table
19466
19467 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19468
19469 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19470 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19471
19472 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19473 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19474
19475
19476 @node Adaptive Scoring
19477 @section Adaptive Scoring
19478 @cindex adaptive scoring
19479
19480 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19481 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19482 stupidity, to be precise.
19483
19484 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19485 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19486 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19487 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19488 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19489 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19490 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19491 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19492 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19493
19494 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19495 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19496 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19497 might look something like this:
19498
19499 @lisp
19500 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19501 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19502 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19503 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19504 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19505 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19506 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19507 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19508 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19509 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19510 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19511 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19512 @end lisp
19513
19514 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19515 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19516 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19517 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19518 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19519 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19520 entries.
19521
19522 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19523 will be applied to each article.
19524
19525 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19526 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19527 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19528 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19529
19530 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19531 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19532 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19533 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19534
19535 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19536 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19537 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19538 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19539
19540 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19541 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19542 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19543 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19544 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19545 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19546
19547 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19548 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19549 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19550
19551 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19552 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19553 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19554
19555 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19556 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19557 let you use different rules in different groups.
19558
19559 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19560 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19561 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19562 is @file{ADAPT}.
19563
19564 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19565 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19566 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19567 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19568 the length of the match is less than
19569 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19570 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19571 this problem.
19572
19573 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19574 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19575 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19576 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19577 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19578
19579 @lisp
19580 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19581 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19582 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19583 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19584 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19585 @end lisp
19586
19587 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19588 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19589 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19590 score with 30 points.
19591
19592 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19593 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19594 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19595 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19596 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19597
19598 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19599 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19600 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19601 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19602 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19603
19604 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19605 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19606 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19607 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19608
19609 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19610 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19611 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19612 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19613
19614 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19615 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19616 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19617 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19618 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19619
19620 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19621 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19622 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19623
19624 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19625 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19626 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19627 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19628
19629
19630 @node Home Score File
19631 @section Home Score File
19632
19633 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19634 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19635 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19636 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19637
19638 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19639 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19640 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19641
19642 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19643 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19644 be:
19645
19646 @enumerate
19647 @item
19648 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19649 groups.
19650
19651 @item
19652 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19653 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19654 parameter.
19655
19656 @item
19657 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19658
19659 @enumerate
19660 @item
19661 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19662 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19663
19664 @item
19665 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19666 be used as the home score file.
19667
19668 @item
19669 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19670 @end enumerate
19671
19672 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19673 for matches.
19674
19675 @end enumerate
19676
19677 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19678
19679 @lisp
19680 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19681 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19682 @end lisp
19683
19684 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19685 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19686
19687 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19688 @lisp
19689 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19690 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19691 @end lisp
19692
19693 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19694 Other functions include
19695
19696 @table @code
19697 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19698 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19699 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19700 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19701
19702 @end table
19703
19704 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19705 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19706 their own home score files:
19707
19708 @lisp
19709 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19710 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19711 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19712 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
19713 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
19714 @end lisp
19715
19716 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
19717 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
19718 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
19719 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
19720 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
19721
19722 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
19723 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
19724 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
19725 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
19726 precedence over this variable.
19727
19728
19729 @node Followups To Yourself
19730 @section Followups To Yourself
19731
19732 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
19733 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
19734 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
19735 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
19736 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
19737 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
19738
19739 @table @code
19740
19741 @item gnus-score-followup-article
19742 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
19743 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
19744 article.
19745
19746 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
19747 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
19748 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
19749 your own article.
19750 @end table
19751
19752 @vindex message-sent-hook
19753 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
19754 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
19755 @lisp
19756 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
19757 @end lisp
19758
19759
19760 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
19761 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
19762 mine:
19763
19764 @example
19765 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19766 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
19767 @end example
19768
19769 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
19770 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
19771 myself:
19772
19773 @lisp
19774 ("references"
19775 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
19776 1000 nil r))
19777 @end lisp
19778
19779 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
19780 is system-dependent.
19781
19782
19783 @node Scoring On Other Headers
19784 @section Scoring On Other Headers
19785 @cindex scoring on other headers
19786
19787 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
19788 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
19789 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
19790 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
19791 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
19792
19793 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
19794 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
19795 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
19796 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
19797 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
19798
19799 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
19800
19801 @lisp
19802 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
19803 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
19804 @end lisp
19805
19806 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
19807 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
19808 time if you have much mail.
19809
19810 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
19811 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
19812
19813 See? Simple.
19814
19815
19816 @node Scoring Tips
19817 @section Scoring Tips
19818 @cindex scoring tips
19819
19820 @table @dfn
19821
19822 @item Crossposts
19823 @cindex crossposts
19824 @cindex scoring crossposts
19825 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
19826 the @code{Xref} header.
19827 @lisp
19828 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
19829 @end lisp
19830
19831 @item Multiple crossposts
19832 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
19833 more than, say, 3 groups:
19834 @lisp
19835 ("xref"
19836 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
19837 -1000 nil r))
19838 @end lisp
19839
19840 @item Matching on the body
19841 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
19842 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
19843 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
19844 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
19845 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
19846 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
19847 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
19848 the matches.
19849
19850 @item Marking as read
19851 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
19852 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
19853 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
19854 @lisp
19855 ((mark -100))
19856 @end lisp
19857 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
19858
19859 @item Negated character classes
19860 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
19861 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
19862 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
19863 @end table
19864
19865
19866 @node Reverse Scoring
19867 @section Reverse Scoring
19868 @cindex reverse scoring
19869
19870 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
19871 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
19872 like this in your score file:
19873
19874 @lisp
19875 (("subject"
19876 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
19877 (mark 1)
19878 (expunge 1))
19879 @end lisp
19880
19881 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
19882 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
19883
19884
19885 @node Global Score Files
19886 @section Global Score Files
19887 @cindex global score files
19888
19889 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
19890 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
19891 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
19892
19893 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
19894 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
19895 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
19896
19897 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
19898 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
19899 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
19900 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
19901 files are applicable to which group.
19902
19903 To use the score file
19904 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
19905 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
19906 say this:
19907
19908 @lisp
19909 (setq gnus-global-score-files
19910 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
19911 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
19912 @end lisp
19913
19914 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
19915 @noindent
19916 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
19917 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
19918 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
19919 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
19920
19921 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
19922 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
19923
19924 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
19925 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
19926 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
19927 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
19928 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
19929 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
19930
19931 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
19932 head:
19933
19934 @itemize @bullet
19935
19936 @item
19937 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
19938 @item
19939 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
19940 @item
19941 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
19942 @item
19943 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
19944 lowered out of existence.
19945 @item
19946 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
19947 articles completely.
19948
19949 @item
19950 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
19951 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
19952 old articles for a long time.
19953 @end itemize
19954
19955 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
19956 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
19957 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
19958 holding our breath yet?
19959
19960
19961 @node Kill Files
19962 @section Kill Files
19963 @cindex kill files
19964
19965 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
19966 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
19967 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
19968
19969 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
19970 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
19971 files into score files.
19972
19973 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
19974 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
19975 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
19976 that isn't a very good idea.
19977
19978 Normal kill files look like this:
19979
19980 @lisp
19981 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
19982 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
19983 (gnus-expunge "X")
19984 @end lisp
19985
19986 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
19987 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
19988
19989 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
19990 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
19991 interpreting it.
19992
19993 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
19994
19995 @table @kbd
19996
19997 @item M-k
19998 @kindex M-k (Summary)
19999 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20000 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20001
20002 @item M-K
20003 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20004 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20005 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20006 @end table
20007
20008 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20009
20010 @table @kbd
20011
20012 @item M-k
20013 @kindex M-k (Group)
20014 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20015 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20016
20017 @item M-K
20018 @kindex M-K (Group)
20019 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20020 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20021 @end table
20022
20023 Kill file variables:
20024
20025 @table @code
20026 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20027 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20028 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20029 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20030 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20031 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20032 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20033
20034 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20035 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20036 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20037 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20038 kills.
20039
20040 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20041 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20042 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20043 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20044 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20045 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20046 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20047 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20048 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20049
20050 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20051 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20052 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20053
20054 @end table
20055
20056
20057 @node Converting Kill Files
20058 @section Converting Kill Files
20059 @cindex kill files
20060 @cindex converting kill files
20061
20062 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20063 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20064 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20065 by hand.
20066
20067 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20068 You can fetch it from
20069 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20070
20071 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20072 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20073 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20074 before.
20075
20076
20077 @node GroupLens
20078 @section GroupLens
20079 @cindex GroupLens
20080
20081 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20082 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20083
20084 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20085 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20086 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20087 news articles generated every day.
20088
20089 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20090 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20091 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20092 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20093 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20094 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20095 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20096 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20097 article.
20098
20099 @menu
20100 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20101 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20102 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20103 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20104 @end menu
20105
20106
20107 @node Using GroupLens
20108 @subsection Using GroupLens
20109
20110 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20111 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20112 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20113
20114 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20115
20116 @table @code
20117
20118 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20119 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20120 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20121 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20122
20123 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20124 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20125 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20126 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20127
20128 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20129 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20130 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20131
20132 @end table
20133
20134 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20135 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20136 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20137 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20138 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20139 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20140
20141
20142 @node Rating Articles
20143 @subsection Rating Articles
20144
20145 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20146 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20147 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20148 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20149 like this one?''
20150
20151 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20152
20153 @table @kbd
20154
20155 @item r
20156 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20157 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20158 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20159
20160 @item k
20161 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20162 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20163 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20164 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20165 threads in rec.humor.
20166
20167 @end table
20168
20169 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20170 the score of the article you're reading.
20171
20172 @table @kbd
20173
20174 @item 1-5 n
20175 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20176 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20177 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20178
20179 @item 1-5 ,
20180 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20181 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20182 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20183
20184 @end table
20185
20186 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20187 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20188
20189
20190 @node Displaying Predictions
20191 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20192
20193 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20194 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20195 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20196 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20197 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20198
20199 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20200 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20201 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20202 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20203 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20204 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20205 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20206 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20207 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20208 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20209 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20210 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20211 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20212
20213 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20214 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20215 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20216 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20217
20218 The following are valid values for that variable.
20219
20220 @table @code
20221 @item prediction-spot
20222 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20223 displayed.
20224
20225 @item confidence-interval
20226 A numeric confidence interval.
20227
20228 @item prediction-bar
20229 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20230
20231 @item confidence-bar
20232 Numerical confidence.
20233
20234 @item confidence-spot
20235 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20236
20237 @item prediction-num
20238 Plain-old numeric value.
20239
20240 @item confidence-plus-minus
20241 Prediction +/- confidence.
20242
20243 @end table
20244
20245
20246 @node GroupLens Variables
20247 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20248
20249 @table @code
20250
20251 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20252 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20253 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20254 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20255 %s\n}.
20256
20257 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20258 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20259 default.
20260
20261 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20262 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20263
20264 @item grouplens-score-offset
20265 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20266 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20267 default is 0.
20268
20269 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20270 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20271 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20272
20273 @end table
20274
20275
20276 @node Advanced Scoring
20277 @section Advanced Scoring
20278
20279 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20280 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20281 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20282 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20283 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20284
20285 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20286 scoring patterns.
20287
20288 @menu
20289 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20290 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20291 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20292 @end menu
20293
20294
20295 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20296 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20297
20298 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20299 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20300 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20301 non-@code{nil} value.
20302
20303 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20304 operator, and various match operators.
20305
20306 Logical operators:
20307
20308 @table @code
20309 @item &
20310 @itemx and
20311 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20312 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20313 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20314 @code{true}.
20315
20316 @item |
20317 @itemx or
20318 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20319 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20320 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20321
20322 @item !
20323 @itemx not
20324 @itemx ¬
20325 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20326 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20327
20328 @end table
20329
20330 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20331 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20332 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20333 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20334 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20335 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20336 the ancestry you want to go.
20337
20338 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20339 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20340 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20341 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20342 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20343
20344
20345 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20346 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20347
20348 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20349 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20350 of parentheses.
20351
20352 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20353 when he's talking about Gnus:
20354
20355 @example
20356 @group
20357 ((&
20358 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20359 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20360 1000)
20361 @end group
20362 @end example
20363
20364 Quite simple, huh?
20365
20366 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20367
20368 @example
20369 ((&
20370 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20371 (|
20372 ("subject" "Gnus")
20373 ("lines" 100 >)))
20374 1000)
20375 @end example
20376
20377 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20378 really don't want to read what he's written:
20379
20380 @example
20381 ((&
20382 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20383 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
20384 -100000)
20385 @end example
20386
20387 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20388 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20389 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20390 very interesting:
20391
20392 @example
20393 ((&
20394 (1-
20395 (&
20396 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20397 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20398 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20399 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20400 1000)
20401 @end example
20402
20403 The possibilities are endless.
20404
20405
20406 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20407 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20408
20409 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20410 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20411 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20412 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20413 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20414 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20415 @samp{subject}) first.
20416
20417 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20418 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20419 something like:
20420
20421 @example
20422 ...
20423 (1-
20424 (1-
20425 ("from" "lars")))
20426 ...
20427 @end example
20428
20429 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20430 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20431
20432 @example
20433 (1-
20434 (&
20435 ("from" "Lars")
20436 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20437 @end example
20438
20439 than it is to say:
20440
20441 @example
20442 (&
20443 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20444 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20445 @end example
20446
20447
20448 @node Score Decays
20449 @section Score Decays
20450 @cindex score decays
20451 @cindex decays
20452
20453 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20454 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20455 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20456 use them in any sensible way.
20457
20458 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20459 @findex gnus-decay-score
20460 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20461 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20462 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20463 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20464 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20465 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20466 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20467 definition of that function:
20468
20469 @lisp
20470 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20471 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20472 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20473 (let ((n (- score
20474 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20475 (min (abs score)
20476 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20477 (* (abs score)
20478 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20479 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20480 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20481 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20482 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20483 (string-to-number
20484 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20485 (floor n))))
20486 @end lisp
20487
20488 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20489 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20490 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20491 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20492
20493 @enumerate
20494 @item
20495 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20496
20497 @item
20498 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20499
20500 @item
20501 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20502 score.
20503 @end enumerate
20504
20505 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20506 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20507 the new score, which should be an integer.
20508
20509 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20510 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20511
20512 @iftex
20513 @iflatex
20514 @chapter Message
20515 @include message.texi
20516 @chapter Emacs MIME
20517 @include emacs-mime.texi
20518 @chapter Sieve
20519 @include sieve.texi
20520 @chapter PGG
20521 @include pgg.texi
20522 @end iflatex
20523 @end iftex
20524
20525 @node Various
20526 @chapter Various
20527
20528 @menu
20529 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20530 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20531 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20532 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20533 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20534 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20535 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20536 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20537 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20538 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20539 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20540 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20541 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20542 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20543 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20544 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20545 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20546 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
20547 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20548 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20549 @end menu
20550
20551
20552 @node Process/Prefix
20553 @section Process/Prefix
20554 @cindex process/prefix convention
20555
20556 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20557 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20558
20559 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20560 command to be performed on.
20561
20562 It goes like this:
20563
20564 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20565 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20566 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20567 with the current one.
20568
20569 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20570 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20571 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20572
20573 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20574 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20575 the process mark.
20576
20577 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20578 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20579
20580 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20581 are avoided.
20582
20583 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20584 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20585 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20586 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20587
20588 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20589 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20590 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20591 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20592 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20593 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20594 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20595 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20596
20597 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20598 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20599 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20600 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20601 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20602
20603
20604 @node Interactive
20605 @section Interactive
20606 @cindex interaction
20607
20608 @table @code
20609
20610 @item gnus-novice-user
20611 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20612 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20613 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20614 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20615 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20616 default.
20617
20618 @item gnus-expert-user
20619 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20620 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20621 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20622 matter how strange.
20623
20624 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20625 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20626 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20627 is @code{t} by default.
20628
20629 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20630 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20631 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20632 default.
20633 @end table
20634
20635
20636 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20637 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20638 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20639
20640 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20641 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20642 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20643 rule of 900 to the current article.
20644
20645 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20646 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20647 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20648 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20649 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20650 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20651 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20652
20653 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20654 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20655 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20656 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20657 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20658 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20659 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20660 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20661 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20662
20663 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20664 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20665 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20666
20667 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20668 Interactive}.
20669
20670
20671 @node Formatting Variables
20672 @section Formatting Variables
20673 @cindex formatting variables
20674
20675 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20676 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20677 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20678 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20679 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20680 be annoyed by.
20681
20682 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20683 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20684 lots of percentages everywhere.
20685
20686 @menu
20687 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20688 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20689 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20690 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20691 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20692 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20693 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20694 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20695 @end menu
20696
20697 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20698 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20699 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
20700 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
20701 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
20702 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
20703 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
20704 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
20705
20706 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
20707 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
20708
20709 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
20710 @findex gnus-update-format
20711 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
20712 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
20713 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
20714 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
20715
20716
20717
20718 @node Formatting Basics
20719 @subsection Formatting Basics
20720
20721 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
20722 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
20723 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
20724
20725 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
20726 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
20727 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
20728 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
20729 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
20730 the right instead.
20731
20732 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
20733 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
20734 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
20735 less than 4 characters wide.
20736
20737 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
20738 @samp{%&user-date;}.
20739
20740
20741 @node Mode Line Formatting
20742 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
20743
20744 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
20745 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
20746 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
20747 with the following two differences:
20748
20749 @enumerate
20750
20751 @item
20752 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
20753
20754 @item
20755 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
20756 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
20757 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
20758 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
20759 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
20760 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
20761 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
20762
20763 @end enumerate
20764
20765
20766 @node Advanced Formatting
20767 @subsection Advanced Formatting
20768
20769 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
20770 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
20771 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
20772 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
20773
20774 These are the valid modifiers:
20775
20776 @table @code
20777 @item pad
20778 @itemx pad-left
20779 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
20780 length.
20781
20782 @item pad-right
20783 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
20784 length.
20785
20786 @item max
20787 @itemx max-left
20788 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
20789
20790 @item max-right
20791 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
20792 length.
20793
20794 @item cut
20795 @itemx cut-left
20796 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
20797
20798 @item cut-right
20799 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
20800
20801 @item ignore
20802 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
20803
20804 @item form
20805 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
20806 used.
20807
20808 Here's an example:
20809
20810 @lisp
20811 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
20812 @end lisp
20813
20814 @end table
20815
20816 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
20817 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
20818 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
20819 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
20820 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
20821 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
20822 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
20823
20824 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
20825 last operation, padding.
20826
20827 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
20828 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
20829 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
20830 @xref{Compilation}.
20831
20832
20833 @node User-Defined Specs
20834 @subsection User-Defined Specs
20835
20836 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
20837 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
20838 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
20839 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
20840 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
20841 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
20842 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
20843 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
20844 should protect against that.
20845
20846 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
20847 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
20848
20849 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
20850 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
20851 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
20852 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
20853 inserted.
20854
20855
20856 @node Formatting Fonts
20857 @subsection Formatting Fonts
20858
20859 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
20860 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
20861 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
20862 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
20863 over it.
20864
20865 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
20866 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
20867 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
20868 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
20869 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
20870 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
20871
20872 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
20873 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
20874 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
20875 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
20876 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
20877 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
20878 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
20879 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
20880 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
20881 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
20882 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
20883 paragraph.)
20884
20885 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
20886
20887 @lisp
20888 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
20889 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
20890 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
20891
20892 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
20893 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
20894 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
20895 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
20896 ;; @r{Set the color.}
20897 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
20898 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
20899
20900 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
20901 (setq gnus-group-line-format
20902 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
20903 @end lisp
20904
20905 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
20906 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
20907
20908 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
20909 mode-line variables.
20910
20911 @node Positioning Point
20912 @subsection Positioning Point
20913
20914 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
20915 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
20916 line. You can customize this behaviour in three different ways.
20917
20918 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
20919
20920 @findex gnus-goto-colon
20921 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
20922 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
20923
20924 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
20925 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
20926 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
20927 place point there.
20928
20929
20930 @node Tabulation
20931 @subsection Tabulation
20932
20933 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
20934 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
20935 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
20936 about lining up the following text afterwards.
20937
20938 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
20939 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
20940
20941 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
20942 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
20943 This is the soft tabulator.
20944
20945 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
20946 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
20947 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
20948
20949
20950 @node Wide Characters
20951 @subsection Wide Characters
20952
20953 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
20954 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
20955 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
20956
20957 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
20958 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
20959 these countries, that's not true.
20960
20961 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
20962 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
20963 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
20964 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
20965 for Emacs.
20966
20967
20968 @node Window Layout
20969 @section Window Layout
20970 @cindex window layout
20971
20972 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
20973
20974 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
20975 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
20976 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
20977 @code{t} by default.
20978
20979 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
20980 glitches. Use at your own peril.
20981
20982 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
20983 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
20984 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
20985
20986 @lisp
20987 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
20988 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
20989 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
20990 (article 1.0))))
20991 @end lisp
20992
20993 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
20994 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
20995 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
20996 possible names is listed below.
20997
20998 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
20999 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21000
21001 @lisp
21002 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21003 (article 1.0)))
21004 @end lisp
21005
21006 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21007 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21008 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21009 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21010 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21011 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21012 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21013 size spec per split.
21014
21015 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21016 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21017 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21018 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21019 present) gets focus.
21020
21021 Here's a more complicated example:
21022
21023 @lisp
21024 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21025 (summary 0.25 point)
21026 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21027 (article 1.0)))
21028 @end lisp
21029
21030 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21031 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21032 occupy, not a percentage.
21033
21034 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21035 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21036 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21037 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21038 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21039 is non-@code{nil}.
21040
21041 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21042
21043 @lisp
21044 (article (horizontal 1.0
21045 (vertical 0.5
21046 (group 1.0)
21047 (gnus-carpal 4))
21048 (vertical 1.0
21049 (summary 0.25 point)
21050 (summary-carpal 4)
21051 (article 1.0))))
21052 @end lisp
21053
21054 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21055 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21056
21057 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21058 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21059 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21060 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21061 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21062
21063 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21064 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21065 lines from the splits.
21066
21067 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21068 may look like:
21069
21070 @example
21071 @group
21072 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21073 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21074 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21075 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21076 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21077 size = number | frame-params
21078 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21079 @end group
21080 @end example
21081
21082 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21083 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21084 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21085 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21086
21087 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21088 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21089 @cindex window height
21090 @cindex window width
21091 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21092 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21093 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21094 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21095 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21096 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21097
21098 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21099 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21100 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21101 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21102
21103 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21104 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21105 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21106 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21107 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21108 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21109 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21110 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21111 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21112 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21113 configuration list.
21114
21115 @lisp
21116 (gnus-configure-frame
21117 '(horizontal 1.0
21118 (vertical 10
21119 (group 1.0)
21120 (article 0.3 point))
21121 (vertical 1.0
21122 (article 1.0)
21123 (horizontal 4
21124 (group 1.0)
21125 (article 10)))))
21126 @end lisp
21127
21128 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21129 @code{frame} split:
21130
21131 @lisp
21132 (gnus-configure-frame
21133 '(frame 1.0
21134 (vertical 1.0
21135 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21136 (article 1.0))
21137 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21138 (user-position . t)
21139 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21140 (picon 1.0))))
21141
21142 @end lisp
21143
21144 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21145 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21146 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21147 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21148 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21149 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21150 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21151 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21152 is such a plist.
21153 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21154 be found in its default value.
21155
21156 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21157 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21158 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21159 might be used:
21160
21161 @lisp
21162 (message (horizontal 1.0
21163 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21164 (vertical 0.24
21165 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21166 '(summary 0.5))
21167 (group 1.0))))
21168 @end lisp
21169
21170 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21171 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21172 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21173
21174 @lisp
21175 (message
21176 (frame 1.0
21177 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21178 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21179 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21180 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21181 (name . "Message"))
21182 (message 1.0 point))))
21183 @end lisp
21184
21185 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21186 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21187 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21188 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21189 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21190
21191 @lisp
21192 (gnus-add-configuration
21193 '(article (vertical 1.0
21194 (group 4)
21195 (summary .25 point)
21196 (article 1.0))))
21197 @end lisp
21198
21199 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21200 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21201 Gnus has been loaded.
21202
21203 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21204 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21205 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21206 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21207 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21208
21209 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21210 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21211 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21212 windows resized.
21213
21214 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21215
21216 @itemize @bullet
21217 @item
21218 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21219 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21220
21221 @ifinfo
21222 @example
21223 +---+---------+
21224 | G | Summary |
21225 | r +---------+
21226 | o | |
21227 | u | Article |
21228 | p | |
21229 +---+---------+
21230 @end example
21231 @end ifinfo
21232
21233 @lisp
21234 (gnus-add-configuration
21235 '(article
21236 (horizontal 1.0
21237 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21238 (vertical 1.0
21239 (summary 0.16 point)
21240 (article 1.0)))))
21241
21242 (gnus-add-configuration
21243 '(summary
21244 (horizontal 1.0
21245 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21246 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21247 @end lisp
21248
21249 @end itemize
21250
21251
21252 @node Faces and Fonts
21253 @section Faces and Fonts
21254 @cindex faces
21255 @cindex fonts
21256 @cindex colors
21257
21258 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21259 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21260 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21261 interface.
21262
21263
21264 @node Compilation
21265 @section Compilation
21266 @cindex compilation
21267 @cindex byte-compilation
21268
21269 @findex gnus-compile
21270
21271 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21272 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21273 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21274 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21275 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21276 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21277 course.)
21278
21279 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21280 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21281 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21282 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21283 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21284 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21285 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21286
21287
21288 @node Mode Lines
21289 @section Mode Lines
21290 @cindex mode lines
21291
21292 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21293 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21294 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21295 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21296 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21297 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21298 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21299 quicker.
21300
21301 @cindex display-time
21302
21303 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21304 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21305 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21306 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21307 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21308 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21309 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21310 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21311 this variable:
21312
21313 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21314 @lisp
21315 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21316 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21317 (+ 21
21318 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21319 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21320 (length display-time-string)))))
21321 @end lisp
21322
21323 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21324 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21325 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21326 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21327 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21328
21329
21330 @node Highlighting and Menus
21331 @section Highlighting and Menus
21332 @cindex visual
21333 @cindex highlighting
21334 @cindex menus
21335
21336 @vindex gnus-visual
21337 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21338 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21339 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21340 file.
21341
21342 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21343 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21344
21345 @table @code
21346 @item group-highlight
21347 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21348 @item summary-highlight
21349 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21350 @item article-highlight
21351 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21352 @item highlight
21353 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21354 @item group-menu
21355 Create menus in the group buffer.
21356 @item summary-menu
21357 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21358 @item article-menu
21359 Create menus in the article buffer.
21360 @item browse-menu
21361 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21362 @item server-menu
21363 Create menus in the server buffer.
21364 @item score-menu
21365 Create menus in the score buffers.
21366 @item menu
21367 Create menus in all buffers.
21368 @end table
21369
21370 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21371 buffers, you could say something like:
21372
21373 @lisp
21374 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21375 @end lisp
21376
21377 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21378
21379 @lisp
21380 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21381 @end lisp
21382
21383 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21384 in all Gnus buffers.
21385
21386 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21387
21388 @table @code
21389 @item gnus-mouse-face
21390 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21391 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21392 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21393
21394 @end table
21395
21396 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21397
21398 @table @code
21399
21400 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21401 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21402 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21403
21404 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21405 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21406 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21407
21408 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21409 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21410 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21411
21412 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21413 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21414 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21415
21416 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21417 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21418 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21419
21420 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21421 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21422 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21423
21424 @end table
21425
21426
21427 @node Buttons
21428 @section Buttons
21429 @cindex buttons
21430 @cindex mouse
21431 @cindex click
21432
21433 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21434 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21435 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21436 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21437 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21438
21439 Right.
21440
21441 @vindex gnus-carpal
21442 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21443 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21444 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21445
21446
21447 @table @code
21448
21449 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21450 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21451 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21452
21453 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21454 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21455 Face used on buttons.
21456
21457 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21458 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21459 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21460
21461 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21462 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21463 Buttons in the group buffer.
21464
21465 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21466 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21467 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21468
21469 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21470 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21471 Buttons in the server buffer.
21472
21473 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21474 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21475 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21476 @end table
21477
21478 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21479 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21480 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21481
21482
21483 @node Daemons
21484 @section Daemons
21485 @cindex demons
21486 @cindex daemons
21487
21488 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21489 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21490 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21491 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21492 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21493
21494 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21495 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21496 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21497
21498 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21499 been idle for thirty minutes:
21500
21501 @lisp
21502 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21503 @end lisp
21504
21505 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21506 Emacs is idle:
21507
21508 @lisp
21509 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21510 @end lisp
21511
21512 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21513 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21514 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21515
21516 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21517 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21518 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21519 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21520
21521 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21522 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21523 @var{idle} minutes.
21524
21525 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21526 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21527 minutes.
21528
21529 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21530 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21531 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21532
21533 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21534 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21535 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21536 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21537
21538 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21539 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21540
21541 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21542 @lisp
21543 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21544 @end lisp
21545
21546 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21547 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21548 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21549 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21550 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21551 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21552 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21553 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21554 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21555 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21556 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21557
21558 @findex gnus-demon-init
21559 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21560 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21561 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21562 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21563 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21564
21565 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21566 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21567 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21568 behave.
21569
21570
21571 @node NoCeM
21572 @section NoCeM
21573 @cindex nocem
21574 @cindex spam
21575
21576 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21577 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21578
21579 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21580 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21581 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21582 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21583 away.
21584
21585 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21586 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21587 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21588 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21589
21590 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21591 this will make spam disappear.
21592
21593 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21594
21595 @table @code
21596 @item gnus-use-nocem
21597 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21598 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21599 by default.
21600
21601 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21602 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21603 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21604 default is
21605 @lisp
21606 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21607 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21608 @end lisp
21609
21610 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21611 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21612 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21613 people you want to listen to. The default is
21614 @lisp
21615 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21616 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21617 @end lisp
21618 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21619
21620 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21621 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21622
21623 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21624 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21625 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21626 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21627 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21628 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21629 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21630 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21631 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21632 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21633
21634 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21635 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21636
21637 @lisp
21638 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21639 @end lisp
21640
21641 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21642 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21643
21644 @lisp
21645 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21646 @end lisp
21647
21648 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21649
21650
21651 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21652 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21653 @findex mc-verify
21654 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21655 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21656 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
21657 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21658
21659 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
21660 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
21661
21662 @lisp
21663 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
21664
21665 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
21666 (not (eq 'forged
21667 (ignore-errors
21668 (if (mc-verify)
21669 t
21670 'forged)))))
21671 @end lisp
21672
21673 This might be dangerous, though.
21674
21675 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21676 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21677 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21678 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21679
21680 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21681 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21682 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21683 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21684 might then see old spam.
21685
21686 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21687 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21688 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21689 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21690 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21691 issuers.
21692
21693 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21694 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21695 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21696 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21697
21698 @end table
21699
21700 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
21701 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
21702 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
21703 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
21704
21705
21706 @node Undo
21707 @section Undo
21708 @cindex undo
21709
21710 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
21711 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
21712 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
21713
21714 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
21715 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
21716 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
21717 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
21718 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
21719 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
21720 @code{undo} function.
21721
21722 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
21723 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
21724 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
21725 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
21726 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
21727 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
21728 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
21729 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
21730 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
21731 never be totally undoable.
21732
21733 @findex gnus-undo-mode
21734 @vindex gnus-use-undo
21735 @findex gnus-undo
21736 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
21737 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
21738 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
21739 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
21740 command.
21741
21742
21743 @node Predicate Specifiers
21744 @section Predicate Specifiers
21745 @cindex predicate specifiers
21746
21747 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
21748 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
21749 to type all that much.
21750
21751 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
21752
21753 Here's an example:
21754
21755 @lisp
21756 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
21757 gnus-article-unread-p)
21758 @end lisp
21759
21760 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
21761 functions all take one parameter.
21762
21763 @findex gnus-make-predicate
21764 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
21765 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
21766 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
21767 specifier.
21768
21769
21770 @node Moderation
21771 @section Moderation
21772 @cindex moderation
21773
21774 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
21775 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
21776 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
21777 get a copy.
21778
21779 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
21780 buffers. Put
21781
21782 @lisp
21783 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
21784 @end lisp
21785
21786 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21787
21788 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
21789 supposed to work:
21790
21791 @enumerate
21792 @item
21793 You split your incoming mail by matching on
21794 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
21795 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
21796
21797 @item
21798 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
21799 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
21800
21801 @item
21802 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
21803 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
21804 @kbd{c} command.
21805 @end enumerate
21806
21807 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
21808
21809 @lisp
21810 (setq gnus-moderated-list
21811 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
21812 @end lisp
21813
21814
21815 @node Image Enhancements
21816 @section Image Enhancements
21817
21818 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
21819 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
21820 taken advantage of that.
21821
21822 @menu
21823 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
21824 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
21825 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
21826 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
21827 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
21828 @end menu
21829
21830
21831 @node X-Face
21832 @subsection X-Face
21833 @cindex x-face
21834
21835 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
21836 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
21837 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
21838 readers.
21839
21840 @cindex x-face
21841 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
21842 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
21843 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
21844 @iftex
21845 @iflatex
21846 \include{xface}
21847 @end iflatex
21848 @end iftex
21849 @c @anchor{X-Face}
21850
21851 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
21852 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
21853 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
21854 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
21855
21856 The variable that controls this is the
21857 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
21858 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
21859 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
21860 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
21861 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
21862
21863 The default action under Emacs 20 is to fork off the @code{display}
21864 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For
21865 the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
21866 like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux system.} to
21867 view the face.
21868
21869 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
21870 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
21871 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
21872 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
21873 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
21874 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
21875 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
21876 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
21877
21878 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
21879 @code{xface}).
21880
21881 @noindent
21882 Face and variable:
21883
21884 @table @code
21885 @item gnus-x-face
21886 @vindex gnus-x-face
21887 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
21888 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
21889 default colors are black and white.
21890 @end table
21891
21892 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
21893 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
21894
21895 @findex gnus-random-x-face
21896 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
21897 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
21898 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
21899 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
21900 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
21901 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
21902 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
21903 header data as a string.
21904
21905 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
21906 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
21907 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
21908 randomly generated data.
21909
21910 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
21911 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
21912 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
21913 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
21914 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
21915
21916 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
21917 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21918
21919 @lisp
21920 (setq message-required-news-headers
21921 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21922 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
21923 @end lisp
21924
21925 Using the last function would be something like this:
21926
21927 @lisp
21928 (setq message-required-news-headers
21929 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21930 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
21931 (gnus-x-face-from-file
21932 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
21933 @end lisp
21934
21935
21936 @node Face
21937 @subsection Face
21938 @cindex face
21939
21940 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces'implementations should really be harmonized.
21941
21942 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
21943 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
21944 represent the author of the message.
21945
21946 @cindex face
21947 @findex gnus-article-display-face
21948 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
21949 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
21950 specifications.
21951
21952 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
21953 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
21954
21955 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
21956 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
21957 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
21958
21959 @findex gnus-face-from-file
21960 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
21961 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
21962 converts the file to Face format by using the
21963 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
21964
21965 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
21966 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21967
21968 @lisp
21969 (setq message-required-news-headers
21970 (nconc message-required-news-headers
21971 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
21972 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
21973 @end lisp
21974
21975
21976 @node Smileys
21977 @subsection Smileys
21978 @cindex smileys
21979
21980 @iftex
21981 @iflatex
21982 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
21983 \input{smiley}
21984 @end iflatex
21985 @end iftex
21986
21987 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
21988 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
21989
21990 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
21991 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21992
21993 @lisp
21994 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
21995 @end lisp
21996
21997 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
21998 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
21999 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22000 text and maps that to file names.
22001
22002 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22003 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22004 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22005 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22006 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22007 displayed.
22008
22009 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22010 files:
22011
22012 @table @code
22013
22014 @item smiley-data-directory
22015 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22016 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22017
22018 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22019 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22020 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22021
22022 @end table
22023
22024
22025 @node Picons
22026 @subsection Picons
22027
22028 @iftex
22029 @iflatex
22030 \include{picons}
22031 @end iflatex
22032 @end iftex
22033
22034 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22035 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22036 over your shoulder as you read news.
22037
22038 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22039
22040 @iftex
22041 @iflatex
22042 \margindex{}
22043 @end iflatex
22044 @end iftex
22045
22046 @quotation
22047 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22048 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22049 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22050 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22051 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22052 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22053 @code{GIF} formats.
22054 @end quotation
22055
22056 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22057 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22058 point your Web browser at
22059 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22060
22061 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22062 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22063
22064 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22065 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22066 Picons databases.
22067
22068 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22069
22070 @table @code
22071
22072 @item gnus-picon-databases
22073 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22074 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22075 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22076 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22077 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22078
22079 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22080 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22081 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22082 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22083
22084 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22085 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22086 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22087 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22088
22089 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22090 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22091 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22092 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22093 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22094
22095 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22096 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22097 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22098 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22099
22100 @end table
22101
22102
22103 @node XVarious
22104 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22105
22106 @table @code
22107 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22108 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22109 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22110 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22111 unusual directory structure.
22112
22113 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22114 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
22115 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
22116 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
22117
22118 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22119 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
22120 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
22121 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
22122 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
22123 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
22124
22125 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22126 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22127 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22128 default.
22129
22130 @end table
22131
22132 @subsubsection Toolbar
22133
22134 @table @code
22135
22136 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22137 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22138 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
22139 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
22140 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
22141
22142 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22143 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22144 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22145
22146 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22147 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22148 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22149
22150 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22151 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22152 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22153
22154 @end table
22155
22156 @iftex
22157 @iflatex
22158 \margindex{}
22159 @end iflatex
22160 @end iftex
22161
22162
22163 @node Fuzzy Matching
22164 @section Fuzzy Matching
22165 @cindex fuzzy matching
22166
22167 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22168 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22169
22170 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22171 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22172 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22173
22174 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22175 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22176 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22177 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22178 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22179
22180
22181 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22182 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22183 @cindex email spam
22184 @cindex spam
22185 @cindex UCE
22186 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22187
22188 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22189 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22190 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22191 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22192 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22193 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22194 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22195 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22196 in the end.
22197
22198 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22199 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22200 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22201 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22202 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22203 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22204
22205 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22206
22207 @menu
22208 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22209 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22210 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22211 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22212 * Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package::
22213 * Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat::
22214 @end menu
22215
22216 @node The problem of spam
22217 @subsection The problem of spam
22218 @cindex email spam
22219 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22220 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22221 @cindex UCE
22222 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22223
22224 First, some background on spam.
22225
22226 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22227 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22228 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22229 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22230 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22231 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22232 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22233 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22234 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22235
22236 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22237 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22238 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22239 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22240 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22241 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22242 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22243 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22244 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22245 and processing.
22246
22247 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22248 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22249 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22250 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22251 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22252 lots of spam from China, for example, you try to filter all mail from
22253 Chinese IPs.
22254
22255 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. For
22256 instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has been
22257 blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22258 words that were common in spam messages. The risks of blocking a
22259 whole country from contacting you should also be obvious, so don't do
22260 it if you have the choice. Nevertheless, in isolated cases, with
22261 great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22262
22263 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22264 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22265 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22266 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22267 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22268 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22269 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22270 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22271 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22272
22273 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22274 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22275 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22276 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22277 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22278 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22279 down for some time because of the incident.
22280
22281 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22282 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22283 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22284 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22285 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22286 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22287 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22288 to store the database of spam analyses. Statistical analysis on the
22289 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22290 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22291 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22292
22293 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22294 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22295 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22296 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22297 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22298 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22299 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22300 spam plague.
22301
22302 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22303 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22304 @cindex email spam
22305 @cindex spam
22306 @cindex UCE
22307 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22308
22309 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22310 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22311
22312 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22313 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22314 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22315 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22316 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22317 part of the mail address.)
22318
22319 @lisp
22320 (setq message-default-news-headers
22321 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22322 @end lisp
22323
22324 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22325 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22326
22327 @lisp
22328 (...
22329 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22330 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22331 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22332 "spam"))
22333 ...)
22334 @end lisp
22335
22336 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22337 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22338 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22339 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22340
22341 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22342 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22343 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22344 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22345 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22346 your fancy split rule in this way:
22347
22348 @lisp
22349 (
22350 ...
22351 (to "larsi" "misc")
22352 "spam")
22353 @end lisp
22354
22355 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22356 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22357 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22358 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22359 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22360
22361 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22362 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22363 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22364 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22365
22366 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22367
22368
22369 @node SpamAssassin
22370 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22371 @cindex SpamAssassin
22372 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22373 @cindex DCC
22374
22375 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22376 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22377 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22378 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22379 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22380 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22381 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22382
22383 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22384 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22385 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22386 recipes.
22387
22388 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22389 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22390 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22391 Specifiers}) follow.
22392
22393 @lisp
22394 (setq mail-sources
22395 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22396 (pop :user "jrl"
22397 :server "pophost"
22398 :postscript
22399 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22400 @end lisp
22401
22402 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22403 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22404 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22405
22406 @lisp
22407 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22408 ...))
22409 @end lisp
22410
22411 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22412
22413 @lisp
22414 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22415 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22416 ...))
22417 @end lisp
22418
22419 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22420 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22421 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22422 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22423
22424 @lisp
22425 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22426 ...))
22427 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22428 (save-excursion
22429 (save-restriction
22430 (widen)
22431 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22432 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22433 "spam"))))
22434 @end lisp
22435
22436 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22437 downloaded by default. You need to set
22438 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to t to do that (@pxref{Splitting in
22439 IMAP}).
22440
22441 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22442 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22443 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22444
22445 @lisp
22446 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22447 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22448 (interactive)
22449 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22450 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22451 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22452 @end lisp
22453
22454 @node Hashcash
22455 @subsection Hashcash
22456 @cindex hashcash
22457
22458 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22459 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22460 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22461 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22462 in smaller communities.
22463
22464 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22465 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22466 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22467 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22468 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22469 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22470 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22471 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22472 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22473 one of them separately.
22474
22475 @cindex X-Hashcash
22476 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22477 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22478 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22479 header. For more details, and for the external application
22480 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22481 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22482 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22483
22484 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22485 like:
22486
22487 @lisp
22488 (require 'hashcash)
22489 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22490 @end lisp
22491
22492 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22493 contrib directory or at
22494 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22495
22496 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22497
22498 @table @code
22499
22500 @item hashcash-default-payment
22501 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22502 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22503 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22504 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22505
22506 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22507 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22508 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22509 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22510 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22511 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22512 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22513 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22514 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22515
22516 @item hashcash
22517 @vindex hashcash
22518 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22519
22520 @end table
22521
22522 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22523 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22524 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22525 a useful contribution, however.
22526
22527 @node Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22528 @subsection Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package
22529 @cindex spam filtering
22530 @cindex spam
22531
22532 The idea behind @file{spam.el} is to have a control center for spam detection
22533 and filtering in Gnus. To that end, @file{spam.el} does two things: it
22534 filters new mail, and it analyzes mail known to be spam or ham.
22535 @dfn{Ham} is the name used throughout @file{spam.el} to indicate
22536 non-spam messages.
22537
22538 First of all, you @strong{must} run the function
22539 @code{spam-initialize} to autoload @code{spam.el} and to install the
22540 @code{spam.el} hooks. There is one exception: if you use the
22541 @code{spam-use-stat} (@pxref{spam-stat spam filtering}) setting, you
22542 should turn it on before @code{spam-initialize}:
22543
22544 @example
22545 (setq spam-use-stat t) ;; if needed
22546 (spam-initialize)
22547 @end example
22548
22549 So, what happens when you load @file{spam.el}?
22550
22551 First, some hooks will get installed by @code{spam-initialize}. There
22552 are some hooks for @code{spam-stat} so it can save its databases, and
22553 there are hooks so interesting things will happen when you enter and
22554 leave a group. More on the sequence of events later (@pxref{Spam
22555 ELisp Package Sequence of Events}).
22556
22557 You get the following keyboard commands:
22558
22559 @table @kbd
22560
22561 @item M-d
22562 @itemx M s x
22563 @itemx S x
22564 @kindex M-d
22565 @kindex S x
22566 @kindex M s x
22567 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22568 @code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}.
22569
22570 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark.
22571 Whenever you see a spam article, make sure to mark its summary line
22572 with @kbd{M-d} before leaving the group. This is done automatically
22573 for unread articles in @emph{spam} groups.
22574
22575 @item M s t
22576 @itemx S t
22577 @kindex M s t
22578 @kindex S t
22579 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
22580 @code{spam-bogofilter-score}.
22581
22582 You must have Bogofilter installed for that command to work properly.
22583
22584 @xref{Bogofilter}.
22585
22586 @end table
22587
22588 Also, when you load @file{spam.el}, you will be able to customize its
22589 variables. Try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{spam} variable
22590 group.
22591
22592 @menu
22593 * Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events::
22594 * Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail::
22595 * Spam ELisp Package Global Variables::
22596 * Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples::
22597 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
22598 * BBDB Whitelists::
22599 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
22600 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
22601 * Blackholes::
22602 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
22603 * Bogofilter::
22604 * ifile spam filtering::
22605 * spam-stat spam filtering::
22606 * SpamOracle::
22607 * Extending the Spam ELisp package::
22608 @end menu
22609
22610 @node Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22611 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Sequence of Events
22612 @cindex spam filtering
22613 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22614 @cindex spam
22615
22616 You must read this section to understand how @code{spam.el} works.
22617 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22618
22619 There are two @emph{contact points}, if you will, between
22620 @code{spam.el} and the rest of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and
22621 leaving a group.
22622
22623 Getting new mail is done in one of two ways. You can either split
22624 your incoming mail or you can classify new articles as ham or spam
22625 when you enter the group.
22626
22627 Splitting incoming mail is better suited to mail backends such as
22628 @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap} where new mail appears in a single file
22629 called a @dfn{Spool File}. See @xref{Spam ELisp Package Filtering of
22630 Incoming Mail}.
22631
22632 For backends such as @code{nntp} there is no incoming mail spool, so
22633 an alternate mechanism must be used. This may also happen for
22634 backends where the server is in charge of splitting incoming mail, and
22635 Gnus does not do further splitting. The @code{spam-autodetect} and
22636 @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameters (accessible with
22637 @kbd{G c} and @kbd{G p} as usual), and the corresponding variables
22638 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} and
22639 @code{gnus-spam-autodetect-methods} (accessible with @kbd{M-x
22640 customize-variable} as usual).
22641
22642 When @code{spam-autodetect} is used, it hooks into the process of
22643 entering a group. Thus, entering a group with unseen or unread
22644 articles becomes the substitute for checking incoming mail. Whether
22645 only unseen articles or all unread articles will be processed is
22646 determined by the @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages}. When set
22647 to t, unread messages will be rechecked.
22648
22649 @code{spam-autodetect} grants the user at once more and less control
22650 of spam filtering. The user will have more control over each group's
22651 spam methods, so for instance the @samp{ding} group may have
22652 @code{spam-use-BBDB} as the autodetection method, while the
22653 @samp{suspect} group may have the @code{spam-use-blacklist} and
22654 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods enabled. Every article detected to
22655 be spam will be marked with the spam mark @samp{$} and processed on
22656 exit from the group as normal spam. The user has less control over
22657 the @emph{sequence} of checks, as he might with @code{spam-split}.
22658
22659 When the newly split mail goes into groups, or messages are
22660 autodetected to be ham or spam, those groups must be exited (after
22661 entering, if needed) for further spam processing to happen. It
22662 matters whether the group is considered a ham group, a spam group, or
22663 is unclassified, based on its @code{spam-content} parameter
22664 (@pxref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). Spam groups have the
22665 additional characteristic that, when entered, any unseen or unread
22666 articles (depending on the @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam}
22667 variable) will be marked as spam. Thus, mail split into a spam group
22668 gets automatically marked as spam when you enter the group.
22669
22670 So, when you exit a group, the @code{spam-processors} are applied, if
22671 any are set, and the processed mail is moved to the
22672 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination}
22673 depending on the article's classification. If the
22674 @code{ham-process-destination} or the @code{spam-process-destination},
22675 whichever is appropriate, are nil, the article is left in the current
22676 group.
22677
22678 If a spam is found in any group (this can be changed to only non-spam
22679 groups with @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only}), it is
22680 processed by the active @code{spam-processors} (@pxref{Spam ELisp
22681 Package Global Variables}) when the group is exited. Furthermore, the
22682 spam is moved to the @code{spam-process-destination} (@pxref{Spam
22683 ELisp Package Global Variables}) for further training or deletion.
22684 You have to load the @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22685 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want spam to be processed
22686 no more than once. Thus, spam is detected and processed everywhere,
22687 which is what most people want. If the
22688 @code{spam-process-destination} is nil, the spam is marked as
22689 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22690
22691 If spam can not be moved - because of a read-only backend such as NNTP,
22692 for example, it will be copied.
22693
22694 If a ham mail is found in a ham group, as determined by the
22695 @code{ham-marks} parameter, it is processed as ham by the active ham
22696 @code{spam-processor} when the group is exited. With the variables
22697 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22698 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} the behavior can be further
22699 altered so ham found anywhere can be processed. You have to load the
22700 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and enable the
22701 @code{spam-log-to-registry} variable if you want ham to be processed
22702 no more than once. Thus, ham is detected and processed only when
22703 necessary, which is what most people want. More on this in
22704 @xref{Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples}.
22705
22706 If ham can not be moved - because of a read-only backend such as NNTP,
22707 for example, it will be copied.
22708
22709 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22710 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface... err, sorry, that's
22711 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22712
22713 @node Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22714 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Filtering of Incoming Mail
22715 @cindex spam filtering
22716 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
22717 @cindex spam
22718
22719 To use the @file{spam.el} facilities for incoming mail filtering, you
22720 must add the following to your fancy split list
22721 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}:
22722
22723 @example
22724 (: spam-split)
22725 @end example
22726
22727 Note that the fancy split may be called @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
22728 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on whether you use the nnmail or
22729 nnimap back ends to retrieve your mail.
22730
22731 The @code{spam-split} function will process incoming mail and send the
22732 mail considered to be spam into the group name given by the variable
22733 @code{spam-split-group}. By default that group name is @samp{spam},
22734 but you can customize @code{spam-split-group}. Make sure the contents
22735 of @code{spam-split-group} are an @emph{unqualified} group name, for
22736 instance in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server} the value
22737 @samp{spam} will turn out to be @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The
22738 value @samp{nnimap+server:spam}, therefore, is wrong and will
22739 actually give you the group
22740 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam} which may or may not
22741 work depending on your server's tolerance for strange group names.
22742
22743 You can also give @code{spam-split} a parameter,
22744 e.g. @samp{'spam-use-regex-headers} or @samp{"maybe-spam"}. Why is
22745 this useful?
22746
22747 Take these split rules (with @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and
22748 @code{spam-use-blackholes} set):
22749
22750 @example
22751 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22752 (any "ding" "ding")
22753 (: spam-split)
22754 ;; default mailbox
22755 "mail")
22756 @end example
22757
22758 Now, the problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the
22759 ding folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam
22760 detected by SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through,
22761 when it's sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to
22762 the ding list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the
22763 invocation of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
22764
22765 You can let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, but all other
22766 @code{spam-split} rules (including a second invocation of the
22767 regex-headers check) will be after the ding rule:
22768
22769 @example
22770 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
22771 ;;; all spam detected by spam-use-regex-headers goes to "regex-spam"
22772 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
22773 (any "ding" "ding")
22774 ;;; all other spam detected by spam-split goes to spam-split-group
22775 (: spam-split)
22776 ;; default mailbox
22777 "mail")
22778 @end example
22779
22780 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
22781 your particular needs, and to target the results of those checks to a
22782 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
22783 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
22784 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
22785 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
22786 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
22787
22788 You should still have specific checks such as
22789 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} set to @code{t}, even if you
22790 specifically invoke @code{spam-split} with the check. The reason is
22791 that when loading @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done
22792 depending on what @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. This
22793 is usually not critical, though.
22794
22795 @emph{Note for IMAP users}
22796
22797 The boolean variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} needs to be
22798 set, if you want to split based on the whole message instead of just
22799 the headers. By default, the nnimap back end will only retrieve the
22800 message headers. If you use @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
22801 @code{spam-check-ifile}, or @code{spam-check-stat} (the splitters that
22802 can benefit from the full message body), you should set this variable.
22803 It is not set by default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and
22804 that is not an appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user.
22805
22806 @xref{Splitting in IMAP}.
22807
22808 @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
22809 statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
22810 don't.}
22811
22812 @node Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22813 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Global Variables
22814 @cindex spam filtering
22815 @cindex spam filtering variables
22816 @cindex spam variables
22817 @cindex spam
22818
22819 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
22820 The concepts of ham processors and spam processors are very important.
22821 Ham processors and spam processors for a group can be set with the
22822 @code{spam-process} group parameter, or the
22823 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. Ham processors take
22824 mail known to be non-spam (@emph{ham}) and process it in some way so
22825 that later similar mail will also be considered non-spam. Spam
22826 processors take mail known to be spam and process it so similar spam
22827 will be detected later.
22828
22829 The format of the spam or ham processor entry used to be a symbol,
22830 but now it is a cons cell. See the individual spam processor entries
22831 for more information.
22832
22833 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
22834 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
22835 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
22836 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
22837 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
22838 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
22839 by customizing the corresponding variable
22840 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
22841 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
22842 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
22843 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
22844 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
22845 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
22846 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
22847 default.
22848
22849 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
22850 @cindex $
22851 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
22852 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
22853 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
22854 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
22855 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
22856 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
22857 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
22858 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
22859 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
22860 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
22861 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
22862 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
22863 processor which will study them as spam samples.
22864
22865 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
22866 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
22867 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
22868 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
22869 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
22870 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
22871 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
22872 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
22873
22874 @defvar ham-marks
22875 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22876 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
22877 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
22878 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
22879 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
22880 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
22881 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
22882 happy for you.
22883 @end defvar
22884
22885 @defvar spam-marks
22886 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
22887 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
22888 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
22889 you really want to.
22890 @end defvar
22891
22892 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
22893 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
22894 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
22895 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
22896 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
22897 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
22898 and nothing else.
22899
22900 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
22901 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
22902 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
22903 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
22904 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
22905 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
22906 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
22907 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
22908 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with
22909 @code{customize-variable gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
22910 newsgroup specification has the format (REGEXP PROCESSOR) in a
22911 standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually.
22912 The ultimate location is a group name or names. If the
22913 @code{ham-process-destination} parameter is not set, ham articles are
22914 left in place. If the
22915 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
22916 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
22917
22918 If ham can not be moved - because of a read-only backend such as NNTP,
22919 for example, it will be copied.
22920
22921 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
22922 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
22923 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
22924
22925 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
22926 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
22927
22928 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
22929 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
22930 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
22931 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
22932 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
22933
22934 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
22935 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
22936 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
22937 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
22938 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
22939 it there.
22940
22941 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
22942 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
22943 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
22944 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
22945 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
22946 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
22947 customize this variable with @code{customize-variable
22948 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each newsgroup specification has
22949 the repeated format (REGEXP GROUP) and they are all in a standard Lisp
22950 list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. The ultimate
22951 location is a group name or names. If the
22952 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
22953 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
22954 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
22955 group buffer then you need it here as well.
22956
22957 If spam can not be moved - because of a read-only backend such as NNTP,
22958 for example, it will be copied.
22959
22960 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
22961 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
22962 training} groups.
22963
22964 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
22965 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
22966 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
22967 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
22968 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
22969 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
22970 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
22971
22972 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
22973 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
22974 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to nil,
22975 unread articles will also be marked as spam.
22976
22977 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
22978 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
22979 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
22980 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham - the article will be placed
22981 in your ham-process-destination, unmarked as if it came fresh from
22982 the mail server.
22983
22984 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
22985 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
22986 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
22987 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
22988
22989 @node Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
22990 @subsubsection Spam ELisp Package Configuration Examples
22991 @cindex spam filtering
22992 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
22993 @cindex spam configuration examples
22994 @cindex spam
22995
22996 @subsubheading Ted's setup
22997
22998 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
22999 @example
23000
23001 ;; for gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent and spam autodetection
23002 ;; see gnus-registry.el for more information
23003 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23004 (spam-initialize)
23005
23006 ;; I like control-S for marking spam
23007 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23008
23009 (setq
23010 spam-log-to-registry t ;; for spam autodetection
23011 spam-use-BBDB t
23012 spam-use-regex-headers t ; catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)
23013 ;; all groups with "spam" in the name contain spam
23014 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23015 ;; see documentation for these
23016 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23017 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23018 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23019 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23020 ;; understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!
23021 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23022 ;; trace references to parents and put in their group
23023 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23024 ;; this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags
23025 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23026 (any "ding" "ding")
23027 ;; note that spam by default will go to "spam"
23028 (: spam-split)
23029 ;; default mailbox
23030 "mail"))
23031
23032 ;; my parameters, set with `G p'
23033
23034 ;; all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except
23035 ;; "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train" and
23036 ;; "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam": any spam goes to nnimap training,
23037 ;; because it must have been detected manually
23038
23039 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23040
23041 ;; all NNTP groups
23042 ;; autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB
23043 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23044 ;; send all spam to the training group
23045 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23046
23047 ;; only some NNTP groups, where I want to autodetect spam
23048 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23049
23050 ;; my nnimap "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam" group
23051
23052 ;; this is a spam group
23053 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23054
23055 ;; any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,
23056 ;; because of the gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents setting above), goes to
23057 ;; "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train" unless I mark it as ham
23058
23059 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23060
23061 ;; any ham goes to my "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail" folder, but
23062 ;; also to my "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham" folder for training
23063
23064 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23065 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23066 ;; in this group, only '!' marks are ham
23067 (ham-marks
23068 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23069 ;; remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out - this is
23070 ;; definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better
23071 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23072
23073 ;; Later, on the IMAP server I use the "train" group for training
23074 ;; SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the "trainham" group for
23075 ;; recognizing ham - but Gnus has nothing to do with it.
23076
23077 @end example
23078
23079 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23080
23081 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23082
23083 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23084 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23085 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23086 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23087 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23088 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23089 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23090 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23091 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23092
23093 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23094 does most of the job for me:
23095
23096 @lisp
23097 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23098 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23099 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23100 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23101 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23102 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23103 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23104 @end lisp
23105
23106 @itemize
23107
23108 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23109
23110 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23111 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23112 bogofilter or DCC).
23113
23114 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23115 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23116 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark (@code{ham-marks},
23117 @ref{Spam ELisp Package Global Variables}). On group exit, those
23118 messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (were I want to have
23119 the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter) and
23120 deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23121
23122 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23123 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23124 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23125 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23126 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23127 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23128
23129 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23130
23131 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23132 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23133 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23134 @samp{training.ham}.
23135 @end itemize
23136
23137 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23138
23139 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23140
23141 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23142 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23143 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23144
23145 @lisp
23146 ("^gmane\\."
23147 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23148 @end lisp
23149
23150 Additionally, I use `(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)'
23151 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23152 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23153 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23154 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23155
23156 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23157 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23158 @cindex spam filtering
23159 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23160 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23161 @cindex spam
23162
23163 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23164
23165 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23166 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23167 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23168 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23169 be spammers.
23170
23171 @end defvar
23172
23173 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23174
23175 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23176 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23177 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23178 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23179 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23180
23181 @end defvar
23182
23183 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23184
23185 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23186 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23187 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23188
23189 @end defvar
23190
23191 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23192
23193 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23194 customizing the group parameters or the
23195 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23196 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23197 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23198
23199 @emph{WARNING}
23200
23201 Instead of the obsolete
23202 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23203 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23204 the same way, we promise.
23205
23206 @end defvar
23207
23208 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23209
23210 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23211 customizing the group parameters or the
23212 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23213 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23214 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23215 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23216 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23217
23218 @emph{WARNING}
23219
23220 Instead of the obsolete
23221 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23222 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23223 the same way, we promise.
23224
23225 @end defvar
23226
23227 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23228 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23229 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23230 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23231 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23232
23233 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23234 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23235 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23236 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23237
23238 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23239 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23240 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23241 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23242 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23243 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23244
23245 @node BBDB Whitelists
23246 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23247 @cindex spam filtering
23248 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23249 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23250 @cindex spam
23251
23252 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23253
23254 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23255 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23256 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23257 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23258 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23259 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23260 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23261
23262 @end defvar
23263
23264 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23265
23266 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23267 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23268 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23269 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23270 classified as spammers.
23271
23272 @end defvar
23273
23274 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23275
23276 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23277 customizing the group parameters or the
23278 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23279 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23280 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23281 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23282 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23283
23284 @emph{WARNING}
23285
23286 Instead of the obsolete
23287 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23288 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23289 the same way, we promise.
23290
23291 @end defvar
23292
23293 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23294 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23295 @cindex spam reporting
23296 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23297 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23298 @cindex spam
23299
23300 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23301
23302 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23303 customizing the group parameters or the
23304 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23305 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23306 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23307 HTTP request.
23308
23309 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23310
23311 @emph{WARNING}
23312
23313 Instead of the obsolete
23314 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23315 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23316 same way, we promise.
23317
23318 @end defvar
23319
23320 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23321
23322 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23323 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23324 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23325 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23326 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23327 Gmane provides.
23328
23329 @end defvar
23330
23331 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23332 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23333 @cindex spam filtering
23334 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23335 @cindex spam
23336
23337 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23338
23339 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23340 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23341 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23342 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23343 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23344 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23345 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23346 ham.
23347
23348 @end defvar
23349
23350 @node Blackholes
23351 @subsubsection Blackholes
23352 @cindex spam filtering
23353 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23354 @cindex spam
23355
23356 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23357
23358 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23359 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23360 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23361 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23362 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23363 contains outdated servers.
23364
23365 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23366 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23367 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23368 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23369 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23370 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23371
23372 @end defvar
23373
23374 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23375
23376 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23377
23378 @end defvar
23379
23380 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23381
23382 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23383 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23384
23385 @end defvar
23386
23387 @defvar spam-use-dig
23388
23389 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23390 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23391
23392 @end defvar
23393
23394 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23395 ham processor for blackholes.
23396
23397 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23398 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23399 @cindex spam filtering
23400 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23401 @cindex spam
23402
23403 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23404
23405 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23406 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23407 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23408 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23409 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23410 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23411
23412 @end defvar
23413
23414 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23415
23416 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23417 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23418
23419 @end defvar
23420
23421 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23422
23423 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23424 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23425
23426 @end defvar
23427
23428 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23429 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23430
23431 @node Bogofilter
23432 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23433 @cindex spam filtering
23434 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23435 @cindex spam
23436
23437 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23438
23439 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23440 speedy Bogofilter.
23441
23442 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23443 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23444 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23445 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23446 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23447 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23448
23449 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23450 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23451 documentation.
23452
23453 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23454 processing will be turned off.
23455
23456 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23457
23458 @end defvar
23459
23460 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23461
23462 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23463 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23464 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23465 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23466 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23467 installation documents for details.
23468
23469 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23470
23471 @end defvar
23472
23473 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23474 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23475 customizing the group parameters or the
23476 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23477 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23478 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23479
23480 @emph{WARNING}
23481
23482 Instead of the obsolete
23483 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23484 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23485 the same way, we promise.
23486 @end defvar
23487
23488 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23489 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23490 customizing the group parameters or the
23491 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23492 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23493 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23494 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23495 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23496
23497 @emph{WARNING}
23498
23499 Instead of the obsolete
23500 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23501 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23502 the same way, we promise.
23503 @end defvar
23504
23505 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23506
23507 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23508 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23509 database directory.
23510
23511 @end defvar
23512
23513 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23514 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23515 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23516 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23517 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23518 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23519
23520 @node ifile spam filtering
23521 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23522 @cindex spam filtering
23523 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23524 @cindex spam
23525
23526 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23527
23528 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23529 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23530
23531 @end defvar
23532
23533 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23534
23535 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23536 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23537 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23538
23539 @end defvar
23540
23541 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23542
23543 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23544 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23545 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23546 @end defvar
23547
23548 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23549
23550 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23551 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23552
23553 @end defvar
23554
23555 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23556 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23557 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23558 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23559 functionality.
23560
23561 @node spam-stat spam filtering
23562 @subsubsection spam-stat spam filtering
23563 @cindex spam filtering
23564 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23565 @cindex spam-stat
23566 @cindex spam
23567
23568 @xref{Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat}.
23569
23570 @defvar spam-use-stat
23571
23572 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use
23573 spam-stat.el, an Emacs Lisp statistical analyzer.
23574
23575 @end defvar
23576
23577 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23578 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23579 customizing the group parameters or the
23580 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23581 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23582 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23583
23584 @emph{WARNING}
23585
23586 Instead of the obsolete
23587 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23588 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23589 the same way, we promise.
23590 @end defvar
23591
23592 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23593 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23594 customizing the group parameters or the
23595 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23596 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23597 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23598 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23599 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23600
23601 @emph{WARNING}
23602
23603 Instead of the obsolete
23604 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23605 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23606 the same way, we promise.
23607 @end defvar
23608
23609 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23610 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23611 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23612 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23613 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23614
23615 @node SpamOracle
23616 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23617 @cindex spam filtering
23618 @cindex SpamOracle
23619 @cindex spam
23620
23621 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23622 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23623 installed separately.
23624
23625 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23626 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23627 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23628 mail as a spam mail or not.
23629
23630 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23631 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23632 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23633
23634 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Filtering Spam
23635 Using The Spam ELisp Package}) call SpamOracle.
23636
23637 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23638 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23639 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23640 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy} as described in
23641 the section @xref{Filtering Spam Using The Spam ELisp Package}. In
23642 this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is filtered using
23643 SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be moved to
23644 @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham messages stay
23645 in @samp{INBOX}:
23646
23647 @example
23648 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23649 spam-split-group "Junk"
23650 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23651 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23652 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23653 @end example
23654
23655 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23656 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23657 SpamOracle.
23658 @end defvar
23659
23660 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
23661 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
23662 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
23663 can be customized.
23664 @end defvar
23665
23666 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
23667 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
23668 store its analyses. This is controlled by the variable
23669 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
23670 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
23671 database to live somewhere special, set
23672 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
23673 @end defvar
23674
23675 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
23676 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
23677 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns the
23678 characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
23679 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
23680 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary buffer
23681 and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using @file{spam.el}'s
23682 spam- and ham-processors, which is much more convenient. For a
23683 detailed description of spam- and ham-processors, @xref{Filtering Spam
23684 Using The Spam ELisp Package}.
23685
23686 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
23687 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23688 customizing the group parameter or the
23689 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23690 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
23691 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
23692
23693 @emph{WARNING}
23694
23695 Instead of the obsolete
23696 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23697 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23698 the same way, we promise.
23699 @end defvar
23700
23701 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
23702 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23703 customizing the group parameter or the
23704 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
23705 to a grup's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
23706 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
23707 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
23708 @emph{unclassified} groups.
23709
23710 @emph{WARNING}
23711
23712 Instead of the obsolete
23713 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
23714 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
23715 the same way, we promise.
23716 @end defvar
23717
23718 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
23719 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
23720 messages.
23721 @example
23722 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
23723 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
23724 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
23725 @end example
23726 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
23727 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
23728 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
23729 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
23730 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
23731 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
23732
23733 @node Extending the Spam ELisp package
23734 @subsubsection Extending the Spam ELisp package
23735 @cindex spam filtering
23736 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
23737 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
23738
23739 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
23740 incoming mail, provide the following:
23741
23742 @enumerate
23743
23744 @item
23745 code
23746
23747 @lisp
23748 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
23749 "True if blackbox should be used.")
23750 @end lisp
23751
23752 Add
23753 @example
23754 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
23755 @end example
23756 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
23757
23758 Add
23759 @example
23760 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
23761 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
23762 @end example
23763 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
23764
23765 Add
23766 @example
23767 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
23768 nil
23769 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
23770 nil)
23771 @end example
23772 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
23773 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
23774 start, or other restister/unregister routines more appropriate to
23775 Blackbox.
23776
23777 @item
23778 functionality
23779
23780 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
23781 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
23782 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
23783 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
23784 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
23785
23786 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
23787 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
23788 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
23789
23790 @end enumerate
23791
23792 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
23793
23794 @enumerate
23795
23796 @item
23797 code
23798
23799 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
23800 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
23801
23802 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
23803 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
23804 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
23805 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
23806
23807 @lisp
23808 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
23809 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
23810 Only applicable to spam groups.")
23811
23812 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
23813 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
23814 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
23815
23816 @end lisp
23817
23818 @item
23819 Gnus parameters
23820
23821 Add
23822 @example
23823 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
23824 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
23825 @end example
23826 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
23827 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
23828 variable customization.
23829
23830 Add
23831 @example
23832 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
23833 @end example
23834 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
23835 @code{gnus.el}.
23836
23837 @end enumerate
23838
23839
23840 @node Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23841 @subsection Filtering Spam Using Statistics with spam-stat
23842 @cindex Paul Graham
23843 @cindex Graham, Paul
23844 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
23845 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
23846 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
23847
23848 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
23849 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
23850 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
23851 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
23852 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
23853 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
23854 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
23855 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
23856 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
23857 or not.
23858
23859 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
23860 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
23861 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
23862 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
23863 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
23864 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
23865 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
23866 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
23867
23868 Gnus supports this kind of filtering. But it needs some setting up.
23869 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
23870 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
23871 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
23872 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
23873
23874 @menu
23875 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
23876 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
23877 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
23878 @end menu
23879
23880 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23881 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
23882
23883 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
23884 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
23885 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
23886 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
23887 need several hundred emails in both collections.
23888
23889 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
23890 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
23891 per mail. Use the following:
23892
23893 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
23894 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
23895 is treated as one spam mail.
23896 @end defun
23897
23898 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
23899 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
23900 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
23901 @end defun
23902
23903 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
23904 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
23905 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
23906 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
23907 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
23908 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
23909
23910 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
23911 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
23912 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
23913 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
23914 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
23915
23916 @defvar spam-stat
23917 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
23918 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
23919 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
23920 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
23921 @end defvar
23922
23923 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
23924 reset the dictionary.
23925
23926 @defun spam-stat-reset
23927 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
23928 @end defun
23929
23930 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
23931 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
23932 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
23933 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
23934 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
23935 only non-spam mails.
23936
23937 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
23938 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
23939 to update the dictionary incrementally.
23940 @end defun
23941
23942 @defun spam-stat-save
23943 Save the dictionary.
23944 @end defun
23945
23946 @defvar spam-stat-file
23947 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
23948 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
23949 @end defvar
23950
23951 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
23952 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
23953
23954 In order to use @code{spam-stat} to split your mail, you need to add the
23955 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23956
23957 @lisp
23958 (require 'spam-stat)
23959 (spam-stat-load)
23960 @end lisp
23961
23962 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
23963 created.
23964
23965 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
23966 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
23967 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
23968 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
23969
23970 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
23971 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
23972 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
23973 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
23974
23975 @lisp
23976 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
23977 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
23978 "mail.misc"))
23979 @end lisp
23980
23981 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
23982 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
23983 @end defvar
23984
23985 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
23986 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
23987 expression are considered potential spam.
23988
23989 @lisp
23990 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
23991 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
23992 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
23993 "mail.misc"))
23994 @end lisp
23995
23996 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
23997 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
23998 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
23999 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24000 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24001
24002 @lisp
24003 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24004 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24005 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24006 "mail.misc"))
24007 @end lisp
24008
24009 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24010 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24011 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24012 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24013 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24014 dictionary!
24015
24016 @lisp
24017 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24018 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24019 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24020 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24021 "mail.misc"))
24022 @end lisp
24023
24024
24025 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24026 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24027
24028 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24029
24030 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24031 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24032 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24033 @end defun
24034
24035 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24036 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24037 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24038 @end defun
24039
24040 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24041 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24042 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24043 already been processed as non-spam.
24044 @end defun
24045
24046 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24047 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24048 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24049 been processed as spam.
24050 @end defun
24051
24052 @defun spam-stat-save
24053 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24054 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24055 @end defun
24056
24057 @defun spam-stat-load
24058 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24059 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24060 @end defun
24061
24062 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24063 Return the spam score for a word.
24064 @end defun
24065
24066 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24067 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24068 @end defun
24069
24070 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24071 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24072 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24073 @end defun
24074
24075 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24076 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24077
24078 @lisp
24079 (require 'spam-stat)
24080 (spam-stat-load)
24081 @end lisp
24082
24083 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24084
24085 @smallexample
24086 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24087 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24088 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24089 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24090 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24091 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24092 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24093 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24094 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24095 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24096 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24097 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24098 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24099 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24100 @end smallexample
24101
24102 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24103
24104 @smallexample
24105 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24106 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24107 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24108 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24109 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24110 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24111 @end smallexample
24112
24113 @node Other modes
24114 @section Interaction with other modes
24115
24116 @subsection Dired
24117 @cindex dired
24118
24119 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24120 buffers. It is enabled with
24121 @lisp
24122 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24123 @end lisp
24124
24125 @table @kbd
24126 @item C-c C-m C-a
24127 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24128 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24129 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24130
24131 @item C-c C-m C-l
24132 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24133 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24134 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24135 buffer.
24136
24137 @item C-c C-m C-p
24138 @findex gnus-dired-print
24139 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24140 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24141 @end table
24142
24143 @node Various Various
24144 @section Various Various
24145 @cindex mode lines
24146 @cindex highlights
24147
24148 @table @code
24149
24150 @item gnus-home-directory
24151 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24152 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24153 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24154
24155 @item gnus-directory
24156 @vindex gnus-directory
24157 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24158 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24159 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24160
24161 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24162 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24163 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24164 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24165
24166 @item gnus-default-directory
24167 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24168 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24169 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24170 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24171 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24172 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24173 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24174
24175 @item gnus-verbose
24176 @vindex gnus-verbose
24177 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24178 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24179 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24180 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24181 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24182
24183 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24184 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24185 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24186 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24187
24188 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24189 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24190 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24191 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
24192 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24193 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24194 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24195 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24196 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24197 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24198
24199 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24200 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24201 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24202 read when doing the operation described above.
24203
24204 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24205 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24206 @cindex file names
24207 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24208 @cindex characters in file names
24209 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24210 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24211 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24212
24213 @lisp
24214 @group
24215 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24216 '((?: . ?_)))
24217 @end group
24218 @end lisp
24219
24220 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24221 Windows (phooey) systems.
24222
24223 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24224 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24225 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24226 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24227 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24228
24229 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24230 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24231 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24232 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24233 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24234
24235 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24236 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24237 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24238
24239 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24240 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24241
24242 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24243 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24244 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24245 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24246 group).
24247
24248 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24249
24250
24251 @end table
24252
24253 @node The End
24254 @chapter The End
24255
24256 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24257 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24258
24259 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24260
24261 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24262
24263 @quotation
24264 @strong{Te Deum}
24265
24266 @sp 1
24267 Not because of victories @*
24268 I sing,@*
24269 having none,@*
24270 but for the common sunshine,@*
24271 the breeze,@*
24272 the largess of the spring.
24273
24274 @sp 1
24275 Not for victory@*
24276 but for the day's work done@*
24277 as well as I was able;@*
24278 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24279 but at the common table.@*
24280 @end quotation
24281
24282
24283 @node Appendices
24284 @chapter Appendices
24285
24286 @menu
24287 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24288 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24289 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24290 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24291 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24292 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24293 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24294 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24295 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24296 @end menu
24297
24298
24299 @node XEmacs
24300 @section XEmacs
24301 @cindex XEmacs
24302 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24303
24304 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24305 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24306 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24307 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24308 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{w3},
24309 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24310
24311
24312 @node History
24313 @section History
24314
24315 @cindex history
24316 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24317 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24318
24319 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24320 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24321 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24322 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24323 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24324
24325 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24326 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24327 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24328 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24329 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24330 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24331
24332 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24333 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24334 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24335 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24336
24337 @menu
24338 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24339 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24340 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24341 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24342 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24343 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24344 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24345 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24346 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24347 @end menu
24348
24349
24350 @node Gnus Versions
24351 @subsection Gnus Versions
24352 @cindex ding Gnus
24353 @cindex September Gnus
24354 @cindex Red Gnus
24355 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24356 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24357 @cindex Oort Gnus
24358 @cindex No Gnus
24359 @cindex Gnus versions
24360
24361 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24362 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24363 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24364
24365 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24366 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24367
24368 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24369 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24370
24371 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24372 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24373
24374 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24375 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24376 1999.
24377
24378 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
24379
24380 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24381 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24382 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
24383 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
24384 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
24385 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24386
24387
24388 @node Other Gnus Versions
24389 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24390 @cindex Semi-gnus
24391
24392 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24393 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24394 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24395 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24396
24397 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24398 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24399 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24400 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24401 Japanese users.
24402
24403
24404 @node Why?
24405 @subsection Why?
24406
24407 What's the point of Gnus?
24408
24409 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24410 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24411 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24412 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24413 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24414 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24415 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24416 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24417 keep track of millions of people who post?
24418
24419 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24420 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24421 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24422 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24423 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24424 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24425 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24426 every one of you to explore and invent.
24427
24428 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24429 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24430
24431
24432 @node Compatibility
24433 @subsection Compatibility
24434
24435 @cindex compatibility
24436 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24437 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24438 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24439
24440 Our motto is:
24441 @quotation
24442 @cartouche
24443 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24444 @end cartouche
24445 @end quotation
24446
24447 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24448 their names.
24449
24450 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24451 Articles}.
24452
24453 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24454 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24455 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24456 important variables have their values copied into their global
24457 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24458 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24459
24460 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24461 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24462 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24463 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24464 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24465 peculiar results.
24466
24467 @cindex hilit19
24468 @cindex highlighting
24469 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24470 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24471 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24472 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24473 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24474 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24475 Away!
24476
24477 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24478 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24479 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24480 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24481
24482 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24483 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24484 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24485 to stop doing it the old way.
24486
24487 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24488
24489 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24490 @findex gnus-bug
24491 @cindex reporting bugs
24492 @cindex bugs
24493 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24494 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24495 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24496
24497 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24498 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24499 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24500 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24501 up at you.
24502
24503
24504 @node Conformity
24505 @subsection Conformity
24506
24507 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24508 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24509 with, of course.
24510
24511 @table @strong
24512
24513 @item RFC (2)822
24514 @cindex RFC 822
24515 @cindex RFC 2822
24516 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24517
24518 @item RFC 1036
24519 @cindex RFC 1036
24520 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24521
24522 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24523 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24524 We do have some breaches to this one.
24525
24526 @table @emph
24527
24528 @item X-Newsreader
24529 @itemx User-Agent
24530 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24531 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24532 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24533 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24534 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24535 @end table
24536
24537 @item USEFOR
24538 @cindex USEFOR
24539 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24540 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24541 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24542 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24543
24544 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24545 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24546 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24547
24548 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24549 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24550
24551 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24552 @cindex RFC 1991
24553 @cindex RFC 2440
24554 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24555 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24556 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24557 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24558 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24559 decryption).
24560
24561 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24562 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24563 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
24564 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24565
24566 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24567 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24568
24569 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24570 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24571 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24572 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24573 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24574 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24575 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24576 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24577
24578 @end table
24579
24580 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24581 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24582 know.
24583
24584
24585 @node Emacsen
24586 @subsection Emacsen
24587 @cindex Emacsen
24588 @cindex XEmacs
24589 @cindex Mule
24590 @cindex Emacs
24591
24592 Gnus should work on:
24593
24594 @itemize @bullet
24595
24596 @item
24597 Emacs 20.7 and up.
24598
24599 @item
24600 XEmacs 21.1 and up.
24601
24602 @end itemize
24603
24604 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24605 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24606 Emacs versions.
24607
24608 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24609 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24610 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24611 Emacsen.
24612
24613
24614 @node Gnus Development
24615 @subsection Gnus Development
24616
24617 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24618 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24619 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24620 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24621 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24622 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24623 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24624 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24625
24626 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24627 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24628 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24629 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24630 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24631
24632 @cindex Incoming*
24633 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24634 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24635 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24636 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24637 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24638
24639 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24640 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24641 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24642 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24643 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24644 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24645 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24646 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24647 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24648 can't be assumed to do so.
24649
24650
24651
24652 @node Contributors
24653 @subsection Contributors
24654 @cindex contributors
24655
24656 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
24657 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
24658 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
24659 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
24660 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
24661 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
24662 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
24663 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
24664 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
24665 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
24666
24667 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
24668 wrong show.
24669
24670 @itemize @bullet
24671
24672 @item
24673 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
24674
24675 @item
24676 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
24677 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
24678 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
24679 functionality and stuff.
24680
24681 @item
24682 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
24683 well as numerous other things).
24684
24685 @item
24686 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
24687
24688 @item
24689 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
24690
24691 @item
24692 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
24693
24694 @item
24695 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
24696
24697 @item
24698 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
24699 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
24700
24701 @item
24702 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
24703
24704 @item
24705 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
24706 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
24707
24708 @item
24709 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
24710
24711 @item
24712 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
24713
24714 @item
24715 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
24716
24717 @item
24718 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
24719
24720 @item
24721 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
24722 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
24723
24724 @item
24725 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
24726
24727 @item
24728 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
24729
24730 @item
24731 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
24732
24733 @item
24734 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
24735 .newsrc files.
24736
24737 @item
24738 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
24739
24740 @item
24741 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
24742
24743 @item
24744 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
24745
24746 @item
24747 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
24748 well as autoconf support.
24749
24750 @end itemize
24751
24752 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
24753 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
24754
24755 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
24756
24757 Christopher Davis,
24758 Andrew Eskilsson,
24759 Kai Grossjohann,
24760 Kevin Greiner,
24761 Jesper Harder,
24762 Paul Jarc,
24763 Simon Josefsson,
24764 David KÃ¥gedal,
24765 Richard Pieri,
24766 Fabrice Popineau,
24767 Daniel Quinlan,
24768 Michael Shields,
24769 Reiner Steib,
24770 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
24771 Jack Vinson,
24772 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
24773 and
24774 Teodor Zlatanov.
24775
24776 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
24777
24778 Jari Aalto,
24779 Adrian Aichner,
24780 Vladimir Alexiev,
24781 Russ Allbery,
24782 Peter Arius,
24783 Matt Armstrong,
24784 Marc Auslander,
24785 Miles Bader,
24786 Alexei V. Barantsev,
24787 Frank Bennett,
24788 Robert Bihlmeyer,
24789 Chris Bone,
24790 Mark Borges,
24791 Mark Boyns,
24792 Lance A. Brown,
24793 Rob Browning,
24794 Kees de Bruin,
24795 Martin Buchholz,
24796 Joe Buehler,
24797 Kevin Buhr,
24798 Alastair Burt,
24799 Joao Cachopo,
24800 Zlatko Calusic,
24801 Massimo Campostrini,
24802 Castor,
24803 David Charlap,
24804 Dan Christensen,
24805 Kevin Christian,
24806 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
24807 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
24808 Laura Conrad,
24809 Michael R. Cook,
24810 Glenn Coombs,
24811 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
24812 Neil Crellin,
24813 Frank D. Cringle,
24814 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
24815 Andre Deparade,
24816 Ulrik Dickow,
24817 Dave Disser,
24818 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
24819 Joev Dubach,
24820 Michael Welsh Duggan,
24821 Dave Edmondson,
24822 Paul Eggert,
24823 Mark W. Eichin,
24824 Karl Eichwalder,
24825 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
24826 Michael Ernst,
24827 Luc Van Eycken,
24828 Sam Falkner,
24829 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
24830 Sigbjorn Finne,
24831 Sven Fischer,
24832 Paul Fisher,
24833 Decklin Foster,
24834 Gary D. Foster,
24835 Paul Franklin,
24836 Guy Geens,
24837 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
24838 David S. Goldberg,
24839 Michelangelo Grigni,
24840 Dale Hagglund,
24841 D. Hall,
24842 Magnus Hammerin,
24843 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
24844 Raja R. Harinath,
24845 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
24846 P. E. Jareth Hein,
24847 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
24848 Scott Hofmann,
24849 Marc Horowitz,
24850 Gunnar Horrigmo,
24851 Richard Hoskins,
24852 Brad Howes,
24853 Miguel de Icaza,
24854 François Felix Ingrand,
24855 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
24856 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
24857 Lee Iverson,
24858 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
24859 Rajappa Iyer,
24860 Andreas Jaeger,
24861 Adam P. Jenkins,
24862 Randell Jesup,
24863 Fred Johansen,
24864 Gareth Jones,
24865 Greg Klanderman,
24866 Karl Kleinpaste,
24867 Michael Klingbeil,
24868 Peter Skov Knudsen,
24869 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
24870 Petr Konecny,
24871 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
24872 Thor Kristoffersen,
24873 Jens Lautenbacher,
24874 Martin Larose,
24875 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
24876 Joerg Lenneis,
24877 Carsten Leonhardt,
24878 James LewisMoss,
24879 Christian Limpach,
24880 Markus Linnala,
24881 Dave Love,
24882 Mike McEwan,
24883 Tonny Madsen,
24884 Shlomo Mahlab,
24885 Nat Makarevitch,
24886 Istvan Marko,
24887 David Martin,
24888 Jason R. Mastaler,
24889 Gordon Matzigkeit,
24890 Timo Metzemakers,
24891 Richard Mlynarik,
24892 Lantz Moore,
24893 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
24894 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
24895 Hrvoje Niksic,
24896 Andy Norman,
24897 Fred Oberhauser,
24898 C. R. Oldham,
24899 Alexandre Oliva,
24900 Ken Olstad,
24901 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
24902 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
24903 Ettore Perazzoli,
24904 William Perry,
24905 Stephen Peters,
24906 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
24907 Ulrich Pfeifer,
24908 Matt Pharr,
24909 Andy Piper,
24910 John McClary Prevost,
24911 Bill Pringlemeir,
24912 Mike Pullen,
24913 Jim Radford,
24914 Colin Rafferty,
24915 Lasse Rasinen,
24916 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
24917 Joe Reiss,
24918 Renaud Rioboo,
24919 Roland B. Roberts,
24920 Bart Robinson,
24921 Christian von Roques,
24922 Markus Rost,
24923 Jason Rumney,
24924 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
24925 Jay Sachs,
24926 Dewey M. Sasser,
24927 Conrad Sauerwald,
24928 Loren Schall,
24929 Dan Schmidt,
24930 Ralph Schleicher,
24931 Philippe Schnoebelen,
24932 Andreas Schwab,
24933 Randal L. Schwartz,
24934 Danny Siu,
24935 Matt Simmons,
24936 Paul D. Smith,
24937 Jeff Sparkes,
24938 Toby Speight,
24939 Michael Sperber,
24940 Darren Stalder,
24941 Richard Stallman,
24942 Greg Stark,
24943 Sam Steingold,
24944 Paul Stevenson,
24945 Jonas Steverud,
24946 Paul Stodghill,
24947 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
24948 Kurt Swanson,
24949 Samuel Tardieu,
24950 Teddy,
24951 Chuck Thompson,
24952 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
24953 Philippe Troin,
24954 James Troup,
24955 Trung Tran-Duc,
24956 Jack Twilley,
24957 Aaron M. Ucko,
24958 Aki Vehtari,
24959 Didier Verna,
24960 Vladimir Volovich,
24961 Jan Vroonhof,
24962 Stefan Waldherr,
24963 Pete Ware,
24964 Barry A. Warsaw,
24965 Christoph Wedler,
24966 Joe Wells,
24967 Lee Willis,
24968 and
24969 Lloyd Zusman.
24970
24971
24972 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
24973 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
24974 (550kB and counting).
24975
24976 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
24977 sure.
24978
24979 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
24980 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
24981
24982
24983 @node New Features
24984 @subsection New Features
24985 @cindex new features
24986
24987 @menu
24988 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
24989 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
24990 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
24991 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
24992 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
24993 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10.
24994 @end menu
24995
24996 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
24997 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
24998 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
24999
25000 @node ding Gnus
25001 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25002
25003 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25004
25005 @itemize @bullet
25006
25007 @item
25008 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25009 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25010
25011 @item
25012 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25013 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25014
25015 @item
25016 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25017
25018 @item
25019 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25020 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25021 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25022
25023 @item
25024 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25025 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25026 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25027 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25028
25029 @item
25030 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25031 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25032
25033 @item
25034 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25035 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25036 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25037
25038 @item
25039 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25040 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25041
25042 @item
25043 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25044 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25045 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25046
25047 @item
25048 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25049 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25050 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25051
25052 @item
25053 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25054 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25055
25056 @item
25057 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25058 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25059
25060 @item
25061 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25062 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25063
25064 @item
25065 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25066 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25067
25068 @item
25069 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25070 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25071
25072 @item
25073 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25074 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25075
25076 @item
25077 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25078
25079 @item
25080 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25081 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25082
25083 @item
25084 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25085 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25086
25087 @item
25088 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25089 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25090
25091 @item
25092 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25093
25094 @item
25095 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25096 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25097
25098 @item
25099 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25100 Articles}).
25101
25102 @item
25103 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25104 Buttons}).
25105
25106 @item
25107 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25108 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25109
25110 @item
25111 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25112 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25113
25114 @end itemize
25115
25116
25117 @node September Gnus
25118 @subsubsection September Gnus
25119
25120 @iftex
25121 @iflatex
25122 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25123 @end iflatex
25124 @end iftex
25125
25126 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25127
25128 @itemize @bullet
25129
25130 @item
25131 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25132 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25133 now obsolete.
25134
25135 @item
25136 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25137 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25138 Threading}).
25139
25140 @lisp
25141 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25142 @end lisp
25143
25144 @item
25145 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25146 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25147
25148 @item
25149 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25150 referred.
25151
25152 @item
25153 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25154
25155 @item
25156 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25157
25158 @item
25159 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25160
25161 @lisp
25162 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25163 @end lisp
25164
25165 @item
25166 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25167 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25168
25169 @lisp
25170 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25171 @end lisp
25172
25173 @item
25174 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25175 Groups}).
25176
25177 @item
25178 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25179 Topics}).
25180
25181 @lisp
25182 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25183 @end lisp
25184
25185 @item
25186 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25187
25188 @item
25189 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25190 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25191
25192 @lisp
25193 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25194 @end lisp
25195
25196 @item
25197 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25198 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25199
25200 @item
25201 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25202
25203 @item
25204 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25205 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25206 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25207
25208 @item
25209 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25210 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25211
25212 @item
25213 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25214
25215 @item
25216 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25217 Groups}).
25218
25219 @item
25220 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25221 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25222
25223 @item
25224 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25225 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25226
25227 @item
25228 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25229 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25230
25231 @item
25232 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25233 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25234 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25235
25236 @item
25237 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25238 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25239
25240 @item
25241 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25242
25243 @item
25244 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25245
25246 @item
25247 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25248
25249 @item
25250 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25251
25252 @item
25253 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25254 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25255
25256 @item
25257 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25258 Layout}).
25259
25260 @item
25261 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25262 @iftex
25263 @iflatex
25264 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25265 @end iflatex
25266 @end iftex
25267
25268 @item
25269 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25270
25271 @lisp
25272 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25273 @end lisp
25274
25275 @item
25276 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25277
25278 @lisp
25279 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25280 @end lisp
25281
25282 @item
25283 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25284
25285 @item
25286 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25287
25288 @item
25289 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25290 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25291
25292 @lisp
25293 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25294 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25295 @end lisp
25296
25297 @item
25298 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25299 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25300
25301 @lisp
25302 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25303 @end lisp
25304
25305 @item
25306 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25307 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25308
25309 @item
25310 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25311
25312 @item
25313 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25314 Articles}).
25315
25316 @lisp
25317 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25318 @end lisp
25319
25320 @item
25321 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25322 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25323
25324 @lisp
25325 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25326 @end lisp
25327
25328 @item
25329 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25330 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25331
25332 @item
25333 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25334 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25335
25336 @lisp
25337 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25338 @end lisp
25339
25340 @item
25341 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25342
25343 @item
25344 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25345
25346 @item
25347 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25348
25349 @end itemize
25350
25351
25352 @node Red Gnus
25353 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25354
25355 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25356
25357 @iftex
25358 @iflatex
25359 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25360 @end iflatex
25361 @end iftex
25362
25363 @itemize @bullet
25364
25365 @item
25366 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25367
25368 @item
25369 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25370 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25371
25372 @item
25373 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25374 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25375 Scoring}).
25376
25377 @item
25378 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25379 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25380
25381 @item
25382 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25383
25384 @item
25385 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25386 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25387
25388 @lisp
25389 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25390 @end lisp
25391
25392 @item
25393 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25394 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25395 been added.
25396
25397 @item
25398 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25399 Server Internals}).
25400
25401 @item
25402 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25403 Parameters}).
25404
25405 @item
25406 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25407
25408 @item
25409 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25410 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25411
25412 @item
25413 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25414 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25415 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25416
25417 @item
25418 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25419 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25420
25421 @item
25422 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25423 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25424
25425 @item
25426 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25427 (@pxref{Undo}).
25428
25429 @item
25430 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25431 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25432
25433 @item
25434 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25435 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25436
25437 @lisp
25438 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25439 @end lisp
25440
25441 @item
25442 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25443
25444 @lisp
25445 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25446 @end lisp
25447
25448 @item
25449 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25450 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25451
25452 @item
25453 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25454 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25455
25456 @item
25457 A new command for reading collections of documents
25458 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25459 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25460
25461 @item
25462 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25463 Marks}).
25464
25465 @item
25466 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25467 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25468
25469 @item
25470 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25471 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25472 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25473
25474 @item
25475 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25476 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25477 Sorting}).
25478
25479 @item
25480 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25481 Groups}).
25482
25483 @item
25484 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25485 Commands}).
25486 @iftex
25487 @iflatex
25488 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25489 @end iflatex
25490 @end iftex
25491
25492 @item
25493 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25494 Variables}).
25495
25496 @item
25497 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25498 Mail}).
25499
25500 @item
25501 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25502 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25503
25504 @item
25505 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25506
25507 @end itemize
25508
25509
25510 @node Quassia Gnus
25511 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25512
25513 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25514
25515 @itemize @bullet
25516
25517 @item
25518 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25519 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25520 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25521
25522 @item
25523 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25524 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25525 group, which is created automatically.
25526
25527 @item
25528 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25529 values.
25530
25531 @item
25532 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25533
25534 @item
25535 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25536 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25537
25538 @item
25539 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25540 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25541
25542 @item
25543 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25544
25545 @item
25546 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25547 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25548
25549 @item
25550 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25551
25552 @item
25553 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25554 details.
25555
25556 @item
25557 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25558 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25559
25560 @item
25561 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25562 control over simplification.
25563
25564 @item
25565 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25566
25567 @item
25568 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25569 limit.
25570
25571 @item
25572 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25573
25574 @item
25575 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25576
25577 @item
25578 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25579 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25580 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25581
25582 @item
25583 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25584 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25585
25586 @item
25587 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25588 text---@kbd{W d}.
25589
25590 @item
25591 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25592 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25593
25594 @item
25595 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25596 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25597
25598 @item
25599 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25600 has been added.
25601
25602 @item
25603 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25604
25605 @item
25606 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25607
25608 @item
25609 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25610 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25611
25612 @item
25613 A new function for citing in Message has been
25614 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25615
25616 @item
25617 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25618
25619 @item
25620 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25621 been added.
25622
25623 @item
25624 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25625 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25626
25627 @item
25628 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25629 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25630
25631 @item
25632 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25633
25634 @item
25635 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25636
25637 @end itemize
25638
25639 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25640 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25641
25642 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25643
25644 @itemize @bullet
25645
25646 @item
25647 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25648 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25649
25650 If you used procmail like in
25651
25652 @lisp
25653 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
25654 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
25655 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
25656 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
25657 @end lisp
25658
25659 this now has changed to
25660
25661 @lisp
25662 (setq mail-sources
25663 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
25664 :suffix ".in")))
25665 @end lisp
25666
25667 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
25668
25669 @item
25670 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
25671 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
25672
25673 @item
25674 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
25675 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
25676
25677 @item
25678 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
25679 called to position point.
25680
25681 @item
25682 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
25683 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
25684
25685 @item
25686 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
25687 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
25688
25689 @item
25690 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
25691 subtly different manner.
25692
25693 @item
25694 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
25695 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
25696 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
25697
25698 @item
25699 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
25700
25701 @end itemize
25702
25703 @node Oort Gnus
25704 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
25705 @cindex Oort Gnus
25706
25707 New features in Gnus 5.10:
25708
25709 @itemize @bullet
25710
25711 @item
25712 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
25713 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
25714 region if the region is active.
25715
25716 @item
25717 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
25718 using @kbd{G M}.
25719
25720 @item
25721 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
25722 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
25723
25724 @item
25725 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
25726 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
25727
25728 @item
25729 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
25730
25731 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
25732 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
25733 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
25734 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
25735 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
25736 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
25737 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
25738 isn't save in general.
25739
25740 @item
25741 Article Buttons
25742
25743 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
25744 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
25745 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
25746 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
25747
25748 @item
25749 Dired integration
25750
25751 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
25752 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
25753 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
25754 entry.
25755
25756 @item
25757 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
25758
25759 @item
25760 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
25761
25762 @item
25763 Picons
25764
25765 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
25766 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
25767
25768 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
25769 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
25770 @xref{Picons}.
25771
25772 @item
25773 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
25774 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
25775
25776 @item
25777 Retrieval of charters and control messages
25778
25779 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
25780 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
25781
25782 @item
25783 Delayed articles
25784
25785 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
25786 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
25787 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
25788
25789 @item
25790 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
25791 decompressed when activated.
25792
25793 @item
25794 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
25795 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
25796
25797 @item
25798 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
25799
25800 @item
25801 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
25802 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
25803
25804 @item
25805 Warn about email replies to news
25806
25807 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
25808 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
25809 you.
25810
25811 @item
25812 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
25813 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
25814 built.
25815
25816 @item
25817 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
25818 opposed to old but unread messages).
25819
25820 @item
25821 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
25822 Gcc articles as read.
25823
25824 @item
25825 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
25826
25827 @item
25828 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
25829 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
25830
25831 @item
25832 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
25833 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
25834
25835 @item
25836 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
25837 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
25838
25839 @item
25840 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
25841 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
25842
25843 @item
25844 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
25845
25846 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
25847 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
25848 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
25849 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
25850
25851 @item
25852 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
25853
25854 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
25855 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
25856 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
25857 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
25858 the second parameter.
25859
25860 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
25861 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
25862 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
25863 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
25864 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
25865 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
25866 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
25867 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
25868 cycle used under Unix systems.
25869
25870 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} superfluous, so it has
25871 been removed.
25872
25873 @item
25874 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
25875
25876 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
25877 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
25878 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
25879 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
25880 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
25881 controls this.
25882
25883 @item
25884 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
25885
25886 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
25887 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
25888 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
25889 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
25890 citations.
25891
25892 @item
25893 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
25894
25895 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
25896 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
25897 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
25898 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
25899
25900 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
25901 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
25902 message cited below.
25903
25904 @item
25905 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
25906
25907 @item
25908 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
25909
25910 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
25911 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
25912 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
25913 variable in @file{~/.emacs} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
25914 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
25915 parameters, a'la:
25916 @lisp
25917 (setq gnus-parameters
25918 '(("mail\\..*"
25919 (gnus-show-threads nil)
25920 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
25921 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
25922 (to-group . "\\1"))))
25923 @end lisp
25924
25925 @item
25926 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now iconized for Emacs too.
25927
25928 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.emacs} to
25929 disable it.
25930
25931 @item
25932 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
25933
25934 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
25935 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
25936 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
25937 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
25938 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
25939 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
25940 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
25941 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
25942 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
25943
25944 @item
25945 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
25946
25947 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
25948 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
25949 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
25950 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
25951 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
25952 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
25953
25954 @item
25955 References and X-Draft-Headers are no longer generated when you start
25956 composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
25957 @code{nil}.
25958
25959 @item
25960 Improved anti-spam features.
25961
25962 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
25963 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
25964 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
25965 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
25966 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
25967
25968 @item
25969 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers.
25970
25971 @item
25972 Face headers handling.
25973
25974 @item
25975 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
25976 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
25977
25978 @item
25979 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
25980
25981 @item
25982 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
25983
25984 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
25985 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
25986 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
25987 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
25988 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
25989 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
25990 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
25991 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
25992 when getting new mail, remove the function.
25993
25994 @item
25995 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
25996
25997 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
25998 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
25999 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26000 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26001 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26002 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26003 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26004 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26005 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26006 was inserted directly.
26007
26008 @item
26009 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26010
26011 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26012 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26013 hierarchy.
26014
26015 @item
26016 @code{gnus-agent}
26017
26018 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26019 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26020 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26021 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26022 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26023 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26024 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26025 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26026 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26027 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26028 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26029 behaviour of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26030 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26031 is not needed any more.
26032
26033 @item
26034 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26035
26036 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26037 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26038 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26039 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26040 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26041 groups.
26042
26043 @item
26044 @file{deuglify.el} (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article})
26045
26046 A new file from Raymond Scholz @email{rscholz@@zonix.de} for deuglifying
26047 broken Outlook (Express) articles.
26048
26049 @item
26050 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26051
26052 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26053 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26054 lisp directory into load-path.
26055
26056 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26057 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26058
26059 @item
26060 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26061
26062 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26063
26064 @item
26065 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26066
26067 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26068 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26069 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26070 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26071
26072 @item
26073 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26074
26075 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26076 @lisp
26077 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26078 'bbdb-complete-name)
26079 @end lisp
26080
26081 @item
26082 Externalizing and deleting of attachments.
26083
26084 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26085 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26086 local files as external parts.
26087
26088 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26089 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26090 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26091 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26092 that support editing.
26093
26094 @item
26095 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26096
26097 The default value is determined from the
26098 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26099 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26100 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26101
26102 @item
26103 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26104
26105 Add a new format of match like
26106 @lisp
26107 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26108 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26109 @end lisp
26110 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26111 @lisp
26112 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26113 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26114 @end lisp
26115
26116 @item
26117 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26118
26119 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26120 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26121 need add those two headers too.
26122
26123 @item
26124 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26125
26126 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26127 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26128 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26129
26130 @item
26131 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26132 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26133 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26134 versions.
26135
26136 @item
26137 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26138
26139 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26140
26141 @item
26142 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26143
26144 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26145
26146 @item
26147 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26148
26149 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26150 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26151 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26152
26153 @item
26154 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26155
26156 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26157 the valid values.
26158
26159 @item
26160 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26161
26162 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26163 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26164 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26165 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26166 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26167 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26168 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26169 The behaviour can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26170
26171 @item
26172 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26173
26174 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26175 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26176 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26177 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26178 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26179
26180 @item
26181 Extended format specs.
26182
26183 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26184 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26185 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26186 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26187 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26188 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26189
26190 @item
26191 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26192
26193 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26194 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26195 out other articles.
26196
26197 @item Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26198
26199 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26200 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26201 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26202 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26203
26204 @item
26205 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26206
26207 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26208 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26209 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26210
26211 @item
26212 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26213
26214 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26215 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26216 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26217 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26218 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26219 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26220 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26221 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26222 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26223 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26224 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26225
26226 @item
26227 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26228 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26229
26230 @item
26231 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26232 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26233 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26234 message, Message Manual}).
26235
26236 @item
26237 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26238 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26239
26240 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26241 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26242 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26243 @lisp
26244 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26245 @end lisp
26246
26247 @item
26248 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26249 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26250
26251 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26252 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26253 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26254 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26255
26256 @item
26257 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26258
26259 @item
26260 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26261 C-m}.
26262
26263 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26264 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26265
26266 @item
26267 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to symbol @code{best}.
26268
26269 The behaviour for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26270 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26271 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26272 invalidate the digital signature.
26273 @end itemize
26274
26275 @iftex
26276
26277 @page
26278 @node The Manual
26279 @section The Manual
26280 @cindex colophon
26281 @cindex manual
26282
26283 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26284 either @code{texi2dvi}
26285 @iflatex
26286 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26287 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26288 @end iflatex
26289 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26290
26291 The following conventions have been used:
26292
26293 @enumerate
26294
26295 @item
26296 This is a @samp{string}
26297
26298 @item
26299 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26300
26301 @item
26302 This is a @file{file}
26303
26304 @item
26305 This is a @code{symbol}
26306
26307 @end enumerate
26308
26309 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26310 mean:
26311
26312 @lisp
26313 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26314 @end lisp
26315
26316 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26317
26318 @lisp
26319 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26320 @end lisp
26321
26322 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26323 ever get them confused.
26324
26325 @iflatex
26326 @c @head
26327 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26328 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26329 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26330 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26331 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26332 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26333 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26334 @end iflatex
26335
26336 @end iftex
26337
26338
26339 @node On Writing Manuals
26340 @section On Writing Manuals
26341
26342 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26343 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26344 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26345 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26346 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26347 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26348 hand in hand.
26349
26350 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26351 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26352 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26353 started with Gnus.
26354
26355 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26356 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26357
26358
26359 @page
26360 @node Terminology
26361 @section Terminology
26362
26363 @cindex terminology
26364 @table @dfn
26365
26366 @item news
26367 @cindex news
26368 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26369 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26370 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26371 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26372 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26373
26374 @item mail
26375 @cindex mail
26376 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26377 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26378 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26379 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26380
26381 @item reply
26382 @cindex reply
26383 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26384
26385 @item follow up
26386 @cindex follow up
26387 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26388 are reading.
26389
26390 @item back end
26391 @cindex back end
26392 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26393 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26394 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26395 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26396 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26397 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26398 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26399 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26400 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26401 number 4711''.
26402
26403 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26404 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26405 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26406 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26407 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26408 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26409
26410 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26411 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26412 access the articles.
26413
26414 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26415 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26416 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26417 confusing.
26418
26419 @item native
26420 @cindex native
26421 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26422 default, way of getting news.
26423
26424 @item foreign
26425 @cindex foreign
26426 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26427 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26428 news.
26429
26430 @item secondary
26431 @cindex secondary
26432 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26433 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26434
26435 @item article
26436 @cindex article
26437 A message that has been posted as news.
26438
26439 @item mail message
26440 @cindex mail message
26441 A message that has been mailed.
26442
26443 @item message
26444 @cindex message
26445 A mail message or news article
26446
26447 @item head
26448 @cindex head
26449 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26450 put.
26451
26452 @item body
26453 @cindex body
26454 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26455 body.
26456
26457 @item header
26458 @cindex header
26459 A line from the head of an article.
26460
26461 @item headers
26462 @cindex headers
26463 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26464 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26465
26466 @item @acronym{NOV}
26467 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26468 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26469 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26470 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26471 normal @sc{head} format.
26472
26473 @item level
26474 @cindex levels
26475 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26476 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26477 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26478 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26479 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26480 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26481
26482 @item killed groups
26483 @cindex killed groups
26484 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26485 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26486
26487 @item zombie groups
26488 @cindex zombie groups
26489 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26490
26491 @item active file
26492 @cindex active file
26493 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26494 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26495 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26496
26497 @item bogus groups
26498 @cindex bogus groups
26499 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26500 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26501 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26502
26503 @item activating
26504 @cindex activating groups
26505 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26506 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26507 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26508
26509 @item server
26510 @cindex server
26511 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26512
26513 @item select method
26514 @cindex select method
26515 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26516 server settings.
26517
26518 @item virtual server
26519 @cindex virtual server
26520 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26521 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26522 whole is a virtual server.
26523
26524 @item washing
26525 @cindex washing
26526 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26527 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26528 original.
26529
26530 @item ephemeral groups
26531 @cindex ephemeral groups
26532 @cindex temporary groups
26533 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26534 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26535 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26536
26537 @item solid groups
26538 @cindex solid groups
26539 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26540 group buffer are solid groups.
26541
26542 @item sparse articles
26543 @cindex sparse articles
26544 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26545 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26546
26547 @item threading
26548 @cindex threading
26549 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26550 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26551
26552 @item root
26553 @cindex root
26554 @cindex thread root
26555 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26556 articles in the thread.
26557
26558 @item parent
26559 @cindex parent
26560 An article that has responses.
26561
26562 @item child
26563 @cindex child
26564 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
26565
26566 @item digest
26567 @cindex digest
26568 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
26569 specified by RFC 1153.
26570
26571 @item splitting
26572 @cindex splitting, terminolgy
26573 @cindex mail sorting
26574 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
26575 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
26576 incorrectly called mail filtering.
26577
26578 @end table
26579
26580
26581 @page
26582 @node Customization
26583 @section Customization
26584 @cindex general customization
26585
26586 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
26587 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
26588 for some quite common situations.
26589
26590 @menu
26591 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
26592 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
26593 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
26594 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
26595 @end menu
26596
26597
26598 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
26599 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
26600
26601 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
26602 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
26603 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
26604
26605 @table @code
26606
26607 @item gnus-read-active-file
26608 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
26609 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
26610 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26611 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
26612 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
26613
26614 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
26615 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
26616 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
26617 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
26618 @end table
26619
26620
26621 @node Slow Terminal Connection
26622 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
26623
26624 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
26625 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
26626 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
26627
26628 @table @code
26629
26630 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
26631 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
26632 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
26633 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
26634 horizontal and vertical recentering.
26635
26636 @item gnus-visible-headers
26637 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
26638 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
26639 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
26640 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
26641
26642 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
26643 @lisp
26644 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
26645 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
26646 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
26647 @end lisp
26648
26649 @item gnus-use-full-window
26650 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
26651 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
26652 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
26653 want to read them anyway.
26654
26655 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
26656 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
26657 hidden initially.
26658
26659
26660 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
26661 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
26662 lines, which might save some time.
26663 @end table
26664
26665
26666 @node Little Disk Space
26667 @subsection Little Disk Space
26668 @cindex disk space
26669
26670 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
26671 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
26672
26673 @table @code
26674
26675 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
26676 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
26677 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26678 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26679 default.
26680
26681 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
26682 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
26683 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
26684 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
26685 default.
26686
26687 @item gnus-save-killed-list
26688 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
26689 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
26690 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
26691 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
26692
26693 @end table
26694
26695
26696 @node Slow Machine
26697 @subsection Slow Machine
26698 @cindex slow machine
26699
26700 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
26701 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
26702
26703 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
26704 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
26705
26706 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
26707 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
26708 summary buffer faster.
26709
26710
26711 @page
26712 @node Troubleshooting
26713 @section Troubleshooting
26714 @cindex troubleshooting
26715
26716 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
26717 problems, really.
26718
26719 Ahem.
26720
26721 @enumerate
26722
26723 @item
26724 Make sure your computer is switched on.
26725
26726 @item
26727 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
26728 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
26729 Gnus will work.
26730
26731 @item
26732 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
26733 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
26734 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
26735
26736 @item
26737 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
26738 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
26739
26740 @item
26741 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
26742 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
26743 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
26744 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
26745 something like that.
26746 @end enumerate
26747
26748 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
26749
26750 @cindex bugs
26751 @cindex reporting bugs
26752
26753 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26754 @findex gnus-bug
26755 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
26756 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
26757 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
26758 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
26759
26760 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
26761 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
26762 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
26763 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
26764 time.
26765
26766 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
26767 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
26768 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
26769 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
26770 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
26771 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
26772
26773 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
26774 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
26775 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
26776 the bug report.
26777
26778 @cindex patches
26779 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
26780 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
26781
26782 @cindex edebug
26783 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
26784 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
26785 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
26786 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
26787 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
26788 you discover some weird behaviour when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
26789 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
26790 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
26791 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
26792 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
26793 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
26794 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
26795 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
26796 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
26797
26798 @cindex elp
26799 @cindex profile
26800 @cindex slow
26801 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
26802 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
26803 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
26804 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
26805 helps isolating the real problem areas).
26806
26807 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
26808 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
26809 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
26810 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
26811 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
26812 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
26813 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
26814 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
26815 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
26816 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
26817 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
26818 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
26819 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
26820 work perfectly.
26821
26822 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
26823 @cindex ding mailing list
26824 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
26825 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
26826 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
26827 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
26828
26829
26830 @page
26831 @node Gnus Reference Guide
26832 @section Gnus Reference Guide
26833
26834 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
26835 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
26836 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
26837 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
26838 it.
26839
26840 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
26841 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
26842 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
26843 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
26844 and general methods of operation.
26845
26846 @menu
26847 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
26848 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
26849 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
26850 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
26851 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
26852 * Group Info:: The group info format.
26853 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
26854 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
26855 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
26856 @end menu
26857
26858
26859 @node Gnus Utility Functions
26860 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
26861 @cindex Gnus utility functions
26862 @cindex utility functions
26863 @cindex functions
26864 @cindex internal variables
26865
26866 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
26867 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
26868 Below is a list of the most common ones.
26869
26870 @table @code
26871
26872 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
26873 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
26874 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
26875
26876 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
26877 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
26878 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
26879
26880 @item gnus-group-real-name
26881 @findex gnus-group-real-name
26882 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
26883 name.
26884
26885 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
26886 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
26887 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
26888 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
26889
26890 @item gnus-get-info
26891 @findex gnus-get-info
26892 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
26893
26894 @item gnus-group-unread
26895 @findex gnus-group-unread
26896 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
26897 unknown.
26898
26899 @item gnus-active
26900 @findex gnus-active
26901 The active entry for @var{group}.
26902
26903 @item gnus-set-active
26904 @findex gnus-set-active
26905 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
26906
26907 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26908 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
26909 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
26910 exit.
26911
26912 @item gnus-continuum-version
26913 @findex gnus-continuum-version
26914 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
26915 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
26916 versions.
26917
26918 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
26919 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
26920 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
26921
26922 @item gnus-news-group-p
26923 @findex gnus-news-group-p
26924 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
26925
26926 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
26927 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
26928 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
26929
26930 @item gnus-server-to-method
26931 @findex gnus-server-to-method
26932 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
26933
26934 @item gnus-server-equal
26935 @findex gnus-server-equal
26936 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
26937
26938 @item gnus-group-native-p
26939 @findex gnus-group-native-p
26940 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
26941
26942 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
26943 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
26944 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
26945
26946 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
26947 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
26948 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
26949
26950 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
26951 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
26952 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
26953 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
26954
26955 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
26956 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
26957 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
26958
26959 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
26960 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
26961 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
26962
26963 @item gnus-check-backend-function
26964 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
26965 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
26966 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
26967
26968 @lisp
26969 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
26970 @result{} t
26971 @end lisp
26972
26973 @item gnus-read-method
26974 @findex gnus-read-method
26975 Prompts the user for a select method.
26976
26977 @end table
26978
26979
26980 @node Back End Interface
26981 @subsection Back End Interface
26982
26983 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
26984 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
26985 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
26986 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
26987 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
26988 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
26989
26990 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
26991 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
26992 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
26993 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
26994 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
26995 been opened, the function should fail.
26996
26997 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
26998 name. Take this example:
26999
27000 @lisp
27001 (nntp "odd-one"
27002 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27003 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27004 @end lisp
27005
27006 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27007 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27008
27009 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27010 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27011 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27012
27013 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27014 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27015 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27016
27017 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27018 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27019 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27020 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27021 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27022 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27023 return value.
27024
27025 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27026 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27027 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27028 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27029 more.
27030
27031 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27032 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27033 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27034 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27035 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27036 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27037 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27038 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27039 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27040 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27041
27042 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27043 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27044 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27045 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27046 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27047 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27048 of numbers as long as possible.
27049
27050 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27051 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27052 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27053
27054 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27055 @code{nnchoke}.
27056
27057 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27058
27059 @menu
27060 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27061 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27062 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27063 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27064 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27065 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27066 @end menu
27067
27068
27069 @node Required Back End Functions
27070 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27071
27072 @table @code
27073
27074 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27075
27076 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27077 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27078 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27079 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27080
27081 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27082 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27083 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27084 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27085
27086 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27087 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27088 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27089 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27090 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27091 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27092 number, do maximum fetches.
27093
27094 Here's an example HEAD:
27095
27096 @example
27097 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27098 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27099 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27100 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27101 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27102 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27103 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27104 Lines: 26
27105 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27106 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27107 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27108 .
27109 @end example
27110
27111 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27112 these in the data buffer.
27113
27114 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27115
27116 @example
27117 headers = *head
27118 head = error / valid-head
27119 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27120 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27121 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27122 header = <text> eol
27123 @end example
27124
27125 @cindex BNF
27126 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27127
27128 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27129 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27130 separated by tabs.
27131
27132 @example
27133 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27134 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27135 field = <text except TAB>
27136 @end example
27137
27138 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27139 @pxref{Headers}.
27140
27141
27142 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27143
27144 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27145 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27146
27147 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27148 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27149 server. In fact, it should do so.
27150
27151 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27152 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27153
27154
27155 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27156
27157 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27158 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27159 reason.
27160
27161 There should be no data returned.
27162
27163
27164 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27165
27166 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27167 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27168 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27169 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27170
27171 There should be no data returned.
27172
27173
27174 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27175
27176 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27177 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27178 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27179 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27180
27181 There should be no data returned.
27182
27183
27184 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27185
27186 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27187
27188 There should be no data returned.
27189
27190
27191 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27192
27193 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27194 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27195 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27196 it would be nice if that were possible.
27197
27198 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27199 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27200 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27201 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27202 into its article buffer.
27203
27204 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27205 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27206 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27207 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27208 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27209 on successful article retrieval.
27210
27211
27212 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27213
27214 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27215 making @var{group} the current group.
27216
27217 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27218 the current group.
27219
27220 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27221
27222 @example
27223 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27224 @end example
27225
27226 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27227 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27228 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27229 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27230 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27231 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27232 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27233 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27234 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27235 highest as 0.
27236
27237 @example
27238 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27239 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27240 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27241 @end example
27242
27243
27244 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27245
27246 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27247 a no-op on most back ends.
27248
27249 There should be no data returned.
27250
27251
27252 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27253
27254 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27255 @emph{all}.
27256
27257 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27258
27259 @example
27260 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27261 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27262 @end example
27263
27264 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27265 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27266 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27267 and the highest as 0.
27268
27269 @example
27270 active-file = *active-line
27271 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27272 name = <string>
27273 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27274 @end example
27275
27276 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27277 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27278 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27279
27280
27281 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27282
27283 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27284 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27285 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27286 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27287 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27288 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27289
27290 There should be no result data from this function.
27291
27292 @end table
27293
27294
27295 @node Optional Back End Functions
27296 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27297
27298 @table @code
27299
27300 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27301
27302 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27303 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27304 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27305
27306 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27307 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27308 former is in the same format as the data from
27309 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27310 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27311
27312 @example
27313 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27314 @end example
27315
27316
27317 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27318
27319 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27320 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27321 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27322 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27323 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27324
27325 There should be no result data from this function.
27326
27327
27328 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27329
27330 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27331 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27332 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27333 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27334 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27335 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27336 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27337 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27338
27339 There should be no result data from this function.
27340
27341
27342 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27343
27344 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27345 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27346 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27347 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27348 propagate the mark information to the server.
27349
27350 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27351
27352 @example
27353 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27354 @end example
27355
27356 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27357 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27358 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27359 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27360 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27361 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27362 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27363 possible, not limit itself to these.
27364
27365 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27366 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27367 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27368 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27369
27370 An example action list:
27371
27372 @example
27373 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27374 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27375 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27376 @end example
27377
27378 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27379 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27380
27381 There should be no result data from this function.
27382
27383 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27384
27385 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27386 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27387 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27388 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27389 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27390
27391 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27392 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27393 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27394 expirable.
27395
27396 There should be no result data from this function.
27397
27398
27399 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27400
27401 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27402 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27403 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27404 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27405 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27406 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27407 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27408 local if that's practical.
27409
27410 There should be no result data from this function.
27411
27412
27413 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27414
27415 The result data from this function should be a description of
27416 @var{group}.
27417
27418 @example
27419 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27420 name = <string>
27421 description = <text>
27422 @end example
27423
27424 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27425
27426 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27427 groups available on the server.
27428
27429 @example
27430 description-buffer = *description-line
27431 @end example
27432
27433
27434 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27435
27436 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27437 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27438 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27439 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27440 in the active buffer format.
27441
27442 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27443 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27444 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27445 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27446 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27447 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27448 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27449
27450
27451 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27452
27453 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27454
27455 There should be no return data.
27456
27457
27458 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27459
27460 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27461 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27462 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27463 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27464 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27465 they are.
27466
27467 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27468 able to delete.
27469
27470 There should be no result data returned.
27471
27472
27473 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27474
27475 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27476 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27477
27478 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27479 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27480 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27481 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27482 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27483 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27484
27485 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27486 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27487 optimizations.
27488
27489 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27490 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27491
27492 There should be no data returned.
27493
27494
27495 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27496
27497 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27498 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27499 this function in short order.
27500
27501 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27502 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27503
27504 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27505 article for that group.
27506
27507 There should be no data returned.
27508
27509
27510 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27511
27512 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27513 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27514
27515 There should be no data returned.
27516
27517
27518 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27519
27520 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27521 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27522 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27523
27524 There should be no data returned.
27525
27526
27527 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27528
27529 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27530 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27531
27532 There should be no data returned.
27533
27534 @end table
27535
27536
27537 @node Error Messaging
27538 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27539
27540 @findex nnheader-report
27541 @findex nnheader-get-report
27542 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27543 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27544 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27545 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27546 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27547 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27548
27549 @lisp
27550 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27551
27552 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27553 @end lisp
27554
27555 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27556 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27557 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27558 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27559
27560 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
27561 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
27562 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
27563
27564
27565 @node Writing New Back Ends
27566 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
27567
27568 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
27569 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
27570 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
27571 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
27572 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
27573 editing articles.
27574
27575 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
27576 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
27577 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
27578
27579 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
27580 package called @code{nnoo}.
27581
27582 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
27583 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
27584 following macros:
27585
27586 @table @code
27587
27588 @item nnoo-declare
27589 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
27590 parameters. For instance:
27591
27592 @lisp
27593 (nnoo-declare nndir
27594 nnml nnmh)
27595 @end lisp
27596
27597 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
27598 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
27599
27600 @item defvoo
27601 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
27602 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
27603 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
27604
27605 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
27606 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
27607 a function in those back ends.
27608
27609 @lisp
27610 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27611 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27612 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27613 @end lisp
27614
27615 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
27616 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
27617 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
27618
27619 @item nnoo-define-basics
27620 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
27621 have.
27622
27623 @lisp
27624 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27625 @end lisp
27626
27627 @item deffoo
27628 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
27629 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
27630 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
27631
27632 @item nnoo-map-functions
27633 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
27634 functions from the parent back ends.
27635
27636 @lisp
27637 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27638 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27639 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
27640 @end lisp
27641
27642 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
27643 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
27644 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
27645 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
27646
27647 @item nnoo-import
27648 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
27649 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
27650 haven't already been defined.
27651
27652 @lisp
27653 (nnoo-import nndir
27654 (nnmh
27655 nnmh-request-list
27656 nnmh-request-newgroups)
27657 (nnml))
27658 @end lisp
27659
27660 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
27661 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
27662 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
27663 defined now.
27664
27665 @end table
27666
27667 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
27668
27669 @lisp
27670 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
27671 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
27672
27673 ;;; @r{Code:}
27674
27675 (require 'nnheader)
27676 (require 'nnmh)
27677 (require 'nnml)
27678 (require 'nnoo)
27679 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
27680
27681 (nnoo-declare nndir
27682 nnml nnmh)
27683
27684 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
27685 "Where nndir will look for groups."
27686 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
27687
27688 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
27689 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
27690 nnml-nov-is-evil)
27691
27692 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
27693 nil
27694 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
27695 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
27696 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
27697
27698 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
27699 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
27700
27701 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
27702
27703 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
27704
27705 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
27706 (setq nndir-directory
27707 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
27708 server))
27709 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
27710 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
27711 (push `(nndir-current-group
27712 ,(file-name-nondirectory
27713 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27714 defs)
27715 (push `(nndir-top-directory
27716 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
27717 defs)
27718 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
27719
27720 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
27721 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27722 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
27723 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
27724 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
27725
27726 (nnoo-import nndir
27727 (nnmh
27728 nnmh-status-message
27729 nnmh-request-list
27730 nnmh-request-newgroups))
27731
27732 (provide 'nndir)
27733 @end lisp
27734
27735
27736 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27737 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
27738
27739 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
27740 @findex gnus-declare-backend
27741 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
27742 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
27743 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
27744
27745 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
27746 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
27747
27748 Here's an example:
27749
27750 @lisp
27751 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
27752 @end lisp
27753
27754 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
27755
27756 The abilities can be:
27757
27758 @table @code
27759 @item mail
27760 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
27761 @item post
27762 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
27763 @item post-mail
27764 This back end supports both mail and news.
27765 @item none
27766 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
27767 different.
27768 @item respool
27769 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
27770 articles and groups.
27771 @item address
27772 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
27773 true for almost all back ends.
27774 @item prompt-address
27775 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
27776 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
27777 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
27778 @end table
27779
27780
27781 @node Mail-like Back Ends
27782 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
27783
27784 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
27785 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
27786 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
27787 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
27788
27789 @lisp
27790 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
27791 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
27792 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
27793 @end lisp
27794
27795 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
27796 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
27797 mail.
27798
27799 This function takes four parameters.
27800
27801 @table @var
27802 @item method
27803 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
27804 the call.
27805
27806 @item exit-function
27807 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
27808
27809 @item temp-directory
27810 Where the temporary files should be stored.
27811
27812 @item group
27813 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
27814 performed for one group only.
27815 @end table
27816
27817 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
27818 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
27819 find the article number assigned to this article.
27820
27821 The function also uses the following variables:
27822 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
27823 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
27824 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
27825 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
27826 this:
27827
27828 @example
27829 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
27830 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
27831 @end example
27832
27833
27834 @node Score File Syntax
27835 @subsection Score File Syntax
27836
27837 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
27838 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
27839 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
27840
27841 Here's a typical score file:
27842
27843 @lisp
27844 (("summary"
27845 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
27846 ("Gnus"))
27847 ("from"
27848 ("Lars" -1000))
27849 (mark -100))
27850 @end lisp
27851
27852 BNF definition of a score file:
27853
27854 @example
27855 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
27856 element = rule / atom
27857 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
27858 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
27859 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
27860 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
27861 quote = <ascii 34>
27862 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
27863 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
27864 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
27865 date-header = "date"
27866 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27867 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27868 score = "nil" / <integer>
27869 date = "nil" / <natural number>
27870 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
27871 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
27872 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
27873 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
27874 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27875 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
27876 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
27877 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
27878 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
27879 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
27880 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
27881 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
27882 exclude-files / read-only / touched
27883 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
27884 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
27885 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
27886 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
27887 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
27888 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
27889 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
27890 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
27891 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
27892 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
27893 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
27894 eval = "eval" space <form>
27895 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
27896 @end example
27897
27898 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
27899 discarded.
27900
27901 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
27902 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
27903 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
27904 one looong line, then that's ok.
27905
27906 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
27907 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27908
27909
27910 @node Headers
27911 @subsection Headers
27912
27913 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
27914 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
27915 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
27916 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
27917
27918 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
27919 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
27920 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
27921 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
27922 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
27923 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
27924 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
27925
27926 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
27927 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
27928 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
27929 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
27930 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
27931
27932 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
27933 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
27934
27935
27936 @node Ranges
27937 @subsection Ranges
27938
27939 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
27940 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
27941
27942 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
27943 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
27944 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
27945 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
27946
27947 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
27948 sequence.
27949
27950 @example
27951 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
27952 @end example
27953
27954 is transformed into
27955
27956 @example
27957 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
27958 @end example
27959
27960 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
27961 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
27962
27963 @example
27964 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
27965 @end example
27966
27967 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
27968 is slightly tricky:
27969
27970 @example
27971 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
27972 @end example
27973
27974 and
27975
27976 @example
27977 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
27978 @end example
27979
27980 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
27981
27982 @example
27983 (1 2 3 4 5)
27984 @end example
27985
27986 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
27987 also valid:
27988
27989 @example
27990 (1 . 5)
27991 @end example
27992
27993 and is equal to the previous range.
27994
27995 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
27996 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
27997 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
27998 range handling.)
27999
28000 @example
28001 range = simple-range / normal-range
28002 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28003 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28004 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28005 number *[ " " contents ]
28006 @end example
28007
28008 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28009 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28010 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28011 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28012 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28013 sequences.)
28014
28015
28016 @node Group Info
28017 @subsection Group Info
28018
28019 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28020 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28021 describes the group.
28022
28023 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28024 second is a more complex one:
28025
28026 @example
28027 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28028
28029 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28030 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28031 (nnml "")
28032 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28033 @end example
28034
28035 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28036 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28037 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28038 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28039 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28040 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28041 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28042 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28043 this section is about.
28044
28045 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28046 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28047 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28048
28049 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28050
28051 @example
28052 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28053 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28054 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28055 group = quote <string> quote
28056 ralevel = rank / level
28057 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28058 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28059 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28060 read = range
28061 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28062 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28063 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28064 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28065 @end example
28066
28067 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28068 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28069 in pseudo-BNF.
28070
28071 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28072 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28073
28074 @table @code
28075 @item gnus-info-group
28076 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28077 @findex gnus-info-group
28078 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28079 Get/set the group name.
28080
28081 @item gnus-info-rank
28082 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28083 @findex gnus-info-rank
28084 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28085 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28086
28087 @item gnus-info-level
28088 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28089 @findex gnus-info-level
28090 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28091 Get/set the group level.
28092
28093 @item gnus-info-score
28094 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28095 @findex gnus-info-score
28096 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28097 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28098
28099 @item gnus-info-read
28100 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28101 @findex gnus-info-read
28102 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28103 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28104
28105 @item gnus-info-marks
28106 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28107 @findex gnus-info-marks
28108 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28109 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28110
28111 @item gnus-info-method
28112 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28113 @findex gnus-info-method
28114 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28115 Get/set the group select method.
28116
28117 @item gnus-info-params
28118 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28119 @findex gnus-info-params
28120 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28121 Get/set the group parameters.
28122 @end table
28123
28124 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28125 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28126
28127 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28128 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28129 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28130 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28131
28132
28133 @node Extended Interactive
28134 @subsection Extended Interactive
28135 @cindex interactive
28136 @findex gnus-interactive
28137
28138 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28139 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28140 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28141
28142 @lisp
28143 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28144 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28145 ...
28146 )
28147 @end lisp
28148
28149 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28150 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28151 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28152 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28153 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28154 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28155 @code{interactive}.
28156
28157 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28158 adds a few more.
28159
28160 @table @samp
28161 @item y
28162 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28163 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28164 variable.
28165
28166 @item Y
28167 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28168 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28169 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28170
28171 @item A
28172 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28173 function.
28174
28175 @item H
28176 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28177 function.
28178
28179 @item g
28180 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28181 function.
28182
28183 @end table
28184
28185
28186 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28187 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28188 @cindex XEmacs
28189 @cindex Emacsen
28190
28191 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28192 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28193 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28194
28195 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28196 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28197 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28198 Gnus, that's very useful.
28199
28200 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28201 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28202 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28203 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28204 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28205 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28206 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28207 following function:
28208
28209 @lisp
28210 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28211 (start-itimer
28212 "gnus-run-at-time"
28213 `(lambda ()
28214 (,function ,@@args))
28215 time repeat))
28216 @end lisp
28217
28218 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28219 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28220 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28221 all over.
28222
28223 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28224 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28225 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28226
28227 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28228 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28229 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28230
28231
28232 @node Various File Formats
28233 @subsection Various File Formats
28234
28235 @menu
28236 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28237 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28238 @end menu
28239
28240
28241 @node Active File Format
28242 @subsubsection Active File Format
28243
28244 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28245 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28246 in each group.
28247
28248 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28249
28250 @example
28251 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28252 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28253 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28254 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28255 no.general 1000 900 y
28256 @end example
28257
28258 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28259
28260 @example
28261 active = *group-line
28262 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28263 group = <non-white-space string>
28264 spc = " "
28265 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28266 low-number = <positive integer>
28267 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28268 @end example
28269
28270 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28271 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28272
28273
28274 @node Newsgroups File Format
28275 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28276
28277 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28278 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28279 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28280 the user.
28281
28282 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28283 Here's the definition:
28284
28285 @example
28286 newsgroups = *line
28287 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28288 group = <non-white-space string>
28289 tab = <TAB>
28290 description = <string>
28291 @end example
28292
28293
28294 @page
28295 @node Emacs for Heathens
28296 @section Emacs for Heathens
28297
28298 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28299 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28300 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28301 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28302 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28303 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28304 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28305 cat instead.
28306
28307 @menu
28308 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28309 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28310 @end menu
28311
28312
28313 @node Keystrokes
28314 @subsection Keystrokes
28315
28316 @itemize @bullet
28317 @item
28318 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28319
28320 @item
28321 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28322 @end itemize
28323
28324 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28325 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28326 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28327 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28328 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28329 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28330
28331 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28332 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28333 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28334 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28335 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28336 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28337 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28338
28339 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28340 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28341 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28342 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28343 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28344 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28345 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28346
28347 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28348 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28349 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28350 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28351 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28352 it.
28353
28354
28355
28356 @node Emacs Lisp
28357 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28358
28359 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28360 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28361 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28362 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28363
28364 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28365 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28366 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28367 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28368 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28369 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28370 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
28371 to customize Gnus.
28372
28373 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28374 write the following:
28375
28376 @lisp
28377 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28378 @end lisp
28379
28380 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28381 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28382 you can go and fill your @file{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
28383 how Gnus works.
28384
28385 If you have put that thing in your @file{.emacs} file, it will be read
28386 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28387 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28388 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28389 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28390
28391 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28392 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28393 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28394
28395 Some pitfalls:
28396
28397 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28398 that means:
28399
28400 @lisp
28401 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28402 @end lisp
28403
28404 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28405 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28406
28407 @lisp
28408 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28409 @end lisp
28410
28411 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28412 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28413
28414 @page
28415 @include gnus-faq.texi
28416
28417 @node Index
28418 @chapter Index
28419 @printindex cp
28420
28421 @node Key Index
28422 @chapter Key Index
28423 @printindex ky
28424
28425 @summarycontents
28426 @contents
28427 @bye
28428
28429 @iftex
28430 @iflatex
28431 \end{document}
28432 @end iflatex
28433 @end iftex
28434
28435 @c Local Variables:
28436 @c mode: texinfo
28437 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28438 @c End:
28439
28440 @ignore
28441 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28442 @end ignore